* gdb.texinfo (Set Breaks, Disabling): Clarify behavior of
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
66 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
67 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
88 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
89 @sp 2
90 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
91 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
92 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
93 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
94
95 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
96 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
97 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
98 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
99 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
100 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
101
102 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
103 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
104 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
105 @page
106 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
107 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
108 software in general. We will miss him.
109 @end titlepage
110 @page
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
120 @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Stack:: Examining the stack
137 * Source:: Examining source files
138 * Data:: Examining data
139 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146 * Altering:: Altering execution
147 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
153 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158
159 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
160
161 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
162 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
163 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
164 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
165 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
166 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
167 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
168 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
169 @value{GDBN}
170 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
171 how you can copy and share GDB
172 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
173 * Index:: Index
174 @end menu
175
176 @end ifnottex
177
178 @contents
179
180 @node Summary
181 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
182
183 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
184 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
185 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
186
187 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
188 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
189
190 @itemize @bullet
191 @item
192 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
193
194 @item
195 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
196
197 @item
198 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
199
200 @item
201 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
202 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
203 @end itemize
204
205 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
206 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
207 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
208
209 @cindex Modula-2
210 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
211 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
212
213 @cindex Pascal
214 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
215 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
216 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
217 syntax.
218
219 @cindex Fortran
220 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
221 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
222 underscore.
223
224 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
225 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
226
227 @menu
228 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
229 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
230 @end menu
231
232 @node Free Software
233 @unnumberedsec Free Software
234
235 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
236 General Public License
237 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
238 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
239 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
240 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
241 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
242 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
243
244 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
245 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
246 from anyone else.
247
248 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
249
250 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
251 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
252 include with the free software. Many of our most important
253 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
254 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
255 when an important free software package does not come with a free
256 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
257 gaps today.
258
259 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
260 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
261 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
262 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
263 them from the free software world.
264
265 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
266 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
267 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
268 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
269 contract to make it non-free.
270
271 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
272 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
273 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
274 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
275 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
276 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
277 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
278
279 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
280 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
281 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
282 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
283
284 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
285 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
286 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
287 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
288 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
289 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
290 community.
291
292 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
293 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
294 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
295 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
296 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
297 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
298 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
299 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
300 of the manual.
301
302 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
303 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
304 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
305 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
306 manual to replace it.
307
308 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
309 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
310 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
311 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
312 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
313 the free software community.
314
315 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
316 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
317 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
318 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
319 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
320 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
321 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
322 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
323 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
324
325 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
326 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
327 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
328 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
329 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
330 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
331 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
332 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
333
334 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
335 published by other publishers, at
336 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
337
338 @node Contributors
339 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
340
341 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
342 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
343 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
344 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
345 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
346 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
347 blow-by-blow account.
348
349 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
350
351 @quotation
352 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
353 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
354 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
355 @end quotation
356
357 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
358 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
359 releases:
360 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
361 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
362 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
363 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
364 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
365 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
366 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
367 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
368 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
369
370 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
371 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
372
373 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
374 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
375 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
376 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
377 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
378
379 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
380 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
381 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
382
383 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
384 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
385
386 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
387
388 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
389 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
390 support.
391 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
392 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
393 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
394 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
395 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
396 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
397 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
398 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
399 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
400 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
401 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
402 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
403 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
404 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
405 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
406 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
407
408 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
409
410 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
411 libraries.
412
413 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
414 about several machine instruction sets.
415
416 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
417 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
418 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
419 and RDI targets, respectively.
420
421 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
422 command-line editing and command history.
423
424 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
425 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
426
427 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
428 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
429 symbols.
430
431 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
432 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
433
434 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
435
436 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
437 processors.
438
439 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
440
441 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
442
443 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
444
445 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
446 watchpoints.
447
448 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
449
450 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
451
452 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
453 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
454
455 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
456 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
457 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
458 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
459 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
460 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
461 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
462
463 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
464 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
465
466 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
467 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
468 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
469 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
470 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
471 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
472 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
473 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
474 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
475 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
476 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
477 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
478 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
479 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
480 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
481
482 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
483 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
484
485 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
486 Hat.
487
488 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
489 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
490 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
491 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
492 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
493 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
494
495 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
496 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
497 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
498 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
499 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
500 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
501 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
502 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
503 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
504 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
505 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
506 Weigand.
507
508 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
509 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
510 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
511 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
512
513 @node Sample Session
514 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
515
516 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
517 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
518 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
519
520 @iftex
521 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
522 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
523 @end iftex
524
525 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
526 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
527
528 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
529 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
530 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
531 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
532 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
533 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
534 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
535 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
536 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
537
538 @smallexample
539 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
540 $ @b{./m4}
541 @b{define(foo,0000)}
542
543 @b{foo}
544 0000
545 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
546
547 @b{bar}
548 0000
549 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
550
551 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
552 @b{baz}
553 @b{Ctrl-d}
554 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
555 @end smallexample
556
557 @noindent
558 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
559
560 @smallexample
561 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
562 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
563 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
564 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
565 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
566 the conditions.
567 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
568 for details.
569
570 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
571 (@value{GDBP})
572 @end smallexample
573
574 @noindent
575 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
576 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
577 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
578 that examples fit in this manual.
579
580 @smallexample
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
586 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
587 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
588 @code{break} command.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
592 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
593 @end smallexample
594
595 @noindent
596 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
597 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
598 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
602 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
603 @b{define(foo,0000)}
604
605 @b{foo}
606 0000
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
611 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
612 context where it stops.
613
614 @smallexample
615 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
616
617 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:879
619 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
620 @end smallexample
621
622 @noindent
623 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
624 the next line of the current function.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
628 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
629 : nil,
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
634 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
635 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
636 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
637
638 @smallexample
639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
640 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
641 at input.c:530
642 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
647 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
648 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
649 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
650 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
651 stack frame for each active subroutine.
652
653 @smallexample
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
655 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
656 at input.c:530
657 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
658 at builtin.c:882
659 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
660 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
661 at macro.c:71
662 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
663 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
664 @end smallexample
665
666 @noindent
667 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
668 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
669 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
670
671 @smallexample
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
673 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
675 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
676 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
678 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
679 : xstrdup(rq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
686 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
687 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
688 (@code{print}) to see their values.
689
690 @smallexample
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
692 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
694 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
699 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
700 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
704 533 xfree(rquote);
705 534
706 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
707 : xstrdup (lq);
708 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
709 : xstrdup (rq);
710 537
711 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
712 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
713 540 @}
714 541
715 542 void
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
720 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
721
722 @smallexample
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
724 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726 540 @}
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
728 $3 = 9
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
730 $4 = 7
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
735 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
736 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
737 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
738 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
739 assignments.
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
743 $5 = 7
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
745 $6 = 9
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
750 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
751 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
752 example that caused trouble initially:
753
754 @smallexample
755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
756 Continuing.
757
758 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
759
760 baz
761 0000
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
766 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
767 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
768
769 @smallexample
770 @b{Ctrl-d}
771 Program exited normally.
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
776 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
777 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
778
779 @smallexample
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @node Invocation
784 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
785
786 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
787 The essentials are:
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
791 @item
792 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
793 @end itemize
794
795 @menu
796 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
797 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
798 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
799 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
800 @end menu
801
802 @node Invoking GDB
803 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
805 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
811 The command-line options described here are designed
812 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
813 options may effectively be unavailable.
814
815 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816 specifying an executable program:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 @noindent
823 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824 specified:
825
826 @smallexample
827 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831 to debug a running process:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
841 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
842 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
846
847 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849 option processing.
850 @smallexample
851 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852 @end smallexample
853 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
856 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
857 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} -silent
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867 @noindent
868 Type
869
870 @smallexample
871 @value{GDBP} -help
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880 @samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883 @menu
884 * File Options:: Choosing files
885 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
887 @end menu
888
889 @node File Options
890 @subsection Choosing Files
891
892 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
893 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
894 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
895 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
896 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
897 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
898 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
899 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
900 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
901 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
902 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
903 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
904 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
905
906 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
907 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
908 argument and ignore it.
909
910 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
911 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
912 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
913 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
914 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
915
916 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
917 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
918 @c it.
919
920 @table @code
921 @item -symbols @var{file}
922 @itemx -s @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--symbols}
924 @cindex @code{-s}
925 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
926
927 @item -exec @var{file}
928 @itemx -e @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--exec}
930 @cindex @code{-e}
931 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
932 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
933
934 @item -se @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--se}
936 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
937 file.
938
939 @item -core @var{file}
940 @itemx -c @var{file}
941 @cindex @code{--core}
942 @cindex @code{-c}
943 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
944
945 @item -c @var{number}
946 @item -pid @var{number}
947 @itemx -p @var{number}
948 @cindex @code{--pid}
949 @cindex @code{-p}
950 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
951 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
952 file named @var{number}.
953
954 @item -command @var{file}
955 @itemx -x @var{file}
956 @cindex @code{--command}
957 @cindex @code{-x}
958 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
959 Files,, Command files}.
960
961 @item -eval-command @var{command}
962 @itemx -ex @var{command}
963 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
964 @cindex @code{-ex}
965 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
966
967 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
968 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
969
970 @smallexample
971 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
972 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
973 @end smallexample
974
975 @item -directory @var{directory}
976 @itemx -d @var{directory}
977 @cindex @code{--directory}
978 @cindex @code{-d}
979 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
980
981 @item -r
982 @itemx -readnow
983 @cindex @code{--readnow}
984 @cindex @code{-r}
985 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
986 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
987 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
988
989 @end table
990
991 @node Mode Options
992 @subsection Choosing Modes
993
994 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
995 batch mode or quiet mode.
996
997 @table @code
998 @item -nx
999 @itemx -n
1000 @cindex @code{--nx}
1001 @cindex @code{-n}
1002 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1003 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1004 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1005 Files}.
1006
1007 @item -quiet
1008 @itemx -silent
1009 @itemx -q
1010 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1011 @cindex @code{--silent}
1012 @cindex @code{-q}
1013 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1014 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1015
1016 @item -batch
1017 @cindex @code{--batch}
1018 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1019 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1020 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1021 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1022 in the command files.
1023
1024 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1025 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1026 make this more useful, the message
1027
1028 @smallexample
1029 Program exited normally.
1030 @end smallexample
1031
1032 @noindent
1033 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1034 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1035 mode.
1036
1037 @item -batch-silent
1038 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1039 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1040 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1041 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1042 for an interactive session.
1043
1044 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1045 messages, for example.
1046
1047 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1048 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1049
1050 @item -return-child-result
1051 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1052 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1053 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1054
1055 @itemize @bullet
1056 @item
1057 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1058 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1059 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1060 @item
1061 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1062 @item
1063 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1064 the exit code will be -1.
1065 @end itemize
1066
1067 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1068 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1069 interface.
1070
1071 @item -nowindows
1072 @itemx -nw
1073 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1074 @cindex @code{-nw}
1075 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1076 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1077 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1078
1079 @item -windows
1080 @itemx -w
1081 @cindex @code{--windows}
1082 @cindex @code{-w}
1083 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1084 used if possible.
1085
1086 @item -cd @var{directory}
1087 @cindex @code{--cd}
1088 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1089 instead of the current directory.
1090
1091 @item -fullname
1092 @itemx -f
1093 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1094 @cindex @code{-f}
1095 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1096 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1097 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1098 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1099 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1100 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1101 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1102 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1103 frame.
1104
1105 @item -epoch
1106 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1107 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1108 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1109 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1110 separate window.
1111
1112 @item -annotate @var{level}
1113 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1114 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1115 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1116 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1117 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1118 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1119 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1120 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1121 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1122
1123 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1124 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1125
1126 @item --args
1127 @cindex @code{--args}
1128 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1129 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1130 This option stops option processing.
1131
1132 @item -baud @var{bps}
1133 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1134 @cindex @code{--baud}
1135 @cindex @code{-b}
1136 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1137 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1138
1139 @item -l @var{timeout}
1140 @cindex @code{-l}
1141 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1142 for remote debugging.
1143
1144 @item -tty @var{device}
1145 @itemx -t @var{device}
1146 @cindex @code{--tty}
1147 @cindex @code{-t}
1148 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1149 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1150
1151 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1152 @item -tui
1153 @cindex @code{--tui}
1154 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1155 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1156 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1157 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1158 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1159 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1160 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1161
1162 @c @item -xdb
1163 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1164 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1165 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1166 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1167 @c systems.
1168
1169 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1170 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1171 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1172 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1173 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1174 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1175
1176 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1177 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1178 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1179 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1180 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1181 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1182
1183 @item -write
1184 @cindex @code{--write}
1185 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1186 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1187 (@pxref{Patching}).
1188
1189 @item -statistics
1190 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1191 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1192 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1193
1194 @item -version
1195 @cindex @code{--version}
1196 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1197 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1198
1199 @end table
1200
1201 @node Startup
1202 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1203 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1204
1205 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1206
1207 @enumerate
1208 @item
1209 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1210 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1211
1212 @item
1213 @cindex init file
1214 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1215 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1216 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1217 that file.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Processes command line options and operands.
1221
1222 @item
1223 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1224 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1225 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1226 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1227 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1228 @value{GDBN}.
1229
1230 @item
1231 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1232 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1233
1234 @item
1235 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1236 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1237 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1238 @end enumerate
1239
1240 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1241 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1242 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1243 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1244 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1245 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1246
1247 @cindex init file name
1248 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1249 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1250 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1251 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1252 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1253 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1254 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1255 the file to the standard name.
1256
1257
1258 @node Quitting GDB
1259 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1260 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1261 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1262
1263 @table @code
1264 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1265 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1266 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1267 @itemx q
1268 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1269 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1270 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1271 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1272 error code.
1273 @end table
1274
1275 @cindex interrupt
1276 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1277 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1278 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1279 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1280 until a time when it is safe.
1281
1282 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1283 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1284 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1285
1286 @node Shell Commands
1287 @section Shell Commands
1288
1289 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1290 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1291 just use the @code{shell} command.
1292
1293 @table @code
1294 @kindex shell
1295 @cindex shell escape
1296 @item shell @var{command string}
1297 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1298 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1299 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1300 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1301 @end table
1302
1303 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1304 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1305 @value{GDBN}:
1306
1307 @table @code
1308 @kindex make
1309 @cindex calling make
1310 @item make @var{make-args}
1311 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1312 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1313 @end table
1314
1315 @node Logging Output
1316 @section Logging Output
1317 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1318 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1319
1320 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1321 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1322
1323 @table @code
1324 @kindex set logging
1325 @item set logging on
1326 Enable logging.
1327 @item set logging off
1328 Disable logging.
1329 @cindex logging file name
1330 @item set logging file @var{file}
1331 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1332 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1333 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1334 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1335 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1336 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1337 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1338 @kindex show logging
1339 @item show logging
1340 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1341 @end table
1342
1343 @node Commands
1344 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1345
1346 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1347 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1348 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1349 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1350 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1351
1352 @menu
1353 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1354 * Completion:: Command completion
1355 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1356 @end menu
1357
1358 @node Command Syntax
1359 @section Command Syntax
1360
1361 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1362 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1363 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1364 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1365 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1366 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1367
1368 @cindex abbreviation
1369 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1370 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1371 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1372 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1373 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1374 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1375 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1376
1377 @cindex repeating commands
1378 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1379 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1380 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1381 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1382 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1383 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1384 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1385
1386 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1387 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1388 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1389
1390 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1391 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1392 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1393 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1394 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1395
1396 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1397 @cindex comment
1398 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1399 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1400 Files,,Command Files}).
1401
1402 @cindex repeating command sequences
1403 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1404 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1405 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1406 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1407 for editing.
1408
1409 @node Completion
1410 @section Command Completion
1411
1412 @cindex completion
1413 @cindex word completion
1414 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1415 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1416 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1417 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1418
1419 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1420 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1421 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1422 enter it). For example, if you type
1423
1424 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1425 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1426 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1427 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1428 @smallexample
1429 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1430 @end smallexample
1431
1432 @noindent
1433 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1434 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1435
1436 @smallexample
1437 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1438 @end smallexample
1439
1440 @noindent
1441 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1442 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1443 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1444 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1445 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1446 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1447
1448 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1449 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1450 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1451 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1452 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1453 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1454 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1455 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1456 example:
1457
1458 @smallexample
1459 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1460 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1461 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1462 make_abs_section make_function_type
1463 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1464 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1465 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1466 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1467 @end smallexample
1468
1469 @noindent
1470 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1471 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1472 command.
1473
1474 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1475 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1476 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1477 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1478 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1479
1480 @cindex quotes in commands
1481 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1482 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1483 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1484 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1485 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1486 @value{GDBN} commands.
1487
1488 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1489 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1490 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1491 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1492 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1493 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1494 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1495 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1496 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1497 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1498 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1499
1500 @smallexample
1501 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1502 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1503 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1504 @end smallexample
1505
1506 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1507 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1508 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1509 place:
1510
1511 @smallexample
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1513 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1514 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1515 @end smallexample
1516
1517 @noindent
1518 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1519 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1520 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1521
1522 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1523 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1524 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1525 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1526
1527
1528 @node Help
1529 @section Getting Help
1530 @cindex online documentation
1531 @kindex help
1532
1533 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1534 using the command @code{help}.
1535
1536 @table @code
1537 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1538 @item help
1539 @itemx h
1540 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1541 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1542
1543 @smallexample
1544 (@value{GDBP}) help
1545 List of classes of commands:
1546
1547 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1548 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1549 data -- Examining data
1550 files -- Specifying and examining files
1551 internals -- Maintenance commands
1552 obscure -- Obscure features
1553 running -- Running the program
1554 stack -- Examining the stack
1555 status -- Status inquiries
1556 support -- Support facilities
1557 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1558 stopping the program
1559 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1560
1561 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1562 commands in that class.
1563 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1564 documentation.
1565 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1566 (@value{GDBP})
1567 @end smallexample
1568 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1569
1570 @item help @var{class}
1571 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1572 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1573 help display for the class @code{status}:
1574
1575 @smallexample
1576 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1577 Status inquiries.
1578
1579 List of commands:
1580
1581 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1582 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1583 info -- Generic command for showing things
1584 about the program being debugged
1585 show -- Generic command for showing things
1586 about the debugger
1587
1588 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1589 documentation.
1590 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1591 (@value{GDBP})
1592 @end smallexample
1593
1594 @item help @var{command}
1595 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1596 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1597
1598 @kindex apropos
1599 @item apropos @var{args}
1600 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1601 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1602 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1603
1604 @smallexample
1605 apropos reload
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 results in:
1610
1611 @smallexample
1612 @c @group
1613 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1614 multiple times in one run
1615 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1616 multiple times in one run
1617 @c @end group
1618 @end smallexample
1619
1620 @kindex complete
1621 @item complete @var{args}
1622 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1623 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1624 command you want completed. For example:
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 complete i
1628 @end smallexample
1629
1630 @noindent results in:
1631
1632 @smallexample
1633 @group
1634 if
1635 ignore
1636 info
1637 inspect
1638 @end group
1639 @end smallexample
1640
1641 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1642 @end table
1643
1644 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1645 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1646 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1647 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1648 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1649 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1650
1651 @c @group
1652 @table @code
1653 @kindex info
1654 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1655 @item info
1656 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1657 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1658 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1659 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1660 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1661 @w{@code{help info}}.
1662
1663 @kindex set
1664 @item set
1665 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1666 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1667 @code{set prompt $}.
1668
1669 @kindex show
1670 @item show
1671 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1672 @value{GDBN} itself.
1673 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1674 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1675 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1676 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1677
1678 @kindex info set
1679 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1680 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1681 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1682 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1683 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1684 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1685 @end table
1686 @c @end group
1687
1688 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1689 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1690
1691 @table @code
1692 @kindex show version
1693 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1694 @item show version
1695 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1696 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1697 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1698 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1699 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1700 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1701 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1702 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1703 @value{GDBN}.
1704
1705 @kindex show copying
1706 @kindex info copying
1707 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1708 @item show copying
1709 @itemx info copying
1710 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1711
1712 @kindex show warranty
1713 @kindex info warranty
1714 @item show warranty
1715 @itemx info warranty
1716 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1717 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1718
1719 @end table
1720
1721 @node Running
1722 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1723
1724 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1725 debugging information when you compile it.
1726
1727 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1728 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1729 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1730 kill a child process.
1731
1732 @menu
1733 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1734 * Starting:: Starting your program
1735 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1736 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1737
1738 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1739 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1740 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1741 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1742
1743 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1744 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1745 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1746 @end menu
1747
1748 @node Compilation
1749 @section Compiling for Debugging
1750
1751 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1752 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1753 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1754 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1755 and addresses in the executable code.
1756
1757 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1758 the compiler.
1759
1760 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1761 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1762 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1763 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1764 executables containing debugging information.
1765
1766 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1767 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1768 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1769 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1770 in pushing your luck.
1771
1772 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1773 @cindex debugging optimized code
1774 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1775 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1776 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1777 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1778 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1779 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1780
1781 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1782 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1783 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1784 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1785 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1786
1787 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1788 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1789 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1790
1791 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1792 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1793 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1794 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1795 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1796 provides macro information if you specify the options
1797 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1798 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1799 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1800 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1801 @option{-g} alone.
1802
1803 @need 2000
1804 @node Starting
1805 @section Starting your Program
1806 @cindex starting
1807 @cindex running
1808
1809 @table @code
1810 @kindex run
1811 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1812 @item run
1813 @itemx r
1814 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1815 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1816 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1817 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1818 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1819
1820 @end table
1821
1822 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1823 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1824 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1825 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1826
1827 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1828 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1829 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1830 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1831 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1832 divided into four categories:
1833
1834 @table @asis
1835 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1836 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1837 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1838 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1839 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1840 the arguments.
1841 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1842 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1843 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1844
1845 @item The @emph{environment.}
1846 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1847 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1848 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1849 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1850
1851 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1852 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1853 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1854 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1855
1856 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1857 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1858 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1859 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1860 set a different device for your program.
1861 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1862
1863 @cindex pipes
1864 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1865 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1866 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1867 wrong program.
1868 @end table
1869
1870 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1871 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1872 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1873 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1874 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1875
1876 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1877 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1878 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1879 your current breakpoints.
1880
1881 @table @code
1882 @kindex start
1883 @item start
1884 @cindex run to main procedure
1885 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1886 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1887 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1888 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1889 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1890 procedure, depending on the language used.
1891
1892 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1893 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1894 the @samp{run} command.
1895
1896 @cindex elaboration phase
1897 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1898 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1899 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1900 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1901 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1902 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1903 will remain to halt execution.
1904
1905 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1906 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1907 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1908 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1909 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1910
1911 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1912 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1913 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1914 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1915 elaboration code before running your program.
1916 @end table
1917
1918 @node Arguments
1919 @section Your Program's Arguments
1920
1921 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1922 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1923 @code{run} command.
1924 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1925 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1926 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1927 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1928 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1929
1930 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1931 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1932 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1933 the program, not by the shell.
1934
1935 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1936 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1937
1938 @table @code
1939 @kindex set args
1940 @item set args
1941 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1942 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1943 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1944 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1945 it again without arguments.
1946
1947 @kindex show args
1948 @item show args
1949 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1950 @end table
1951
1952 @node Environment
1953 @section Your Program's Environment
1954
1955 @cindex environment (of your program)
1956 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1957 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1958 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1959 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1960 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1961 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1962 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1963
1964 @table @code
1965 @kindex path
1966 @item path @var{directory}
1967 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1968 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1969 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1970 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1971 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1972 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1973 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1974
1975 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1976 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1977 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1978 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1979 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1980 @var{directory} to the search path.
1981 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1982 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1983
1984 @kindex show paths
1985 @item show paths
1986 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1987 environment variable).
1988
1989 @kindex show environment
1990 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1991 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1992 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1993 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1994 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1995
1996 @kindex set environment
1997 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1998 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1999 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2000 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2001 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2002 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2003 null value.
2004 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2005 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2006
2007 For example, this command:
2008
2009 @smallexample
2010 set env USER = foo
2011 @end smallexample
2012
2013 @noindent
2014 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2015 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2016 are not actually required.)
2017
2018 @kindex unset environment
2019 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2020 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2021 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2022 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2023 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2024 @end table
2025
2026 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2027 the shell indicated
2028 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2029 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2030 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2031 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2032 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2033 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2034 @file{.profile}.
2035
2036 @node Working Directory
2037 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2038
2039 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2040 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2041 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2042 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2043 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2044 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2045
2046 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2047 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2048 Specify Files}.
2049
2050 @table @code
2051 @kindex cd
2052 @cindex change working directory
2053 @item cd @var{directory}
2054 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2055
2056 @kindex pwd
2057 @item pwd
2058 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2059 @end table
2060
2061 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2062 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2063 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2064 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2065 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2066 current working directory of the debuggee.
2067
2068 @node Input/Output
2069 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2070
2071 @cindex redirection
2072 @cindex i/o
2073 @cindex terminal
2074 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2075 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2076 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2077 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2078 running your program.
2079
2080 @table @code
2081 @kindex info terminal
2082 @item info terminal
2083 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2084 program is using.
2085 @end table
2086
2087 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2088 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2089
2090 @smallexample
2091 run > outfile
2092 @end smallexample
2093
2094 @noindent
2095 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2096
2097 @kindex tty
2098 @cindex controlling terminal
2099 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2100 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2101 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2102 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2103 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2104
2105 @smallexample
2106 tty /dev/ttyb
2107 @end smallexample
2108
2109 @noindent
2110 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2111 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2112 that as their controlling terminal.
2113
2114 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2115 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2116 terminal.
2117
2118 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2119 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2120 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2121 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2122
2123 @cindex inferior tty
2124 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2125 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2126 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2127 program.
2128
2129 @table @code
2130 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2131 @kindex set inferior-tty
2132 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2133
2134 @item show inferior-tty
2135 @kindex show inferior-tty
2136 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2137 @end table
2138
2139 @node Attach
2140 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2141 @kindex attach
2142 @cindex attach
2143
2144 @table @code
2145 @item attach @var{process-id}
2146 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2147 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2148 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2149 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2150 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2151
2152 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2153 executing the command.
2154 @end table
2155
2156 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2157 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2158 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2159 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2160
2161 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2162 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2163 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2164 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2165 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2166 Specify Files}.
2167
2168 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2169 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2170 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2171 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2172 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2173 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2174 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2175
2176 @table @code
2177 @kindex detach
2178 @item detach
2179 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2180 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2181 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2182 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2183 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2184 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2185 executing the command.
2186 @end table
2187
2188 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2189 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2190 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2191 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2192 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2193 Messages}).
2194
2195 @node Kill Process
2196 @section Killing the Child Process
2197
2198 @table @code
2199 @kindex kill
2200 @item kill
2201 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2202 @end table
2203
2204 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2205 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2206 is running.
2207
2208 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2209 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2210 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2211 outside the debugger.
2212
2213 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2214 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2215 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2216 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2217 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2218 breakpoint settings).
2219
2220 @node Threads
2221 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2222
2223 @cindex threads of execution
2224 @cindex multiple threads
2225 @cindex switching threads
2226 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2227 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2228 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2229 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2230 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2231 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2232 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2233
2234 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2235 programs:
2236
2237 @itemize @bullet
2238 @item automatic notification of new threads
2239 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2240 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2241 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2242 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2243 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2244 @end itemize
2245
2246 @quotation
2247 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2248 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2249 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2250 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2251 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2252 like this:
2253
2254 @smallexample
2255 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2256 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2257 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2258 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2259 @end smallexample
2260 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2261 @c doesn't support threads"?
2262 @end quotation
2263
2264 @cindex focus of debugging
2265 @cindex current thread
2266 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2267 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2268 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2269 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2270 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2271
2272 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2273 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2274 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2275 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2276 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2277 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2278 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2279 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2280 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2281 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2282
2283 @smallexample
2284 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2285 @end smallexample
2286
2287 @noindent
2288 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2289 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2290 further qualifier.
2291
2292 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2293 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2294 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2295 @c program?
2296 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2297 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2298 @c threads ab initio?
2299
2300 @cindex thread number
2301 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2302 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2303 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2304
2305 @table @code
2306 @kindex info threads
2307 @item info threads
2308 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2309 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2310
2311 @enumerate
2312 @item
2313 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2314
2315 @item
2316 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2317
2318 @item
2319 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2320 @end enumerate
2321
2322 @noindent
2323 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2324 indicates the current thread.
2325
2326 For example,
2327 @end table
2328 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2329
2330 @smallexample
2331 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2332 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2333 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2334 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2335 at threadtest.c:68
2336 @end smallexample
2337
2338 On HP-UX systems:
2339
2340 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2341 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2342 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2343 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2344 thread in your program.
2345
2346 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2347 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2348 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2349 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2350 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2351 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2352 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2353 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2354 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2355 HP-UX, you see
2356
2357 @smallexample
2358 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2359 @end smallexample
2360
2361 @noindent
2362 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2363
2364 @table @code
2365 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2366 @item info threads
2367 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2368 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2369
2370 @enumerate
2371 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2372
2373 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2374
2375 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2376 @end enumerate
2377
2378 @noindent
2379 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2380 indicates the current thread.
2381
2382 For example,
2383 @end table
2384 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2385
2386 @smallexample
2387 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2388 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2389 at quicksort.c:137
2390 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2391 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2392 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2393 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2394 @end smallexample
2395
2396 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2397 Solaris-specific command:
2398
2399 @table @code
2400 @item maint info sol-threads
2401 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2402 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2403 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2404 @end table
2405
2406 @table @code
2407 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2408 @item thread @var{threadno}
2409 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2410 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2411 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2412 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2413 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2414
2415 @smallexample
2416 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2417 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2418 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2419 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2420 @end smallexample
2421
2422 @noindent
2423 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2424 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2425 threads.
2426
2427 @kindex thread apply
2428 @cindex apply command to several threads
2429 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2430 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2431 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2432 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2433 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2434 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2435 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2436 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2437 @end table
2438
2439 @cindex automatic thread selection
2440 @cindex switching threads automatically
2441 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2442 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2443 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2444 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2445 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2446 thread.
2447
2448 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2449 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2450 programs with multiple threads.
2451
2452 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2453 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2454
2455 @node Processes
2456 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2457
2458 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2459 @cindex multiple processes
2460 @cindex processes, multiple
2461 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2462 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2463 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2464 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2465 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2466 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2467 will cause it to terminate.
2468
2469 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2470 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2471 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2472 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2473 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2474 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2475 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2476 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2477 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2478 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2479
2480 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2481 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2482 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2483 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2484
2485 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2486 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2487
2488 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2489 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2490
2491 @table @code
2492 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2493 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2494 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2495 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2496 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2497
2498 @table @code
2499 @item parent
2500 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2501 unimpeded. This is the default.
2502
2503 @item child
2504 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2505 unimpeded.
2506
2507 @end table
2508
2509 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2510 @item show follow-fork-mode
2511 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2512 @end table
2513
2514 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2515 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2516 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2517
2518 @table @code
2519 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2520 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2521 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2522 retain debugger control over them both.
2523
2524 @table @code
2525 @item on
2526 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2527 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2528 independently. This is the default.
2529
2530 @item off
2531 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2532 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2533 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2534 is held suspended.
2535
2536 @end table
2537
2538 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2539 @item show detach-on-follow
2540 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2541 @end table
2542
2543 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2544 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2545 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2546 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2547 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2548
2549 @table @code
2550 @kindex info forks
2551 @item info forks
2552 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2553 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2554 position (program counter) of the process.
2555
2556
2557 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2558 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2559 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2560 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2561 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2562
2563 @end table
2564
2565 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2566 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2567 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2568 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2572 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2573 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2574 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2575 allowed to run independently.
2576
2577 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2578 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2579 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2580 and remove it from the fork list.
2581
2582 @end table
2583
2584 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2585 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2586 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2587 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2588 the child process's @code{main}.
2589
2590 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2591 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2592
2593 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2594 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2595 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2596 argument.
2597
2598 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2599 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2600 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2601
2602 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2603 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2604
2605 @cindex checkpoint
2606 @cindex restart
2607 @cindex bookmark
2608 @cindex snapshot of a process
2609 @cindex rewind program state
2610
2611 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2612 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2613 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2614 later.
2615
2616 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2617 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2618 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2619 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2620 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2621
2622 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2623 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2624 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2625 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2626 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2627 start again from there.
2628
2629 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2630 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2631
2632 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2633
2634 @table @code
2635 @kindex checkpoint
2636 @item checkpoint
2637 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2638 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2639 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2640
2641 @kindex info checkpoints
2642 @item info checkpoints
2643 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2644 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2645 listed:
2646
2647 @table @code
2648 @item Checkpoint ID
2649 @item Process ID
2650 @item Code Address
2651 @item Source line, or label
2652 @end table
2653
2654 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2655 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2656 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2657 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2658 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2659 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2660 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2661
2662 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2663 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2664 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2665 the debugger.
2666
2667 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2668 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2669 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2670
2671 @end table
2672
2673 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2674 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2675 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2676 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2677 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2678 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2679 previously read data can be read again.
2680
2681 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2682 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2683 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2684 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2685 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2686 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2687
2688 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2689 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2690 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2691 different execution path this time.
2692
2693 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2694 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2695 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2696 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2697 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2698 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2699 potentially pose a problem.
2700
2701 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2702
2703 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2704 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2705 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2706 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2707 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2708 next.
2709
2710 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2711 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2712 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2713 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2714 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2715
2716 @node Stopping
2717 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2718
2719 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2720 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2721 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2722
2723 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2724 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2725 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2726 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2727 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2728 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2729 explicitly request this information at any time.
2730
2731 @table @code
2732 @kindex info program
2733 @item info program
2734 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2735 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2736 @end table
2737
2738 @menu
2739 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2740 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2741 * Signals:: Signals
2742 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2743 @end menu
2744
2745 @node Breakpoints
2746 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2747
2748 @cindex breakpoints
2749 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2750 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2751 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2752 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2753 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2754 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2755 program.
2756
2757 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2758 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2759 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2760 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2761 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2762 call).
2763
2764 @cindex watchpoints
2765 @cindex data breakpoints
2766 @cindex memory tracing
2767 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2768 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2769 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2770 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2771 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2772 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2773 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2774 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2775 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2776 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2777 same commands.
2778
2779 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2780 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2781 Automatic Display}.
2782
2783 @cindex catchpoints
2784 @cindex breakpoint on events
2785 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2786 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2787 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2788 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2789 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2790 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2791 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2792
2793 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2794 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2795 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2796 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2797 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2798 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2799 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2800 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2801 enable it again.
2802
2803 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2804 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2805 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2806 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2807 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2808 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2809 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2810
2811 @menu
2812 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2813 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2814 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2815 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2816 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2817 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2818 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2819 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2820 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2821 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2822 @end menu
2823
2824 @node Set Breaks
2825 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2826
2827 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2828 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2829 @c
2830 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2831
2832 @kindex break
2833 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2834 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2835 @cindex latest breakpoint
2836 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2837 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2838 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2839 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2840 convenience variables.
2841
2842 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2843
2844 @table @code
2845 @item break @var{function}
2846 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2847 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2848 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2849 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2850
2851 @item break +@var{offset}
2852 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2853 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2854 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2855 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2856
2857 @item break @var{linenum}
2858 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2859 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2860 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2861 code on that line.
2862
2863 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2864 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2865
2866 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2867 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2868 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2869 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2870 functions.
2871
2872 @item break *@var{address}
2873 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2874 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2875 information or source files.
2876
2877 @item break
2878 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2879 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2880 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2881 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2882 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2883 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2884 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2885 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2886 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2887 inside loops.
2888
2889 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2890 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2891 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2892 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2893 existed when your program stopped.
2894
2895 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2896 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2897 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2898 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2899 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2900 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2901 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2902
2903 @kindex tbreak
2904 @item tbreak @var{args}
2905 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2906 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2907 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2908 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2909
2910 @kindex hbreak
2911 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2912 @item hbreak @var{args}
2913 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2914 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2915 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2916 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2917 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2918 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2919 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2920 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2921 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2922 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2923 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2924 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2925 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2926 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2927 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2928 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2929 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2930 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2931
2932
2933 @kindex thbreak
2934 @item thbreak @var{args}
2935 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2936 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2937 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2938 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2939 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2940 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2941 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2942 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2943
2944 @kindex rbreak
2945 @cindex regular expression
2946 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2947 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2948 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2949 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2950 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2951 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2952 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2953 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2954 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2955
2956 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2957 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2958 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2959 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2960 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2961 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2962
2963 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2964 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2965 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2966 classes.
2967
2968 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2969 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2970 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2971
2972 @smallexample
2973 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2974 @end smallexample
2975
2976 @kindex info breakpoints
2977 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2978 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2979 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2980 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2981 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2982 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2983 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2984 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
2985
2986 @table @emph
2987 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2988 @item Type
2989 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2990 @item Disposition
2991 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2992 @item Enabled or Disabled
2993 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2994 that are not enabled. An optional @samp{(p)} suffix marks pending
2995 breakpoints---breakpoints for which address is either not yet
2996 resolved, pending load of a shared library, or for which address was
2997 in a shared library that was since unloaded. Such breakpoint won't
2998 fire until a shared library that has the symbol or line referred by
2999 breakpoint is loaded. See below for details.
3000 @item Address
3001 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3002 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3003 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. A breakpoint with several locations will
3004 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3005 @item What
3006 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3007 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3008 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3009 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3010 @end table
3011
3012 @noindent
3013 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3014 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3015 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3016 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3017 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3018 valid location.
3019
3020 @noindent
3021 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3022 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3023 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3024 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3025 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3026
3027 @noindent
3028 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3029 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3030 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3031 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3032 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3033 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3034 @end table
3035
3036 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3037 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3038 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3039 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3040
3041 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3042 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3043
3044 @itemize @bullet
3045
3046 @item
3047 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3048 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3049
3050 @item
3051 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3052 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3053
3054 @item
3055 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3056 several places where that function is inlined.
3057
3058 @end itemize
3059
3060 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3061 the relevant locations.
3062
3063 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3064 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3065 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3066 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3067 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3068 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3069 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3070
3071 For example:
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3075 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3076 stop only if i==1
3077 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3078 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3079 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3080 @end smallexample
3081
3082 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3083 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3084 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3085 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3086 entire list of locations that be long to their parent breakpoint (with
3087 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3088 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3089 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3090 that belong to that breakpoint.
3091
3092 @cindex pending breakpoints
3093 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3094 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3095 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3096 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3097 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3098 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3099 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3100 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3101 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3102 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3103 is not yet resolved.
3104
3105 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3106 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3107 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3108 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3109 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3110 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3111
3112 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3113 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3114 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3115 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3116
3117 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3118 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3119 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3120
3121 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3122 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3123 address specification to an address:
3124
3125 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3126 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3127 @table @code
3128 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3129 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3130 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3131
3132 @item set breakpoint pending on
3133 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3134 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3135
3136 @item set breakpoint pending off
3137 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3138 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3139 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3140
3141 @item show breakpoint pending
3142 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3143 @end table
3144
3145 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3146 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3147 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3148
3149 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3150 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3151 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3152 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3153 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3154 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3155 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3156 breakpoints.
3157
3158 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3159
3160 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3161 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3162 @table @code
3163 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3164 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3165 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3166 breakpoint must be used.
3167
3168 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3169 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3170 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3171 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3172 @end table
3173
3174
3175 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3176 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3177 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3178 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3179 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3180 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3181 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3182 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3183
3184
3185 @node Set Watchpoints
3186 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3187
3188 @cindex setting watchpoints
3189 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3190 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3191 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3192 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3193 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3194
3195 @itemize @bullet
3196 @item
3197 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3198
3199 @item
3200 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3201 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3202 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3203
3204 @item
3205 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3206 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3207 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3208 @end itemize
3209
3210 @cindex software watchpoints
3211 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3212 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3213 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3214 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3215 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3216 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3217 culprit.)
3218
3219 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3220 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3221 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3222
3223 @table @code
3224 @kindex watch
3225 @item watch @var{expr}
3226 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3227 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3228 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3229 to watch the value of a single variable:
3230
3231 @smallexample
3232 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3233 @end smallexample
3234
3235 @kindex rwatch
3236 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3237 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3238 by the program.
3239
3240 @kindex awatch
3241 @item awatch @var{expr}
3242 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3243 or written into by the program.
3244
3245 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3246 @item info watchpoints
3247 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3248 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3249 @end table
3250
3251 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3252 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3253 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3254 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3255 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3256 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3257
3258 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3259 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3260 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3261 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3262 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3263 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3264 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3265 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3266
3267 @table @code
3268 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3269 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3270 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3271
3272 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3273 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3274 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3275 @end table
3276
3277 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3278 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3279 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3280
3281 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3282
3283 @smallexample
3284 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3285 @end smallexample
3286
3287 @noindent
3288 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3289
3290 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3291 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3292 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3293 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3294 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3295 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3296 will print a message like this:
3297
3298 @smallexample
3299 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3300 @end smallexample
3301
3302 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3303 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3304 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3305 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3306 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3307 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3308 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3309 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3310
3311 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3312 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3313 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3314 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3315 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3316 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3317
3318 @smallexample
3319 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3320 @end smallexample
3321
3322 @noindent
3323 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3324
3325 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3326 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3327 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3328 expression with separately allocated resources.
3329
3330 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3331 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3332 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3333 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3334 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3335 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3336 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3337 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3338 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3339 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3340
3341 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3342 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3343 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3344
3345 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3346 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3347 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3348 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3349 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3350 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3351 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3352 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3353 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3354
3355 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3356 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3357 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3358 watched expression from every thread.
3359
3360 @quotation
3361 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3362 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3363 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3364 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3365 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3366 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3367 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3368 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3369 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3370 @end quotation
3371
3372 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3373
3374 @node Set Catchpoints
3375 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3376 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3377 @cindex exception handlers
3378 @cindex event handling
3379
3380 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3381 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3382 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3383
3384 @table @code
3385 @kindex catch
3386 @item catch @var{event}
3387 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3388 @table @code
3389 @item throw
3390 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3391 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3392
3393 @item catch
3394 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3395
3396 @item exception
3397 @cindex Ada exception catching
3398 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3399 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3400 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3401 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3402 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3403
3404 @item exception unhandled
3405 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3406
3407 @item assert
3408 A failed Ada assertion.
3409
3410 @item exec
3411 @cindex break on fork/exec
3412 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3413
3414 @item fork
3415 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3416
3417 @item vfork
3418 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3419
3420 @item load
3421 @itemx load @var{libname}
3422 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3423 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3424 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3425
3426 @item unload
3427 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3428 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3429 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3430 @end table
3431
3432 @item tcatch @var{event}
3433 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3434 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3435
3436 @end table
3437
3438 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3439
3440 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3441 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3442
3443 @itemize @bullet
3444 @item
3445 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3446 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3447 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3448 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3449 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3450 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3451 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3452 disabled within interactive calls.
3453
3454 @item
3455 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3456
3457 @item
3458 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3459 @end itemize
3460
3461 @cindex raise exceptions
3462 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3463 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3464 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3465 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3466 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3467 out where the exception was raised.
3468
3469 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3470 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3471 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3472 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3473
3474 @smallexample
3475 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3476 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3477 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3478 @end smallexample
3479
3480 @noindent
3481 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3482 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3483 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3484
3485 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3486 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3487 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3488 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3489 raised.
3490
3491
3492 @node Delete Breaks
3493 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3494
3495 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3496 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3497 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3498 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3499 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3500 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3501
3502 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3503 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3504 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3505 their breakpoint numbers.
3506
3507 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3508 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3509 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3510
3511 @table @code
3512 @kindex clear
3513 @item clear
3514 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3515 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3516 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3517 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3518
3519 @item clear @var{function}
3520 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3521 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3522
3523 @item clear @var{linenum}
3524 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3525 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3526 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3527
3528 @cindex delete breakpoints
3529 @kindex delete
3530 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3531 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3532 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3533 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3534 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3535 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3536 @end table
3537
3538 @node Disabling
3539 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3540
3541 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3542 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3543 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3544 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3545 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3546
3547 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3548 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3549 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3550 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3551 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3552
3553 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3554 affects all of its locations.
3555
3556 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3557 states of enablement:
3558
3559 @itemize @bullet
3560 @item
3561 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3562 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3563 @item
3564 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3565 @item
3566 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3567 disabled.
3568 @item
3569 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3570 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3571 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3572 @end itemize
3573
3574 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3575 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3576
3577 @table @code
3578 @kindex disable
3579 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3580 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3581 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3582 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3583 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3584 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3585 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3586
3587 @kindex enable
3588 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3589 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3590 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3591
3592 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3593 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3594 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3595
3596 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3597 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3598 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3599 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3600 @end table
3601
3602 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3603 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3604 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3605 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3606 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3607 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3608 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3609 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3610 Stepping}.)
3611
3612 @node Conditions
3613 @subsection Break Conditions
3614 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3615 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3616
3617 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3618 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3619 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3620 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3621 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3622 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3623 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3624 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3625
3626 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3627 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3628 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3629 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3630 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3631
3632 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3633 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3634 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3635 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3636 one.
3637
3638 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3639 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3640 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3641 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3642 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3643 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3644 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3645 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3646 conditions for the
3647 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3648 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3649
3650 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3651 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3652 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3653 with the @code{condition} command.
3654
3655 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3656 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3657 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3658 catchpoint.
3659
3660 @table @code
3661 @kindex condition
3662 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3663 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3664 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3665 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3666 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3667 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3668 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3669 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3670 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3671 prints an error message:
3672
3673 @smallexample
3674 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3675 @end smallexample
3676
3677 @noindent
3678 @value{GDBN} does
3679 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3680 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3681 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3682
3683 @item condition @var{bnum}
3684 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3685 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3686 @end table
3687
3688 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3689 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3690 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3691 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3692 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3693 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3694 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3695 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3696 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3697 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3698 your program reaches it.
3699
3700 @table @code
3701 @kindex ignore
3702 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3703 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3704 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3705 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3706 takes no action.
3707
3708 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3709 a count of zero.
3710
3711 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3712 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3713 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3714 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3715
3716 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3717 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3718 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3719
3720 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3721 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3722 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3723 Variables}.
3724 @end table
3725
3726 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3727
3728
3729 @node Break Commands
3730 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3731
3732 @cindex breakpoint commands
3733 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3734 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3735 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3736 enable other breakpoints.
3737
3738 @table @code
3739 @kindex commands
3740 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3741 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3742 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3743 @itemx end
3744 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3745 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3746 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3747
3748 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3749 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3750
3751 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3752 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3753 recently encountered).
3754 @end table
3755
3756 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3757 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3758
3759 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3760 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3761 that resumes execution.
3762
3763 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3764 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3765 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3766 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3767 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3768
3769 @kindex silent
3770 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3771 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3772 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3773 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3774 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3775 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3776
3777 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3778 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3779 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3780
3781 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3782 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3783
3784 @smallexample
3785 break foo if x>0
3786 commands
3787 silent
3788 printf "x is %d\n",x
3789 cont
3790 end
3791 @end smallexample
3792
3793 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3794 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3795 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3796 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3797 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3798 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3799 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3800
3801 @smallexample
3802 break 403
3803 commands
3804 silent
3805 set x = y + 4
3806 cont
3807 end
3808 @end smallexample
3809
3810 @node Breakpoint Menus
3811 @subsection Breakpoint Menus
3812 @cindex overloading
3813 @cindex symbol overloading
3814
3815 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3816 single function name
3817 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3818 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3819 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3820 a breakpoint. You can use explicit signature of the function, as in
3821 @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})}, to specify which
3822 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3823 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3824 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3825 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3826 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3827 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3828 breakpoints.
3829
3830 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3831 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3832 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3833
3834 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3835 @smallexample
3836 @group
3837 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3838 [0] cancel
3839 [1] all
3840 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3841 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3842 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3843 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3844 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3845 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3846 > 2 4 6
3847 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3848 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3849 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3850 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3851 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3852 breakpoints.
3853 (@value{GDBP})
3854 @end group
3855 @end smallexample
3856
3857 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3858 @node Error in Breakpoints
3859 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3860 @c
3861 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3862 @c
3863 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3864 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3865 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3866 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3867
3868 @smallexample
3869 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3870 The same program may be running in another process.
3871 @end smallexample
3872
3873 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3874
3875 @enumerate
3876 @item
3877 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3878
3879 @item
3880 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3881 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3882 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3883 Then start your program again.
3884
3885 @item
3886 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3887 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3888 to nonsharable executables.
3889 @end enumerate
3890 @c @end ifclear
3891
3892 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3893 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3894
3895 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3896 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3897 @smallexample
3898 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3899 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3900 @end smallexample
3901
3902 @noindent
3903 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3904 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3905 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3906
3907 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3908 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3909
3910 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3911 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3912 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3913
3914 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3915 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3916 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3917 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3918
3919 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3920 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3921 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3922 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3923 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3924 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3925 first in the bundle.
3926
3927 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3928 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3929 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3930 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3931 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3932 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3933 is hit.
3934
3935 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3936 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3937
3938 @smallexample
3939 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3940 @end smallexample
3941
3942 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3943 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3944 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3945 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3946 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3947 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3948 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3949 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3950
3951 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3952 adjusted breakpoints:
3953
3954 @smallexample
3955 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3956 to 0x00010410.
3957 @end smallexample
3958
3959 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3960 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3961 frequently than expected.
3962
3963 @node Continuing and Stepping
3964 @section Continuing and Stepping
3965
3966 @cindex stepping
3967 @cindex continuing
3968 @cindex resuming execution
3969 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3970 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3971 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3972 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3973 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3974 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3975 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3976 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3977
3978 @table @code
3979 @kindex continue
3980 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3981 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3982 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3983 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3984 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3985 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3986 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3987 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3988 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3989 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3990
3991 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3992 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3993 @code{continue} is ignored.
3994
3995 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3996 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3997 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3998 @code{continue}.
3999 @end table
4000
4001 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4002 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4003 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4004 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4005
4006 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4007 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4008 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4009 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4010 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4011 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4012
4013 @table @code
4014 @kindex step
4015 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4016 @item step
4017 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4018 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4019 abbreviated @code{s}.
4020
4021 @quotation
4022 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4023 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4024 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4025 @c distinction here.
4026 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4027 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4028 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4029 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4030 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4031 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4032 below.
4033 @end quotation
4034
4035 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4036 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4037 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4038 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4039 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4040 called within the line.
4041
4042 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4043 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4044 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4045 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4046 was any debugging information about the routine.
4047
4048 @item step @var{count}
4049 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4050 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4051 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4052
4053 @kindex next
4054 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4055 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4056 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4057 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4058 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4059 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4060 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4061 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4062
4063 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4064
4065
4066 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4067 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4068 @c
4069 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4070 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4071 @c function are executed without stopping.
4072
4073 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4074 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4075 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4076
4077 @kindex set step-mode
4078 @item set step-mode
4079 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4080 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4081 @itemx set step-mode on
4082 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4083 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4084 information rather than stepping over it.
4085
4086 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4087 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4088 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4089
4090 @item set step-mode off
4091 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4092 debug information. This is the default.
4093
4094 @item show step-mode
4095 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4096 source line debug information.
4097
4098 @kindex finish
4099 @item finish
4100 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4101 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4102
4103 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4104 ,Returning from a Function}).
4105
4106 @kindex until
4107 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4108 @cindex run until specified location
4109 @item until
4110 @itemx u
4111 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4112 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4113 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4114 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4115 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4116 than the address of the jump.
4117
4118 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4119 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4120 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4121 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4122 through the next iteration.
4123
4124 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4125 stack frame.
4126
4127 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4128 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4129 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4130 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4131 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4132
4133 @smallexample
4134 (@value{GDBP}) f
4135 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4136 206 expand_input();
4137 (@value{GDBP}) until
4138 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4139 @end smallexample
4140
4141 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4142 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4143 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4144 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4145 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4146 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4147 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4148
4149 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4150 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4151 argument.
4152
4153 @item until @var{location}
4154 @itemx u @var{location}
4155 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4156 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4157 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4158 ,Setting Breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4159 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4160 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4161 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4162 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4163 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4164 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4165 invocations have returned.
4166
4167 @smallexample
4168 94 int factorial (int value)
4169 95 @{
4170 96 if (value > 1) @{
4171 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4172 98 @}
4173 99 return (value);
4174 100 @}
4175 @end smallexample
4176
4177
4178 @kindex advance @var{location}
4179 @itemx advance @var{location}
4180 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4181 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4182 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4183 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4184 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4185 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4186
4187
4188 @kindex stepi
4189 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4190 @item stepi
4191 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4192 @itemx si
4193 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4194
4195 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4196 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4197 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4198 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4199
4200 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4201
4202 @need 750
4203 @kindex nexti
4204 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4205 @item nexti
4206 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4207 @itemx ni
4208 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4209 proceed until the function returns.
4210
4211 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4212 @end table
4213
4214 @node Signals
4215 @section Signals
4216 @cindex signals
4217
4218 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4219 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4220 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4221 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4222 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4223 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4224 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4225 requested an alarm).
4226
4227 @cindex fatal signals
4228 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4229 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4230 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4231 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4232 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4233 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4234
4235 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4236 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4237 signal.
4238
4239 @cindex handling signals
4240 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4241 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4242 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4243 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4244 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4245
4246 @table @code
4247 @kindex info signals
4248 @kindex info handle
4249 @item info signals
4250 @itemx info handle
4251 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4252 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4253 the defined types of signals.
4254
4255 @item info signals @var{sig}
4256 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4257
4258 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4259
4260 @kindex handle
4261 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4262 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4263 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4264 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4265 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4266 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4267 say what change to make.
4268 @end table
4269
4270 @c @group
4271 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4272 Their full names are:
4273
4274 @table @code
4275 @item nostop
4276 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4277 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4278
4279 @item stop
4280 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4281 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4282
4283 @item print
4284 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4285
4286 @item noprint
4287 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4288 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4289
4290 @item pass
4291 @itemx noignore
4292 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4293 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4294 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4295
4296 @item nopass
4297 @itemx ignore
4298 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4299 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4300 @end table
4301 @c @end group
4302
4303 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4304 program until you
4305 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4306 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4307 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4308 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4309 program sees that signal when you continue.
4310
4311 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4312 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4313 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4314 erroneous signals.
4315
4316 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4317 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4318 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4319 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4320 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4321 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4322 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4323 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4324 Program a Signal}.
4325
4326 @node Thread Stops
4327 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4328
4329 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4330 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4331 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4332
4333 @table @code
4334 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4335 @cindex thread breakpoints
4336 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4337 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4338 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4339 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4340 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4341
4342 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4343 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4344 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4345 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4346 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4347
4348 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4349 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4350 program.
4351
4352 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4353 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4354 breakpoint condition, like this:
4355
4356 @smallexample
4357 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 @end table
4361
4362 @cindex stopped threads
4363 @cindex threads, stopped
4364 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4365 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4366 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4367 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4368 underfoot.
4369
4370 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4371 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4372 @cindex premature return from system calls
4373 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4374 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4375 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4376 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4377 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4378 stop execution.
4379
4380 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4381 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4382 style anyways.
4383
4384 For example, do not write code like this:
4385
4386 @smallexample
4387 sleep (10);
4388 @end smallexample
4389
4390 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4391 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4392
4393 Instead, write this:
4394
4395 @smallexample
4396 int unslept = 10;
4397 while (unslept > 0)
4398 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4399 @end smallexample
4400
4401 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4402 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4403 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4404 @value{GDBN}.
4405
4406 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4407 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4408 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4409 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4410
4411 @cindex continuing threads
4412 @cindex threads, continuing
4413 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4414 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4415 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4416
4417 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4418 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4419 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4420 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4421 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4422 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4423 stops.
4424
4425 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4426 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4427 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4428 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4429
4430 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4431 thread to run.
4432
4433 @table @code
4434 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4435 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4436 @cindex lock scheduler
4437 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4438 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4439 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4440 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4441 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4442 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4443 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4444 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4445 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4446 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4447 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4448
4449 @item show scheduler-locking
4450 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4451 @end table
4452
4453
4454 @node Stack
4455 @chapter Examining the Stack
4456
4457 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4458 stopped and how it got there.
4459
4460 @cindex call stack
4461 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4462 is generated.
4463 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4464 the arguments of the call,
4465 and the local variables of the function being called.
4466 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4467 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4468 stack}.
4469
4470 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4471 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4472
4473 @cindex selected frame
4474 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4475 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4476 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4477 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4478 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4479 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4480
4481 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4482 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4483 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4484
4485 @menu
4486 * Frames:: Stack frames
4487 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4488 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4489 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4490
4491 @end menu
4492
4493 @node Frames
4494 @section Stack Frames
4495
4496 @cindex frame, definition
4497 @cindex stack frame
4498 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4499 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4500 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4501 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4502 which the function is executing.
4503
4504 @cindex initial frame
4505 @cindex outermost frame
4506 @cindex innermost frame
4507 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4508 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4509 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4510 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4511 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4512 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4513 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4514 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4515
4516 @cindex frame pointer
4517 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4518 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4519 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4520 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4521 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4522 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4523
4524 @cindex frame number
4525 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4526 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4527 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4528 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4529 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4530
4531 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4532 @c underflow problems.
4533 @cindex frameless execution
4534 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4535 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4536 @smallexample
4537 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4538 @end smallexample
4539 generates functions without a frame.)
4540 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4541 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4542 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4543 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4544 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4545 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4546 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4547
4548 @table @code
4549 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4550 @cindex current stack frame
4551 @item frame @var{args}
4552 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4553 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4554 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4555 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4556
4557 @kindex select-frame
4558 @cindex selecting frame silently
4559 @item select-frame
4560 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4561 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4562 @code{frame}.
4563 @end table
4564
4565 @node Backtrace
4566 @section Backtraces
4567
4568 @cindex traceback
4569 @cindex call stack traces
4570 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4571 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4572 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4573 stack.
4574
4575 @table @code
4576 @kindex backtrace
4577 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4578 @item backtrace
4579 @itemx bt
4580 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4581 frames in the stack.
4582
4583 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4584 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4585
4586 @item backtrace @var{n}
4587 @itemx bt @var{n}
4588 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4589
4590 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4591 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4592 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4593
4594 @item backtrace full
4595 @itemx bt full
4596 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4597 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4598 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4599 number of frames to print, as described above.
4600 @end table
4601
4602 @kindex where
4603 @kindex info stack
4604 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4605 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4606
4607 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4608 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4609 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4610 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4611 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4612 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4613 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4614 multi-threaded program.
4615
4616 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4617 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4618 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4619 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4620 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4621 line number.
4622
4623 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4624 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4625
4626 @smallexample
4627 @group
4628 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4629 at builtin.c:993
4630 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4631 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4632 at macro.c:71
4633 (More stack frames follow...)
4634 @end group
4635 @end smallexample
4636
4637 @noindent
4638 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4639 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4640 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4641
4642 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4643 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4644 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4645 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4646 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4647 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4648 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4649 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4650 such a backtrace might look like:
4651
4652 @smallexample
4653 @group
4654 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4655 at builtin.c:993
4656 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4657 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4658 at macro.c:71
4659 (More stack frames follow...)
4660 @end group
4661 @end smallexample
4662
4663 @noindent
4664 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4665 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4666
4667 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4668 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4669 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4670
4671 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4672 @cindex program entry point
4673 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4674 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4675 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4676 @code{main}@footnote{
4677 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4678 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4679 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4680 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4681 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4682 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4683
4684 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4685 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4686
4687 @table @code
4688 @item set backtrace past-main
4689 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4690 @kindex set backtrace
4691 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4692
4693 @item set backtrace past-main off
4694 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4695 default.
4696
4697 @item show backtrace past-main
4698 @kindex show backtrace
4699 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4700
4701 @item set backtrace past-entry
4702 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4703 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4704 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4705 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4706
4707 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4708 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4709 application. This is the default.
4710
4711 @item show backtrace past-entry
4712 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4713
4714 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4715 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4716 @cindex backtrace limit
4717 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4718 unlimited.
4719
4720 @item show backtrace limit
4721 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4722 @end table
4723
4724 @node Selection
4725 @section Selecting a Frame
4726
4727 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4728 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4729 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4730 of the stack frame just selected.
4731
4732 @table @code
4733 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4734 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4735 @item frame @var{n}
4736 @itemx f @var{n}
4737 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4738 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4739 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4740 @code{main}.
4741
4742 @item frame @var{addr}
4743 @itemx f @var{addr}
4744 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4745 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4746 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4747 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4748 switches between them.
4749
4750 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4751 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4752
4753 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4754 pointer and a program counter.
4755
4756 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4757 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4758
4759 @kindex up
4760 @item up @var{n}
4761 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4762 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4763 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4764
4765 @kindex down
4766 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4767 @item down @var{n}
4768 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4769 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4770 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4771 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4772 @end table
4773
4774 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4775 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4776 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4777 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4778
4779 @need 1000
4780 For example:
4781
4782 @smallexample
4783 @group
4784 (@value{GDBP}) up
4785 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4786 at env.c:10
4787 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4788 @end group
4789 @end smallexample
4790
4791 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4792 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4793 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4794 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4795 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4796 for details.
4797
4798 @table @code
4799 @kindex down-silently
4800 @kindex up-silently
4801 @item up-silently @var{n}
4802 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4803 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4804 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4805 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4806 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4807 distracting.
4808 @end table
4809
4810 @node Frame Info
4811 @section Information About a Frame
4812
4813 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4814 stack frame.
4815
4816 @table @code
4817 @item frame
4818 @itemx f
4819 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4820 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4821 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4822 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4823 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4824
4825 @kindex info frame
4826 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4827 @item info frame
4828 @itemx info f
4829 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4830 including:
4831
4832 @itemize @bullet
4833 @item
4834 the address of the frame
4835 @item
4836 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4837 @item
4838 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4839 @item
4840 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4841 @item
4842 the address of the frame's arguments
4843 @item
4844 the address of the frame's local variables
4845 @item
4846 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4847 @item
4848 which registers were saved in the frame
4849 @end itemize
4850
4851 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4852 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4853 the usual conventions.
4854
4855 @item info frame @var{addr}
4856 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4857 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4858 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4859 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4860 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4861 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4862
4863 @kindex info args
4864 @item info args
4865 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4866
4867 @item info locals
4868 @kindex info locals
4869 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4870 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4871 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4872
4873 @kindex info catch
4874 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4875 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4876 @item info catch
4877 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4878 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4879 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4880 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4881 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4882
4883 @end table
4884
4885
4886 @node Source
4887 @chapter Examining Source Files
4888
4889 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4890 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4891 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4892 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4893 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4894 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4895 source files by explicit command.
4896
4897 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4898 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4899 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4900
4901 @menu
4902 * List:: Printing source lines
4903 * Edit:: Editing source files
4904 * Search:: Searching source files
4905 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4906 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4907 @end menu
4908
4909 @node List
4910 @section Printing Source Lines
4911
4912 @kindex list
4913 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4914 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4915 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4916 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4917
4918 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4919
4920 @table @code
4921 @item list @var{linenum}
4922 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4923 current source file.
4924
4925 @item list @var{function}
4926 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4927 @var{function}.
4928
4929 @item list
4930 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4931 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4932 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4933 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4934 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4935
4936 @item list -
4937 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4938 @end table
4939
4940 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4941 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4942 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4943
4944 @table @code
4945 @kindex set listsize
4946 @item set listsize @var{count}
4947 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4948 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4949
4950 @kindex show listsize
4951 @item show listsize
4952 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4953 @end table
4954
4955 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4956 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4957 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4958 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4959 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4960
4961 @cindex linespec
4962 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4963 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4964 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4965 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4966
4967 @table @code
4968 @item list @var{linespec}
4969 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4970
4971 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4972 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4973 linespecs.
4974
4975 @item list ,@var{last}
4976 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4977
4978 @item list @var{first},
4979 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4980
4981 @item list +
4982 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4983
4984 @item list -
4985 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4986
4987 @item list
4988 As described in the preceding table.
4989 @end table
4990
4991 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4992 kinds of linespec.
4993
4994 @table @code
4995 @item @var{number}
4996 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4997 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4998 the same source file as the first linespec.
4999
5000 @item +@var{offset}
5001 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
5002 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
5003 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
5004 first linespec.
5005
5006 @item -@var{offset}
5007 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
5008
5009 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
5010 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
5011
5012 @item @var{function}
5013 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5014 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5015
5016 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5017 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
5018 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
5019 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
5020 identically named functions in different source files.
5021
5022 @item *@var{address}
5023 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
5024 @var{address} may be any expression.
5025 @end table
5026
5027 @node Edit
5028 @section Editing Source Files
5029 @cindex editing source files
5030
5031 @kindex edit
5032 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5033 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5034 The editing program of your choice
5035 is invoked with the current line set to
5036 the active line in the program.
5037 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5038 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
5039
5040 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
5041
5042 @table @code
5043 @item edit
5044 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
5045
5046 @item edit @var{number}
5047 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5048
5049 @item edit @var{function}
5050 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5051
5052 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
5053 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
5054
5055 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
5056 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
5057 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
5058 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
5059 identically named functions in different source files.
5060
5061 @item edit *@var{address}
5062 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
5063 @var{address} may be any expression.
5064 @end table
5065
5066 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5067 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5068 @footnote{
5069 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5070 following command-line syntax:
5071 @smallexample
5072 ex +@var{number} file
5073 @end smallexample
5074 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5075 the file where to start editing.}.
5076 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5077 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5078 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5079 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5080 @smallexample
5081 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5082 export EDITOR
5083 gdb @dots{}
5084 @end smallexample
5085 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5086 @smallexample
5087 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5088 gdb @dots{}
5089 @end smallexample
5090
5091 @node Search
5092 @section Searching Source Files
5093 @cindex searching source files
5094
5095 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5096 regular expression.
5097
5098 @table @code
5099 @kindex search
5100 @kindex forward-search
5101 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5102 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5103 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5104 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5105 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5106 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5107 @code{fo}.
5108
5109 @kindex reverse-search
5110 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5111 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5112 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5113 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5114 this command as @code{rev}.
5115 @end table
5116
5117 @node Source Path
5118 @section Specifying Source Directories
5119
5120 @cindex source path
5121 @cindex directories for source files
5122 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5123 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5124 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5125 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5126 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5127 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5128 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5129
5130 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5131 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5132 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5133 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5134 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5135 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5136 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5137 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5138 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5139 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5140 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5141
5142 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5143 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5144 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5145 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5146 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5147 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5148
5149 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5150 source files.
5151
5152 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5153 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5154 each line is in the file.
5155
5156 @kindex directory
5157 @kindex dir
5158 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5159 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5160 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5161
5162 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5163 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5164
5165 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5166 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5167 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5168 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5169 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5170 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5171 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5172 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5173 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5174 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5175 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5176 name to look up the sources.
5177
5178 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5179 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5180 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5181 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5182 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5183 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5184 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5185 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5186
5187 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5188 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5189 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5190 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5191 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5192 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5193 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5194
5195 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5196 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5197 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5198 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5199 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5200 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5201 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5202 command.
5203
5204 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5205 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5206 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5207 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5208 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5209 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5210 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5211
5212 @table @code
5213 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5214 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5215 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5216 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5217 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5218 part of absolute file names) or
5219 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5220 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5221
5222 @kindex cdir
5223 @kindex cwd
5224 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5225 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5226 @cindex compilation directory
5227 @cindex current directory
5228 @cindex working directory
5229 @cindex directory, current
5230 @cindex directory, compilation
5231 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5232 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5233 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5234 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5235 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5236 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5237
5238 @item directory
5239 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5240
5241 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5242 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5243
5244 @item show directories
5245 @kindex show directories
5246 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5247
5248 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5249 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5250 @kindex set substitute-path
5251 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5252 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5253 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5254
5255 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5256 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5257
5258 @smallexample
5259 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5260 @end smallexample
5261
5262 @noindent
5263 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5264 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5265 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5266
5267 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5268 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5269 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5270 the substitution.
5271
5272 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5273
5274 @smallexample
5275 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5276 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5277 @end smallexample
5278
5279 @noindent
5280 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5281 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5282 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5283 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5284
5285
5286 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5287 @kindex unset substitute-path
5288 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5289 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5290 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5291
5292 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5293
5294 @item show substitute-path [path]
5295 @kindex show substitute-path
5296 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5297 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5298
5299 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5300 rules.
5301
5302 @end table
5303
5304 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5305 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5306 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5307
5308 @enumerate
5309 @item
5310 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5311
5312 @item
5313 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5314 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5315 directories in one command.
5316 @end enumerate
5317
5318 @node Machine Code
5319 @section Source and Machine Code
5320 @cindex source line and its code address
5321
5322 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5323 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5324 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5325 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5326 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5327 well as hex.
5328
5329 @table @code
5330 @kindex info line
5331 @item info line @var{linespec}
5332 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5333 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5334 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5335 Source Lines}).
5336 @end table
5337
5338 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5339 the object code for the first line of function
5340 @code{m4_changequote}:
5341
5342 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5343 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5344 @smallexample
5345 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5346 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5347 @end smallexample
5348
5349 @noindent
5350 @cindex code address and its source line
5351 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5352 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5353 @smallexample
5354 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5355 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5356 @end smallexample
5357
5358 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5359 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5360 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5361 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5362 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5363 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5364 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5365 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5366 Variables}).
5367
5368 @table @code
5369 @kindex disassemble
5370 @cindex assembly instructions
5371 @cindex instructions, assembly
5372 @cindex machine instructions
5373 @cindex listing machine instructions
5374 @item disassemble
5375 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5376 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5377 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5378 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5379 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5380 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5381 @end table
5382
5383 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5384 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5385
5386 @smallexample
5387 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5388 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5389 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5390 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5391 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5392 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5393 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5394 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5395 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5396 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5397 End of assembler dump.
5398 @end smallexample
5399
5400 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5401 mnemonics or other syntax.
5402
5403 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5404 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5405 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5406 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5407 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5408
5409 @table @code
5410 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5411 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5412 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5413 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5414 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5415 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5416
5417 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5418 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5419 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5420 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5421
5422 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5423 @item show disassembly-flavor
5424 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5425 @end table
5426
5427
5428 @node Data
5429 @chapter Examining Data
5430
5431 @cindex printing data
5432 @cindex examining data
5433 @kindex print
5434 @kindex inspect
5435 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5436 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5437 @c different window or something like that.
5438 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5439 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5440 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5441 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5442 Different Languages}).
5443
5444 @table @code
5445 @item print @var{expr}
5446 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5447 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5448 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5449 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5450 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5451 Formats}.
5452
5453 @item print
5454 @itemx print /@var{f}
5455 @cindex reprint the last value
5456 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5457 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5458 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5459 @end table
5460
5461 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5462 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5463 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5464
5465 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5466 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5467 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5468 Table}.
5469
5470 @menu
5471 * Expressions:: Expressions
5472 * Variables:: Program variables
5473 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5474 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5475 * Memory:: Examining memory
5476 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5477 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5478 * Value History:: Value history
5479 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5480 * Registers:: Registers
5481 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5482 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5483 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5484 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5485 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5486 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5487 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5488 character set than GDB does
5489 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5490 @end menu
5491
5492 @node Expressions
5493 @section Expressions
5494
5495 @cindex expressions
5496 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5497 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5498 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5499 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5500 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5501 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5502 @ref{Compilation}.
5503
5504 @cindex arrays in expressions
5505 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5506 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5507 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5508 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5509
5510 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5511 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5512 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5513 languages.
5514
5515 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5516 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5517
5518 @cindex casts, in expressions
5519 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5520 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5521 at that address in memory.
5522 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5523
5524 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5525 to programming languages:
5526
5527 @table @code
5528 @item @@
5529 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5530 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5531
5532 @item ::
5533 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5534 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5535
5536 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5537 @cindex type casting memory
5538 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5539 @cindex casts, to view memory
5540 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5541 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5542 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5543 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5544 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5545 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5546 @end table
5547
5548 @node Variables
5549 @section Program Variables
5550
5551 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5552 in your program.
5553
5554 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5555 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5556
5557 @itemize @bullet
5558 @item
5559 global (or file-static)
5560 @end itemize
5561
5562 @noindent or
5563
5564 @itemize @bullet
5565 @item
5566 visible according to the scope rules of the
5567 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5568 @end itemize
5569
5570 @noindent This means that in the function
5571
5572 @smallexample
5573 foo (a)
5574 int a;
5575 @{
5576 bar (a);
5577 @{
5578 int b = test ();
5579 bar (b);
5580 @}
5581 @}
5582 @end smallexample
5583
5584 @noindent
5585 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5586 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5587 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5588 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5589
5590 @cindex variable name conflict
5591 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5592 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5593 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5594 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5595 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5596 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5597 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5598
5599 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5600 @ifnotinfo
5601 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5602 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5603 @end ifnotinfo
5604 @smallexample
5605 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5606 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5607 @end smallexample
5608
5609 @noindent
5610 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5611 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5612 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5613 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5614
5615 @smallexample
5616 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5617 @end smallexample
5618
5619 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5620 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5621 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5622 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5623 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5624 @c conflict?? --mew
5625
5626 @cindex wrong values
5627 @cindex variable values, wrong
5628 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5629 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5630 @quotation
5631 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5632 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5633 scope, and just before exit.
5634 @end quotation
5635 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5636 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5637 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5638 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5639 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5640 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5641 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5642 variable definitions may be gone.
5643
5644 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5645 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5646 when compiling.
5647
5648 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5649 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5650 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5651 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5652 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5653 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5654 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5655
5656 @smallexample
5657 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5658 @end smallexample
5659
5660 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5661 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5662 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5663 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5664 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5665 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5666 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5667 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5668 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5669 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5670 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5671
5672 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5673 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5674 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5675 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5676
5677 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5678 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5679 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5680 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5681 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5682 For program code
5683
5684 @smallexample
5685 char var0[] = "A";
5686 signed char var1[] = "A";
5687 @end smallexample
5688
5689 You get during debugging
5690 @smallexample
5691 (gdb) print var0
5692 $1 = "A"
5693 (gdb) print var1
5694 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5695 @end smallexample
5696
5697 @node Arrays
5698 @section Artificial Arrays
5699
5700 @cindex artificial array
5701 @cindex arrays
5702 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5703 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5704 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5705 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5706 program.
5707
5708 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5709 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5710 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5711 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5712 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5713 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5714 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5715 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5716 example. If a program says
5717
5718 @smallexample
5719 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5720 @end smallexample
5721
5722 @noindent
5723 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5724
5725 @smallexample
5726 p *array@@len
5727 @end smallexample
5728
5729 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5730 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5731 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5732 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5733 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5734
5735 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5736 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5737 The value need not be in memory:
5738 @smallexample
5739 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5740 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5741 @end smallexample
5742
5743 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5744 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5745 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5746 @smallexample
5747 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5748 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5749 @end smallexample
5750
5751 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5752 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5753 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5754 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5755 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5756 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5757 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5758 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5759 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5760 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5761
5762 @smallexample
5763 set $i = 0
5764 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5765 @key{RET}
5766 @key{RET}
5767 @dots{}
5768 @end smallexample
5769
5770 @node Output Formats
5771 @section Output Formats
5772
5773 @cindex formatted output
5774 @cindex output formats
5775 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5776 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5777 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5778 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5779 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5780
5781 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5782 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5783 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5784 letters supported are:
5785
5786 @table @code
5787 @item x
5788 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5789 hexadecimal.
5790
5791 @item d
5792 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5793
5794 @item u
5795 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5796
5797 @item o
5798 Print as integer in octal.
5799
5800 @item t
5801 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5802 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5803 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5804 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5805
5806 @item a
5807 @cindex unknown address, locating
5808 @cindex locate address
5809 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5810 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5811 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5812
5813 @smallexample
5814 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5815 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5816 @end smallexample
5817
5818 @noindent
5819 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5820 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5821
5822 @item c
5823 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5824 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5825 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5826 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5827
5828 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
5829 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
5830 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
5831 data.
5832
5833 @item f
5834 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5835 using typical floating point syntax.
5836
5837 @item s
5838 @cindex printing strings
5839 @cindex printing byte arrays
5840 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
5841 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
5842 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
5843 natural types.
5844
5845 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
5846 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
5847 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
5848 array.
5849 @end table
5850
5851 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5852
5853 @smallexample
5854 p/x $pc
5855 @end smallexample
5856
5857 @noindent
5858 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5859 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5860
5861 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5862 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5863 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5864
5865 @node Memory
5866 @section Examining Memory
5867
5868 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5869 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5870
5871 @cindex examining memory
5872 @table @code
5873 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5874 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5875 @itemx x @var{addr}
5876 @itemx x
5877 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5878 @end table
5879
5880 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5881 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5882 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5883 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5884 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5885
5886 @table @r
5887 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5888 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5889 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5890 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5891 @c 4.1.2.
5892
5893 @item @var{f}, the display format
5894 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5895 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5896 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
5897 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
5898 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
5899
5900 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5901 The unit size is any of
5902
5903 @table @code
5904 @item b
5905 Bytes.
5906 @item h
5907 Halfwords (two bytes).
5908 @item w
5909 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5910 @item g
5911 Giant words (eight bytes).
5912 @end table
5913
5914 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5915 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5916 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5917
5918 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5919 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5920 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5921 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5922 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5923 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5924 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5925 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5926 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5927 a value from memory).
5928 @end table
5929
5930 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5931 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5932 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5933 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5934 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5935
5936 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5937 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5938 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5939 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5940 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5941
5942 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5943 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5944 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5945 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
5946 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
5947 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
5948 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
5949 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
5950 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
5951
5952 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5953 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5954 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5955 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5956 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5957 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5958 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5959
5960 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5961 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5962 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5963 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5964 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5965 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5966 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5967 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5968 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5969
5970 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5971 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5972 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5973
5974 @cindex remote memory comparison
5975 @cindex verify remote memory image
5976 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5977 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5978 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5979 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5980 situations.
5981
5982 @table @code
5983 @kindex compare-sections
5984 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5985 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5986 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5987 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5988 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5989 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5990 remote request.
5991 @end table
5992
5993 @node Auto Display
5994 @section Automatic Display
5995 @cindex automatic display
5996 @cindex display of expressions
5997
5998 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5999 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6000 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6001 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6002 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6003 The automatic display looks like this:
6004
6005 @smallexample
6006 2: foo = 38
6007 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6008 @end smallexample
6009
6010 @noindent
6011 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6012 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6013 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6014 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6015 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6016 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6017
6018 @table @code
6019 @kindex display
6020 @item display @var{expr}
6021 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6022 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6023
6024 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6025
6026 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6027 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6028 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6029 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6030 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6031
6032 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6033 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6034 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6035 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6036 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6037 @end table
6038
6039 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6040 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6041 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6042
6043 @table @code
6044 @kindex delete display
6045 @kindex undisplay
6046 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6047 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6048 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6049
6050 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6051 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6052
6053 @kindex disable display
6054 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6055 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6056 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6057 enabled again later.
6058
6059 @kindex enable display
6060 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6061 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6062 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6063
6064 @item display
6065 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6066 done when your program stops.
6067
6068 @kindex info display
6069 @item info display
6070 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6071 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6072 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6073 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6074 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6075 @end table
6076
6077 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6078 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6079 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6080 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6081 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6082 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6083 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6084 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6085 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6086 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6087 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6088
6089 @node Print Settings
6090 @section Print Settings
6091
6092 @cindex format options
6093 @cindex print settings
6094 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6095 and symbols are printed.
6096
6097 @noindent
6098 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6099
6100 @table @code
6101 @kindex set print
6102 @item set print address
6103 @itemx set print address on
6104 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6105 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6106 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6107 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6108 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6109 @code{set print address on}:
6110
6111 @smallexample
6112 @group
6113 (@value{GDBP}) f
6114 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6115 at input.c:530
6116 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6117 @end group
6118 @end smallexample
6119
6120 @item set print address off
6121 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6122 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6123
6124 @smallexample
6125 @group
6126 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6127 (@value{GDBP}) f
6128 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6129 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6130 @end group
6131 @end smallexample
6132
6133 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6134 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6135 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6136 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6137
6138 @kindex show print
6139 @item show print address
6140 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6141 @end table
6142
6143 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6144 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6145 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6146 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6147 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6148 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6149 it prints a symbolic address:
6150
6151 @table @code
6152 @item set print symbol-filename on
6153 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6154 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6155 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6156 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6157
6158 @item set print symbol-filename off
6159 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6160 default.
6161
6162 @item show print symbol-filename
6163 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6164 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6165 @end table
6166
6167 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6168 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6169 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6170
6171 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6172 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6173
6174 @table @code
6175 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6176 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6177 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6178 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6179 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6180 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6181
6182 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6183 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6184 symbolic address.
6185 @end table
6186
6187 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6188 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6189 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6190 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6191 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6192 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6193 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6194 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6195
6196 @smallexample
6197 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6198 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6199 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6200 @end smallexample
6201
6202 @quotation
6203 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6204 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6205 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6206 @end quotation
6207
6208 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6209
6210 @table @code
6211 @item set print array
6212 @itemx set print array on
6213 @cindex pretty print arrays
6214 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6215 but uses more space. The default is off.
6216
6217 @item set print array off
6218 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6219
6220 @item show print array
6221 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6222 arrays.
6223
6224 @cindex print array indexes
6225 @item set print array-indexes
6226 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6227 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6228 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6229 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6230
6231 @item set print array-indexes off
6232 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6233
6234 @item show print array-indexes
6235 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6236 arrays.
6237
6238 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6239 @cindex number of array elements to print
6240 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6241 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6242 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6243 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6244 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6245 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6246 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6247
6248 @item show print elements
6249 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6250 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6251
6252 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6253 @cindex printing frame argument values
6254 @cindex print all frame argument values
6255 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6256 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6257 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6258 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6259 values are:
6260
6261 @table @code
6262 @item all
6263 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6264
6265 @item scalars
6266 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6267 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6268 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6269
6270 @smallexample
6271 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6272 at frame-args.c:23
6273 @end smallexample
6274
6275 @item none
6276 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6277 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6278
6279 @smallexample
6280 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6281 at frame-args.c:23
6282 @end smallexample
6283 @end table
6284
6285 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6286 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6287 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6288 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6289 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6290 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6291 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6292 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6293
6294 @item show print frame-arguments
6295 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6296
6297 @item set print repeats
6298 @cindex repeated array elements
6299 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6300 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6301 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6302 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6303 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6304 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6305 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6306
6307 @item show print repeats
6308 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6309 elements.
6310
6311 @item set print null-stop
6312 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6313 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6314 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6315 contain only short strings.
6316 The default is off.
6317
6318 @item show print null-stop
6319 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6320 @sc{null} character.
6321
6322 @item set print pretty on
6323 @cindex print structures in indented form
6324 @cindex indentation in structure display
6325 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6326 per line, like this:
6327
6328 @smallexample
6329 @group
6330 $1 = @{
6331 next = 0x0,
6332 flags = @{
6333 sweet = 1,
6334 sour = 1
6335 @},
6336 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6337 @}
6338 @end group
6339 @end smallexample
6340
6341 @item set print pretty off
6342 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6343
6344 @smallexample
6345 @group
6346 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6347 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6348 @end group
6349 @end smallexample
6350
6351 @noindent
6352 This is the default format.
6353
6354 @item show print pretty
6355 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6356
6357 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6358 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6359 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6360 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6361 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6362 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6363 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6364 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6365
6366 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6367 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6368 international character sets, and is the default.
6369
6370 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6371 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6372
6373 @item set print union on
6374 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6375 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6376 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6377
6378 @item set print union off
6379 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6380 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6381 instead.
6382
6383 @item show print union
6384 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6385 structures and other unions.
6386
6387 For example, given the declarations
6388
6389 @smallexample
6390 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6391 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6392 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6393 Bug_forms;
6394
6395 struct thing @{
6396 Species it;
6397 union @{
6398 Tree_forms tree;
6399 Bug_forms bug;
6400 @} form;
6401 @};
6402
6403 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6404 @end smallexample
6405
6406 @noindent
6407 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6408
6409 @smallexample
6410 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6411 @end smallexample
6412
6413 @noindent
6414 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6415
6416 @smallexample
6417 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6418 @end smallexample
6419
6420 @noindent
6421 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6422 and in Pascal.
6423 @end table
6424
6425 @need 1000
6426 @noindent
6427 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6428
6429 @table @code
6430 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6431 @item set print demangle
6432 @itemx set print demangle on
6433 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6434 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6435 linkage. The default is on.
6436
6437 @item show print demangle
6438 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6439
6440 @item set print asm-demangle
6441 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6442 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6443 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6444 The default is off.
6445
6446 @item show print asm-demangle
6447 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6448 or demangled form.
6449
6450 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6451 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6452 @kindex set demangle-style
6453 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6454 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6455 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6456
6457 @table @code
6458 @item auto
6459 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6460
6461 @item gnu
6462 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6463 This is the default.
6464
6465 @item hp
6466 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6467
6468 @item lucid
6469 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6470
6471 @item arm
6472 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6473 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6474 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6475 require further enhancement to permit that.
6476
6477 @end table
6478 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6479
6480 @item show demangle-style
6481 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6482
6483 @item set print object
6484 @itemx set print object on
6485 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6486 @cindex display derived types
6487 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6488 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6489 the virtual function table.
6490
6491 @item set print object off
6492 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6493 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6494
6495 @item show print object
6496 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6497
6498 @item set print static-members
6499 @itemx set print static-members on
6500 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6501 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6502
6503 @item set print static-members off
6504 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6505
6506 @item show print static-members
6507 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6508
6509 @item set print pascal_static-members
6510 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6511 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6512 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6513 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6514
6515 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6516 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6517
6518 @item show print pascal_static-members
6519 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6520
6521 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6522 @item set print vtbl
6523 @itemx set print vtbl on
6524 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6525 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6526 @cindex VTBL display
6527 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6528 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6529 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6530
6531 @item set print vtbl off
6532 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6533
6534 @item show print vtbl
6535 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6536 @end table
6537
6538 @node Value History
6539 @section Value History
6540
6541 @cindex value history
6542 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6543 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6544 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6545 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6546 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6547 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6548 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6549 symbol table.
6550
6551 @cindex @code{$}
6552 @cindex @code{$$}
6553 @cindex history number
6554 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6555 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6556 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6557 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6558 history number.
6559
6560 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6561 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6562 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6563 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6564 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6565 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6566 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6567
6568 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6569 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6570
6571 @smallexample
6572 p *$
6573 @end smallexample
6574
6575 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6576 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6577
6578 @smallexample
6579 p *$.next
6580 @end smallexample
6581
6582 @noindent
6583 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6584 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6585
6586 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6587 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6588
6589 @smallexample
6590 print x
6591 set x=5
6592 @end smallexample
6593
6594 @noindent
6595 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6596 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6597
6598 @table @code
6599 @kindex show values
6600 @item show values
6601 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6602 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6603 values} does not change the history.
6604
6605 @item show values @var{n}
6606 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6607
6608 @item show values +
6609 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6610 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6611 @end table
6612
6613 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6614 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6615
6616 @node Convenience Vars
6617 @section Convenience Variables
6618
6619 @cindex convenience variables
6620 @cindex user-defined variables
6621 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6622 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6623 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6624 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6625 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6626
6627 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6628 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6629 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6630 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6631 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6632
6633 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6634 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6635 For example:
6636
6637 @smallexample
6638 set $foo = *object_ptr
6639 @end smallexample
6640
6641 @noindent
6642 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6643 @code{object_ptr}.
6644
6645 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6646 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6647 value with another assignment at any time.
6648
6649 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6650 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6651 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6652 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6653
6654 @table @code
6655 @kindex show convenience
6656 @cindex show all user variables
6657 @item show convenience
6658 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6659 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6660
6661 @kindex init-if-undefined
6662 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6663 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6664 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6665 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6666 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6667 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6668 override default values used in a command script.
6669
6670 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6671 any side-effects do not occur.
6672 @end table
6673
6674 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6675 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6676 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6677
6678 @smallexample
6679 set $i = 0
6680 print bar[$i++]->contents
6681 @end smallexample
6682
6683 @noindent
6684 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6685
6686 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6687 values likely to be useful.
6688
6689 @table @code
6690 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6691 @item $_
6692 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6693 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6694 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6695 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6696 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6697 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6698 to the type of @code{$__}.
6699
6700 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6701 @item $__
6702 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6703 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6704 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6705
6706 @item $_exitcode
6707 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6708 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6709 the program being debugged terminates.
6710 @end table
6711
6712 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6713 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6714 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6715
6716 @node Registers
6717 @section Registers
6718
6719 @cindex registers
6720 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6721 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6722 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6723 your machine.
6724
6725 @table @code
6726 @kindex info registers
6727 @item info registers
6728 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6729 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6730
6731 @kindex info all-registers
6732 @cindex floating point registers
6733 @item info all-registers
6734 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6735 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6736
6737 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6738 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6739 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6740 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6741 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6742 @end table
6743
6744 @cindex stack pointer register
6745 @cindex program counter register
6746 @cindex process status register
6747 @cindex frame pointer register
6748 @cindex standard registers
6749 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6750 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6751 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6752 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6753 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6754 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6755 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6756 you could print the program counter in hex with
6757
6758 @smallexample
6759 p/x $pc
6760 @end smallexample
6761
6762 @noindent
6763 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6764
6765 @smallexample
6766 x/i $pc
6767 @end smallexample
6768
6769 @noindent
6770 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6771 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6772 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6773 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6774 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6775 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6776 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6777
6778 @smallexample
6779 set $sp += 4
6780 @end smallexample
6781
6782 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6783 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6784 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6785 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6786 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6787 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6788 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6789
6790 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6791 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6792 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6793 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6794 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6795 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6796 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6797
6798 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6799 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6800 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6801 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6802 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6803 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6804 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6805 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6806 prints the data in both formats.
6807
6808 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6809 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6810 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6811 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6812 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6813 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6814 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6815
6816 @smallexample
6817 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6818 $1 = @{
6819 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6820 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6821 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6822 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6823 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6824 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6825 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6826 @}
6827 @end smallexample
6828
6829 @noindent
6830 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6831 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6832 value to a @code{struct} member:
6833
6834 @smallexample
6835 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6836 @end smallexample
6837
6838 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6839 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6840 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6841 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6842 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6843 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6844
6845 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6846 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6847 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6848 frame makes no difference.
6849
6850 @node Floating Point Hardware
6851 @section Floating Point Hardware
6852 @cindex floating point
6853
6854 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6855 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6856
6857 @table @code
6858 @kindex info float
6859 @item info float
6860 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6861 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6862 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6863 the ARM and x86 machines.
6864 @end table
6865
6866 @node Vector Unit
6867 @section Vector Unit
6868 @cindex vector unit
6869
6870 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6871 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6872
6873 @table @code
6874 @kindex info vector
6875 @item info vector
6876 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6877 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6878 @end table
6879
6880 @node OS Information
6881 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
6882 @cindex OS information
6883
6884 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6885 you debug your program.
6886
6887 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6888 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6889 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6890 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6891 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6892 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6893 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6894 structure.
6895
6896 @table @code
6897 @item info udot
6898 @kindex info udot
6899 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6900 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6901 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6902 the @code{examine} command.
6903 @end table
6904
6905 @cindex auxiliary vector
6906 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6907 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6908 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6909 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6910 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6911 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6912 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6913 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6914 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6915 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6916 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6917 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6918
6919 @table @code
6920 @kindex info auxv
6921 @item info auxv
6922 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6923 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6924 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6925 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6926 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6927 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6928 an unrecognized tag.
6929 @end table
6930
6931
6932 @node Memory Region Attributes
6933 @section Memory Region Attributes
6934 @cindex memory region attributes
6935
6936 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6937 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6938 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6939 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6940 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6941 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6942 user can override the fetched regions.
6943
6944 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6945 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6946 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6947 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6948 all memory.
6949
6950 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6951 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6952
6953 @table @code
6954 @kindex mem
6955 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6956 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6957 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6958 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6959 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
6960 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6961
6962 @item mem auto
6963 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6964 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6965
6966 @kindex delete mem
6967 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6968 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6969 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6970
6971 @kindex disable mem
6972 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6973 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6974 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6975 It may be enabled again later.
6976
6977 @kindex enable mem
6978 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6979 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6980
6981 @kindex info mem
6982 @item info mem
6983 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6984 for each region:
6985
6986 @table @emph
6987 @item Memory Region Number
6988 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6989 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6990 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6991
6992 @item Lo Address
6993 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6994
6995 @item Hi Address
6996 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6997
6998 @item Attributes
6999 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7000 @end table
7001 @end table
7002
7003
7004 @subsection Attributes
7005
7006 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7007 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7008 write accesses to a memory region.
7009
7010 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7011 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7012 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7013
7014 @table @code
7015 @item ro
7016 Memory is read only.
7017 @item wo
7018 Memory is write only.
7019 @item rw
7020 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7021 @end table
7022
7023 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7024 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7025 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7026 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7027 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7028
7029 @table @code
7030 @item 8
7031 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7032 @item 16
7033 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7034 @item 32
7035 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7036 @item 64
7037 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7038 @end table
7039
7040 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7041 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7042 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7043 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7044 @c
7045 @c @table @code
7046 @c @item hwbreak
7047 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7048 @c @item swbreak (default)
7049 @c @end table
7050
7051 @subsubsection Data Cache
7052 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7053 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7054 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7055 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7056 registers.
7057
7058 @table @code
7059 @item cache
7060 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7061 @item nocache
7062 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7063 @end table
7064
7065 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7066 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7067 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7068 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7069 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7070
7071 @table @code
7072 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7073 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7074 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7075 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7076 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7077 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7078 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7079 The default value is @code{on}.
7080 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7081 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7082 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7083 @end table
7084
7085
7086 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7087 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7088 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7089 @c
7090 @c @table @code
7091 @c @item verify
7092 @c @item noverify (default)
7093 @c @end table
7094
7095 @node Dump/Restore Files
7096 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7097 @cindex dump/restore files
7098 @cindex append data to a file
7099 @cindex dump data to a file
7100 @cindex restore data from a file
7101
7102 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7103 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7104 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7105 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7106 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7107 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7108 files.
7109
7110 @table @code
7111
7112 @kindex dump
7113 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7114 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7115 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7116 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7117
7118 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7119 @table @code
7120 @item binary
7121 Raw binary form.
7122 @item ihex
7123 Intel hex format.
7124 @item srec
7125 Motorola S-record format.
7126 @item tekhex
7127 Tektronix Hex format.
7128 @end table
7129
7130 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7131 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7132 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7133 form.
7134
7135 @kindex append
7136 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7137 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7138 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7139 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7140 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7141
7142 @kindex restore
7143 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7144 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7145 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7146 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7147 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7148
7149 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7150 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7151 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7152 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7153 from that location.
7154
7155 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7156 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7157 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7158 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7159
7160 @end table
7161
7162 @node Core File Generation
7163 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7164 @cindex dump core from inferior
7165
7166 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7167 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7168 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7169 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7170 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7171 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7172 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7173
7174 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7175 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7176 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7177
7178 @table @code
7179 @kindex gcore
7180 @kindex generate-core-file
7181 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7182 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7183 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7184 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7185 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7186 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7187
7188 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7189 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7190 @end table
7191
7192 @node Character Sets
7193 @section Character Sets
7194 @cindex character sets
7195 @cindex charset
7196 @cindex translating between character sets
7197 @cindex host character set
7198 @cindex target character set
7199
7200 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7201 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7202 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7203 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7204 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7205 @dfn{target character set}.
7206
7207 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7208 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7209 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7210 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7211 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7212 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7213 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7214 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7215 character and string literals in expressions.
7216
7217 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7218 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7219 target-charset} command, described below.
7220
7221 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7222 support:
7223
7224 @table @code
7225 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7226 @kindex set target-charset
7227 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7228 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7229 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7230 list the target character sets it supports.
7231 @end table
7232
7233 @table @code
7234 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7235 @kindex set host-charset
7236 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7237
7238 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7239 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7240 @code{set host-charset} command.
7241
7242 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7243 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7244 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7245 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7246 list the host character sets it supports.
7247
7248 @item set charset @var{charset}
7249 @kindex set charset
7250 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7251 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7252 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7253 for both host and target.
7254
7255
7256 @item show charset
7257 @kindex show charset
7258 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7259
7260 @itemx show host-charset
7261 @kindex show host-charset
7262 Show the name of the current host charset.
7263
7264 @itemx show target-charset
7265 @kindex show target-charset
7266 Show the name of the current target charset.
7267
7268 @end table
7269
7270 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7271 sets:
7272
7273 @table @code
7274
7275 @item ASCII
7276 @cindex ASCII character set
7277 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7278 character set.
7279
7280 @item ISO-8859-1
7281 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7282 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7283 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7284 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7285 this as its host character set.
7286
7287 @item EBCDIC-US
7288 @itemx IBM1047
7289 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7290 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7291 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7292 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7293 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7294
7295 @end table
7296
7297 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7298 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7299 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7300
7301 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7302 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7303 @file{charset-test.c}:
7304
7305 @smallexample
7306 #include <stdio.h>
7307
7308 char ascii_hello[]
7309 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7310 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7311 char ibm1047_hello[]
7312 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7313 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7314
7315 main ()
7316 @{
7317 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7318 @}
7319 @end smallexample
7320
7321 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7322 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7323 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7324
7325 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7326
7327 @smallexample
7328 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7329 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7330 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7331 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7332 @dots{}
7333 (@value{GDBP})
7334 @end smallexample
7335
7336 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7337 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7338 strings:
7339
7340 @smallexample
7341 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7342 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7343 (@value{GDBP})
7344 @end smallexample
7345
7346 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7347 initial character set:
7348 @smallexample
7349 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7350 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7351 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7352 (@value{GDBP})
7353 @end smallexample
7354
7355 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7356 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7357 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7358 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7359 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7360
7361 @smallexample
7362 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7363 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7364 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7365 $2 = 72 'H'
7366 (@value{GDBP})
7367 @end smallexample
7368
7369 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7370 literals you use in expressions:
7371
7372 @smallexample
7373 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7374 $3 = 43 '+'
7375 (@value{GDBP})
7376 @end smallexample
7377
7378 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7379 character.
7380
7381 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7382 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7383 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7384
7385 @smallexample
7386 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7387 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7388 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7389 $5 = 200 '\310'
7390 (@value{GDBP})
7391 @end smallexample
7392
7393 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7394 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7395
7396 @smallexample
7397 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7398 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7399 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7400 @end smallexample
7401
7402 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7403 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7404 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7405 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7406 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7407
7408 @smallexample
7409 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7410 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7411 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7412 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7413 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7414 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7415 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7416 $7 = 72 '\110'
7417 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7418 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7419 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7420 $9 = 200 'H'
7421 (@value{GDBP})
7422 @end smallexample
7423
7424 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7425 string literals you use in expressions:
7426
7427 @smallexample
7428 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7429 $10 = 78 '+'
7430 (@value{GDBP})
7431 @end smallexample
7432
7433 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7434 character.
7435
7436 @node Caching Remote Data
7437 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7438 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7439
7440 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7441 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7442 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7443 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7444 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7445 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7446 volatile registers are in use.
7447
7448 @table @code
7449 @kindex set remotecache
7450 @item set remotecache on
7451 @itemx set remotecache off
7452 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7453 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7454
7455 @kindex show remotecache
7456 @item show remotecache
7457 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7458
7459 @kindex info dcache
7460 @item info dcache
7461 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7462 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7463 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7464 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7465 the data cache operation.
7466 @end table
7467
7468
7469 @node Macros
7470 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7471
7472 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7473 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7474 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7475 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7476 where it was defined.
7477
7478 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7479 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7480 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7481 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7482
7483 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7484 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7485 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7486 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7487 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7488 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7489 see @ref{List}.
7490
7491 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7492 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7493 variable-arity macros.
7494
7495 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7496 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7497 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7498
7499 @table @code
7500
7501 @kindex macro expand
7502 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7503 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7504 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7505 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7506 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7507 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7508 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7509 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7510 it can be any string of tokens.
7511
7512 @kindex macro exp1
7513 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7514 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7515 @cindex expand macro once
7516 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7517 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7518 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7519 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7520 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7521 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7522 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7523 can be any string of tokens.
7524
7525 @kindex info macro
7526 @cindex macro definition, showing
7527 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7528 @item info macro @var{macro}
7529 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7530 source location where that definition was established.
7531
7532 @kindex macro define
7533 @cindex user-defined macros
7534 @cindex defining macros interactively
7535 @cindex macros, user-defined
7536 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7537 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7538 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7539 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7540 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7541 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7542 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7543 given in @var{arglist}.
7544
7545 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7546 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7547 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7548 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7549 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7550
7551 @kindex macro undef
7552 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7553 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7554 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7555 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7556 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7557 debugged.
7558
7559 @kindex macro list
7560 @item macro list
7561 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7562 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7563 @end table
7564
7565 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7566 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7567 show our source files:
7568
7569 @smallexample
7570 $ cat sample.c
7571 #include <stdio.h>
7572 #include "sample.h"
7573
7574 #define M 42
7575 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7576
7577 main ()
7578 @{
7579 #define N 28
7580 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7581 #undef N
7582 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7583 #define N 1729
7584 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7585 @}
7586 $ cat sample.h
7587 #define Q <
7588 $
7589 @end smallexample
7590
7591 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7592 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7593 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7594 information.
7595
7596 @smallexample
7597 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7598 $
7599 @end smallexample
7600
7601 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7602
7603 @smallexample
7604 $ gdb -nw sample
7605 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7606 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7607 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7608 (@value{GDBP})
7609 @end smallexample
7610
7611 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7612 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7613 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7614
7615 @smallexample
7616 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7617 3
7618 4 #define M 42
7619 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7620 6
7621 7 main ()
7622 8 @{
7623 9 #define N 28
7624 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7625 11 #undef N
7626 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7627 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7628 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7629 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7630 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7631 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7632 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7633 #define Q <
7634 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7635 expands to: (42 + 1)
7636 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7637 expands to: once (M + 1)
7638 (@value{GDBP})
7639 @end smallexample
7640
7641 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7642 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7643 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7644 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7645
7646 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7647 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7648
7649 @smallexample
7650 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7651 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7652 (@value{GDBP}) run
7653 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7654
7655 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7656 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7657 (@value{GDBP})
7658 @end smallexample
7659
7660 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7661
7662 @smallexample
7663 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7664 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7665 #define N 28
7666 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7667 expands to: 28 < 42
7668 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7669 $1 = 1
7670 (@value{GDBP})
7671 @end smallexample
7672
7673 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7674 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7675 thereof) in force at each point:
7676
7677 @smallexample
7678 (@value{GDBP}) next
7679 Hello, world!
7680 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7681 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7682 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7683 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7684 (@value{GDBP}) next
7685 We're so creative.
7686 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7687 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7688 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7689 #define N 1729
7690 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7691 expands to: 1729 < 42
7692 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7693 $2 = 0
7694 (@value{GDBP})
7695 @end smallexample
7696
7697
7698 @node Tracepoints
7699 @chapter Tracepoints
7700 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7701 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7702
7703 @cindex tracepoints
7704 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7705 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7706 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7707 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7708 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7709 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7710 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7711
7712 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7713 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7714 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7715 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7716 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7717 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7718 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7719 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7720 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7721 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7722 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7723
7724 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7725 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7726 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7727 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7728 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7729 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7730 Packets}.
7731
7732 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7733
7734 @menu
7735 * Set Tracepoints::
7736 * Analyze Collected Data::
7737 * Tracepoint Variables::
7738 @end menu
7739
7740 @node Set Tracepoints
7741 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7742
7743 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7744 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7745 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7746 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7747 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7748 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7749 work on.
7750
7751 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7752 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7753 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7754 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7755 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7756 tracepoint was hit.
7757
7758 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7759 conditions and actions.
7760
7761 @menu
7762 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7763 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7764 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7765 * Tracepoint Actions::
7766 * Listing Tracepoints::
7767 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7768 @end menu
7769
7770 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7771 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7772
7773 @table @code
7774 @cindex set tracepoint
7775 @kindex trace
7776 @item trace
7777 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7778 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7779 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7780 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7781 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7782 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7783 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7784 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7785 running.
7786
7787 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7788
7789 @smallexample
7790 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7791
7792 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7793
7794 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7795
7796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7797
7798 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7799 @end smallexample
7800
7801 @noindent
7802 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7803
7804 @vindex $tpnum
7805 @cindex last tracepoint number
7806 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7807 @cindex tracepoint number
7808 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7809 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7810
7811 @kindex delete tracepoint
7812 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7813 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7814 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7815 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7816
7817 Examples:
7818
7819 @smallexample
7820 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7821
7822 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7823 @end smallexample
7824
7825 @noindent
7826 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7827 @end table
7828
7829 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7830 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7831
7832 @table @code
7833 @kindex disable tracepoint
7834 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7835 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7836 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7837 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7838 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7839
7840 @kindex enable tracepoint
7841 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7842 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7843 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7844 run.
7845 @end table
7846
7847 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7848 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7849
7850 @table @code
7851 @kindex passcount
7852 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7853 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7854 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7855 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7856 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7857 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7858 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7859 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7860 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7861 user.
7862
7863 Examples:
7864
7865 @smallexample
7866 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7867 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7868
7869 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7870 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7871 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7872 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7873 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7874 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7875 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7876 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7877 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7878 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7879 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7880 @end smallexample
7881 @end table
7882
7883 @node Tracepoint Actions
7884 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7885
7886 @table @code
7887 @kindex actions
7888 @cindex tracepoint actions
7889 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7890 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7891 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7892 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7893 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7894 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7895 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7896 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7897 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7898 @code{while-stepping}.
7899
7900 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7901 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7902 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7903
7904 @smallexample
7905 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7906
7907 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7908
7909 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7910 @end smallexample
7911
7912 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7913 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7914 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7915 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7916 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7917 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7918 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7919 @code{end} command.
7920
7921 @smallexample
7922 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7923 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7924 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7925 > collect bar,baz
7926 > collect $regs
7927 > while-stepping 12
7928 > collect $fp, $sp
7929 > end
7930 end
7931 @end smallexample
7932
7933 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7934 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7935 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7936 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7937 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7938 special arguments are supported:
7939
7940 @table @code
7941 @item $regs
7942 collect all registers
7943
7944 @item $args
7945 collect all function arguments
7946
7947 @item $locals
7948 collect all local variables.
7949 @end table
7950
7951 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7952 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7953 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7954
7955 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7956 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7957
7958 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7959 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7960 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7961 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7962 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7963 its own @code{end} command):
7964
7965 @smallexample
7966 > while-stepping 12
7967 > collect $regs, myglobal
7968 > end
7969 >
7970 @end smallexample
7971
7972 @noindent
7973 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7974 @code{stepping}.
7975 @end table
7976
7977 @node Listing Tracepoints
7978 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7979
7980 @table @code
7981 @kindex info tracepoints
7982 @kindex info tp
7983 @cindex information about tracepoints
7984 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7985 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7986 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7987 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7988 shown:
7989
7990 @itemize @bullet
7991 @item
7992 its number
7993 @item
7994 whether it is enabled or disabled
7995 @item
7996 its address
7997 @item
7998 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7999 @item
8000 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8001 @item
8002 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8003 @item
8004 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8005 @end itemize
8006
8007 @smallexample
8008 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8009 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8010 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8011 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8012 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8013 (@value{GDBP})
8014 @end smallexample
8015
8016 @noindent
8017 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8018 @end table
8019
8020 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8021 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8022
8023 @table @code
8024 @kindex tstart
8025 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8026 @cindex collected data discarded
8027 @item tstart
8028 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8029 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8030 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8031 experiment.
8032
8033 @kindex tstop
8034 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8035 @item tstop
8036 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8037 stops collecting data.
8038
8039 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8040 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8041 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8042
8043 @kindex tstatus
8044 @cindex status of trace data collection
8045 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8046 @item tstatus
8047 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8048 collection.
8049 @end table
8050
8051 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8052
8053 @smallexample
8054 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8055 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8056 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8057 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8058 > while-stepping 11
8059 > collect $regs
8060 > end
8061 > end
8062 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8063 [time passes @dots{}]
8064 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8065 @end smallexample
8066
8067
8068 @node Analyze Collected Data
8069 @section Using the Collected Data
8070
8071 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8072 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8073 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8074 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8075 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8076 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8077 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8078 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8079 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8080 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8081 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8082 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8083 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8084 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8085 the buffer will fail.
8086
8087 @menu
8088 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8089 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8090 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8091 @end menu
8092
8093 @node tfind
8094 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8095
8096 @kindex tfind
8097 @cindex select trace snapshot
8098 @cindex find trace snapshot
8099 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8100 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8101 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8102 snapshot is selected.
8103
8104 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8105
8106 @table @code
8107 @item tfind start
8108 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8109 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8110
8111 @item tfind none
8112 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8113
8114 @item tfind end
8115 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8116
8117 @item tfind
8118 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8119
8120 @item tfind -
8121 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8122 retracing earlier steps.
8123
8124 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8125 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8126 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8127 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8128 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8129
8130 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8131 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8132 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8133 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8134 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8135
8136 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8137 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8138 addresses.
8139
8140 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8141 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8142 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8143
8144 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8145 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8146 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8147 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8148 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8149 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8150 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8151 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8152 @end table
8153
8154 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8155 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8156 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8157 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8158 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8159 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8160 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8161 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8162 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8163 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8164 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8165 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8166 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8167 tracepoint as the current one.
8168
8169 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8170 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8171 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8172 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8173 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8174
8175 @smallexample
8176 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8177 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8178 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8179 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8180 > tfind
8181 > end
8182
8183 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8184 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8185 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8186 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8187 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8188 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8189 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8190 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8191 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8192 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8193 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8194 @end smallexample
8195
8196 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8197 the buffer:
8198
8199 @smallexample
8200 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8201 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8202 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8203 > tfind line
8204 > end
8205
8206 Frame 0, X = 1
8207 Frame 7, X = 2
8208 Frame 13, X = 255
8209 @end smallexample
8210
8211 @node tdump
8212 @subsection @code{tdump}
8213 @kindex tdump
8214 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8215 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8216
8217 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8218 the current trace snapshot.
8219
8220 @smallexample
8221 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8222 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8223 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8224 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8225 > end
8226
8227 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8228
8229 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8230 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8231 at gdb_test.c:444
8232 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8233
8234 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8235 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8236 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8237 d1 0x18 24
8238 d2 0x80 128
8239 d3 0x33 51
8240 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8241 d5 0x22 34
8242 d6 0xe0 224
8243 d7 0x380035 3670069
8244 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8245 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8246 a2 0x100 256
8247 a3 0x322000 3284992
8248 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8249 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8250 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8251 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8252 ps 0x0 0
8253 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8254 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8255 fpstatus 0x0 0
8256 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8257 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8258 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8259 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8260 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8261 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8262 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8263 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8264 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8265
8266 (@value{GDBP})
8267 @end smallexample
8268
8269 @node save-tracepoints
8270 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8271 @kindex save-tracepoints
8272 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8273
8274 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8275 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8276 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8277 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8278 Files}).
8279
8280 @node Tracepoint Variables
8281 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8282 @cindex tracepoint variables
8283 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8284
8285 @table @code
8286 @vindex $trace_frame
8287 @item (int) $trace_frame
8288 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8289 snapshot is selected.
8290
8291 @vindex $tracepoint
8292 @item (int) $tracepoint
8293 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8294
8295 @vindex $trace_line
8296 @item (int) $trace_line
8297 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8298
8299 @vindex $trace_file
8300 @item (char []) $trace_file
8301 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8302
8303 @vindex $trace_func
8304 @item (char []) $trace_func
8305 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8306 @end table
8307
8308 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8309 use @code{output} instead.
8310
8311 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8312 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8313 data.
8314
8315 @smallexample
8316 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8317
8318 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8319 > output $trace_file
8320 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8321 > tfind
8322 > end
8323 @end smallexample
8324
8325 @node Overlays
8326 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8327 @cindex overlays
8328
8329 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8330 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8331 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8332 use overlays.
8333
8334 @menu
8335 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8336 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8337 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8338 mapped by asking the inferior.
8339 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8340 @end menu
8341
8342 @node How Overlays Work
8343 @section How Overlays Work
8344 @cindex mapped overlays
8345 @cindex unmapped overlays
8346 @cindex load address, overlay's
8347 @cindex mapped address
8348 @cindex overlay area
8349
8350 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8351 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8352 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8353 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8354 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8355
8356 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8357 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8358 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8359 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8360 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8361 largest overlay as well.
8362
8363 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8364 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8365 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8366 there.
8367
8368 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8369 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8370 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8371
8372 @smallexample
8373 @group
8374 Data Instruction Larger
8375 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8376 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8377 | | | | | |
8378 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8379 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8380 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8381 | and heap | | | | | |
8382 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8383 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8384 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8385 | | | | | |
8386 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8387 address | | | | | |
8388 | overlay | <-' | | |
8389 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8390 | | <---. | | load address
8391 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8392 | | | |
8393 +-----------+ | |
8394 +-----------+
8395 | |
8396 +-----------+
8397
8398 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8399 @end group
8400 @end smallexample
8401
8402 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8403 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8404 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8405 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8406 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8407 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8408 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8409 program and the overlay area.
8410
8411 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8412 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8413 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8414 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8415 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8416 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8417 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8418
8419 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8420 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8421 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8422
8423 @itemize @bullet
8424
8425 @item
8426 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8427 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8428 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8429 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8430
8431 @item
8432 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8433 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8434 your program's performance.
8435
8436 @item
8437 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8438 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8439 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8440 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8441 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8442 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8443 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8444
8445 @item
8446 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8447 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8448 instruction and data spaces.
8449
8450 @end itemize
8451
8452 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8453 improved in many ways:
8454
8455 @itemize @bullet
8456
8457 @item
8458 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8459 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8460 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8461 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8462 area in the usual way.
8463
8464 @item
8465 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8466 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8467
8468 @item
8469 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8470 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8471 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8472 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8473 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8474 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8475 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8476
8477 @end itemize
8478
8479
8480 @node Overlay Commands
8481 @section Overlay Commands
8482
8483 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8484 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8485 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8486 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8487 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8488 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8489
8490 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8491 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8492
8493 @table @code
8494 @item overlay off
8495 @kindex overlay
8496 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8497 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8498 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8499 overlay support is disabled.
8500
8501 @item overlay manual
8502 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8503 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8504 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8505 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8506 commands described below.
8507
8508 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8509 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8510 @cindex map an overlay
8511 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8512 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8513 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8514 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8515 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8516 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8517
8518 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8519 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8520 @cindex unmap an overlay
8521 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8522 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8523 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8524 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8525
8526 @item overlay auto
8527 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8528 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8529 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8530 Overlay Debugging}.
8531
8532 @item overlay load-target
8533 @itemx overlay load
8534 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8535 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8536 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8537 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8538 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8539 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8540
8541 @item overlay list-overlays
8542 @itemx overlay list
8543 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8544 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8545 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8546
8547 @end table
8548
8549 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8550 of the function the address falls in:
8551
8552 @smallexample
8553 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8554 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8555 @end smallexample
8556 @noindent
8557 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8558 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8559 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8560 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8561
8562 @smallexample
8563 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8564 No sections are mapped.
8565 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8566 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8567 @end smallexample
8568 @noindent
8569 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8570 name normally:
8571
8572 @smallexample
8573 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8574 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8575 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8576 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8577 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8578 @end smallexample
8579
8580 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8581 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8582 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8583 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8584 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8585
8586 @itemize @bullet
8587 @item
8588 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8589 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8590 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8591 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8592 @item
8593 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8594 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8595 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8596 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8597 breakpoints properly.
8598 @end itemize
8599
8600
8601 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8602 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8603 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8604
8605 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8606 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8607 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8608 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8609 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8610 current state of the overlays.
8611
8612 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8613 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8614
8615 @table @asis
8616
8617 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8618 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8619
8620 @smallexample
8621 struct
8622 @{
8623 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8624 unsigned long vma;
8625
8626 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8627 unsigned long size;
8628
8629 /* The overlay's load address. */
8630 unsigned long lma;
8631
8632 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8633 zero otherwise. */
8634 unsigned long mapped;
8635 @}
8636 @end smallexample
8637
8638 @item @code{_novlys}:
8639 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8640 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8641
8642 @end table
8643
8644 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8645 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8646 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8647 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8648 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8649 currently mapped.
8650
8651 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8652 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8653 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8654 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8655 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8656 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8657 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8658 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8659 are not being executed.
8660
8661 @node Overlay Sample Program
8662 @section Overlay Sample Program
8663 @cindex overlay example program
8664
8665 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8666 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8667 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8668 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8669 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8670 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8671 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8672
8673 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8674 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8675 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8676 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8677
8678 @table @file
8679 @item overlays.c
8680 The main program file.
8681 @item ovlymgr.c
8682 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8683 @item foo.c
8684 @itemx bar.c
8685 @itemx baz.c
8686 @itemx grbx.c
8687 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8688 @item d10v.ld
8689 @itemx m32r.ld
8690 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8691 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8692 @end table
8693
8694 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8695 cross-compiler like this:
8696
8697 @smallexample
8698 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8699 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8700 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8701 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8702 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8703 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8704 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8705 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8706 @end smallexample
8707
8708 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8709 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8710 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8711
8712
8713 @node Languages
8714 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8715 @cindex languages
8716
8717 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8718 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8719 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8720 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8721 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8722 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8723
8724 @cindex working language
8725 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8726 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8727 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8728 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8729 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8730 language}.
8731
8732 @menu
8733 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8734 * Show:: Displaying the language
8735 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8736 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8737 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8738 @end menu
8739
8740 @node Setting
8741 @section Switching Between Source Languages
8742
8743 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8744 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8745 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8746 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8747 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8748 are printed, etc.
8749
8750 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8751 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8752 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8753 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8754 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8755 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8756 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8757 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8758 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8759 Displaying the Language}.
8760
8761 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8762 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8763 another language. In that case, make the
8764 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8765 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8766 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8767
8768 @menu
8769 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8770 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8771 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8772 @end menu
8773
8774 @node Filenames
8775 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8776
8777 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8778 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8779
8780 @table @file
8781 @item .ada
8782 @itemx .ads
8783 @itemx .adb
8784 @itemx .a
8785 Ada source file.
8786
8787 @item .c
8788 C source file
8789
8790 @item .C
8791 @itemx .cc
8792 @itemx .cp
8793 @itemx .cpp
8794 @itemx .cxx
8795 @itemx .c++
8796 C@t{++} source file
8797
8798 @item .m
8799 Objective-C source file
8800
8801 @item .f
8802 @itemx .F
8803 Fortran source file
8804
8805 @item .mod
8806 Modula-2 source file
8807
8808 @item .s
8809 @itemx .S
8810 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8811 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8812 @end table
8813
8814 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8815 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8816
8817 @node Manually
8818 @subsection Setting the Working Language
8819
8820 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8821 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8822 your program.
8823
8824 @kindex set language
8825 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8826 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8827 a language, such as
8828 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8829 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8830
8831 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8832 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8833 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8834 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8835 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8836 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8837 command such as:
8838
8839 @smallexample
8840 print a = b + c
8841 @end smallexample
8842
8843 @noindent
8844 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8845 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8846 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8847 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8848
8849 @node Automatically
8850 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8851
8852 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8853 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8854 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8855 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8856 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8857 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8858 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8859 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8860 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8861
8862 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8863 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8864 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8865 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8866 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8867
8868 @node Show
8869 @section Displaying the Language
8870
8871 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8872 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8873
8874 @table @code
8875 @item show language
8876 @kindex show language
8877 Display the current working language. This is the
8878 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8879 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8880
8881 @item info frame
8882 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8883 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8884 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8885 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
8886 information listed here.
8887
8888 @item info source
8889 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8890 Display the source language of this source file.
8891 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8892 information listed here.
8893 @end table
8894
8895 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8896 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8897 with a language explicitly:
8898
8899 @table @code
8900 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8901 @kindex set extension-language
8902 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8903 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8904
8905 @item info extensions
8906 @kindex info extensions
8907 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8908 @end table
8909
8910 @node Checks
8911 @section Type and Range Checking
8912
8913 @quotation
8914 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8915 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8916 section documents the intended facilities.
8917 @end quotation
8918 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8919
8920 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8921 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8922 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8923 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8924 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8925 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8926 errors when your program is running.
8927
8928 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8929 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8930 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8931 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8932 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8933 automatically based on your program's source language.
8934 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
8935 settings of supported languages.
8936
8937 @menu
8938 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8939 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8940 @end menu
8941
8942 @cindex type checking
8943 @cindex checks, type
8944 @node Type Checking
8945 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
8946
8947 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8948 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8949 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8950 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8951
8952 @smallexample
8953 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8954 @exdent but
8955 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8956 @end smallexample
8957
8958 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8959 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8960
8961 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8962 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8963 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8964 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8965 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8966 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8967 also issues a warning.
8968
8969 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8970 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8971 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8972 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8973 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8974 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8975
8976 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8977 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8978 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8979 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8980 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
8981 details on specific languages.
8982
8983 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8984
8985 @kindex set check type
8986 @kindex show check type
8987 @table @code
8988 @item set check type auto
8989 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8990 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
8991 each language.
8992
8993 @item set check type on
8994 @itemx set check type off
8995 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8996 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8997 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8998 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8999 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9000
9001 @item set check type warn
9002 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9003 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9004 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9005 numbers and structures.
9006
9007 @item show type
9008 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9009 is setting it automatically.
9010 @end table
9011
9012 @cindex range checking
9013 @cindex checks, range
9014 @node Range Checking
9015 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9016
9017 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9018 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9019 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9020 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9021 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9022
9023 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9024 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9025 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9026 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9027
9028 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9029 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9030 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9031 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9032 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9033 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9034
9035 @smallexample
9036 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9037 @end smallexample
9038
9039 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9040 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9041 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9042
9043 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9044
9045 @kindex set check range
9046 @kindex show check range
9047 @table @code
9048 @item set check range auto
9049 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9050 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9051 each language.
9052
9053 @item set check range on
9054 @itemx set check range off
9055 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9056 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9057 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9058 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9059
9060 @item set check range warn
9061 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9062 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9063 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9064 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9065 systems).
9066
9067 @item show range
9068 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9069 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9070 @end table
9071
9072 @node Supported Languages
9073 @section Supported Languages
9074
9075 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9076 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9077 @c This is false ...
9078 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9079 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9080 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9081 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9082 language.
9083
9084 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9085 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9086 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9087 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9088 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9089 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9090 language reference or tutorial.
9091
9092 @menu
9093 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9094 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9095 * Fortran:: Fortran
9096 * Pascal:: Pascal
9097 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9098 * Ada:: Ada
9099 @end menu
9100
9101 @node C
9102 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9103
9104 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9105 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9106
9107 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9108 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9109 together.
9110
9111 @cindex C@t{++}
9112 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9113 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9114 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9115 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9116 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9117 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9118 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9119
9120 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9121 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9122 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9123 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9124 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9125 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9126
9127 @menu
9128 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9129 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9130 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9131 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9132 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9133 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9134 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9135 @end menu
9136
9137 @node C Operators
9138 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9139
9140 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9141
9142 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9143 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9144 often defined on groups of types.
9145
9146 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9147
9148 @itemize @bullet
9149
9150 @item
9151 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9152 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9153
9154 @item
9155 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9156 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9157
9158 @item
9159 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9160
9161 @item
9162 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9163
9164 @end itemize
9165
9166 @noindent
9167 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9168 in order of increasing precedence:
9169
9170 @table @code
9171 @item ,
9172 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9173 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9174 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9175
9176 @item =
9177 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9178 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9179
9180 @item @var{op}=
9181 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9182 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9183 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9184 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9185 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9186
9187 @item ?:
9188 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9189 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9190 integral type.
9191
9192 @item ||
9193 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9194
9195 @item &&
9196 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9197
9198 @item |
9199 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9200
9201 @item ^
9202 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9203
9204 @item &
9205 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9206
9207 @item ==@r{, }!=
9208 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9209 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9210
9211 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9212 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9213 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9214 and non-zero for true.
9215
9216 @item <<@r{, }>>
9217 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9218
9219 @item @@
9220 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9221
9222 @item +@r{, }-
9223 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9224 pointer types.
9225
9226 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9227 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9228 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9229 integral types.
9230
9231 @item ++@r{, }--
9232 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9233 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9234 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9235 operation takes place.
9236
9237 @item *
9238 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9239 @code{++}.
9240
9241 @item &
9242 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9243
9244 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9245 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9246 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9247 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9248 stored.
9249
9250 @item -
9251 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9252 precedence as @code{++}.
9253
9254 @item !
9255 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9256 @code{++}.
9257
9258 @item ~
9259 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9260 @code{++}.
9261
9262
9263 @item .@r{, }->
9264 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9265 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9266 pointer based on the stored type information.
9267 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9268
9269 @item .*@r{, }->*
9270 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9271
9272 @item []
9273 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9274 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9275
9276 @item ()
9277 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9278
9279 @item ::
9280 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9281 and @code{class} types.
9282
9283 @item ::
9284 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9285 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9286 above.
9287 @end table
9288
9289 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9290 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9291 predefined meaning.
9292
9293 @node C Constants
9294 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9295
9296 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9297
9298 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9299 following ways:
9300
9301 @itemize @bullet
9302 @item
9303 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9304 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9305 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9306 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9307 @code{long} value.
9308
9309 @item
9310 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9311 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9312 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9313 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9314 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9315 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9316 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9317 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9318 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9319 constant.
9320
9321 @item
9322 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9323 integral equivalents.
9324
9325 @item
9326 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9327 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9328 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9329 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9330 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9331 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9332 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9333 @samp{\n} for newline.
9334
9335 @item
9336 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9337 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9338 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9339 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9340 characters.
9341
9342 @item
9343 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9344 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9345
9346 @item
9347 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9348 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9349 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9350 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9351 @end itemize
9352
9353 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9354 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9355
9356 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9357 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9358
9359 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9360 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9361 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9362 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9363 @quotation
9364 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9365 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9366 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9367 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9368 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9369 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9370 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9371 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9372 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9373 C@t{++} code.
9374 @end quotation
9375
9376 @enumerate
9377
9378 @cindex member functions
9379 @item
9380 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9381
9382 @smallexample
9383 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9384 @end smallexample
9385
9386 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9387 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9388 @item
9389 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9390 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9391 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9392 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9393
9394 @cindex call overloaded functions
9395 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9396 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9397 @item
9398 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9399 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9400 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9401 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9402 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9403 default arguments.
9404
9405 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9406 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9407 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9408 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9409 number of function arguments.
9410
9411 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9412 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9413 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9414
9415 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9416 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9417 @smallexample
9418 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9419 @end smallexample
9420
9421 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9422 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9423
9424 @cindex reference declarations
9425 @item
9426 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9427 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9428 dereferenced.
9429
9430 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9431 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9432 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9433 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9434 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9435
9436 @item
9437 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9438 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9439 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9440 necessary, for example in an expression like
9441 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9442 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9443 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9444 @end enumerate
9445
9446 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9447 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9448 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9449 invoking user-defined operators.
9450
9451 @node C Defaults
9452 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9453
9454 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9455
9456 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9457 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9458 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9459 selects the working language.
9460
9461 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9462 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9463 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9464 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9465 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9466 for further details.
9467
9468 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9469 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9470 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9471
9472 @node C Checks
9473 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9474
9475 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9476
9477 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9478 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9479 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9480
9481 @itemize @bullet
9482 @item
9483 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9484 enumerated tag.
9485
9486 @item
9487 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9488 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9489
9490 @ignore
9491 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9492 @c FIXME--beers?
9493 @item
9494 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9495 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9496 compilers.)
9497 @end ignore
9498 @end itemize
9499
9500 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9501 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9502 that is not itself an array.
9503
9504 @node Debugging C
9505 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9506
9507 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9508 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9509 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9510 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9511
9512 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9513 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9514 ,Expressions}.
9515
9516 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9517 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9518
9519 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9520
9521 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9522 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9523
9524 @table @code
9525 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9526 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9527 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9528 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9529 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}.
9530
9531 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9532 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9533 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9534 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9535 classes.
9536 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9537
9538 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9539 @item catch throw
9540 @itemx catch catch
9541 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9542 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9543
9544 @cindex inheritance
9545 @item ptype @var{typename}
9546 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9547 @var{typename}.
9548 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9549
9550 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9551 @item set print demangle
9552 @itemx show print demangle
9553 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9554 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9555 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9556 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9557 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9558
9559 @item set print object
9560 @itemx show print object
9561 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9562 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9563
9564 @item set print vtbl
9565 @itemx show print vtbl
9566 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9567 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9568 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9569 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9570
9571 @kindex set overload-resolution
9572 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9573 @item set overload-resolution on
9574 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9575 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9576 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9577 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9578 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9579 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9580
9581 @item set overload-resolution off
9582 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9583 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9584 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9585 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9586 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9587 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9588 argument types.
9589
9590 @kindex show overload-resolution
9591 @item show overload-resolution
9592 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9593
9594 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9595 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9596 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9597 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9598 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9599 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9600 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9601 @end table
9602
9603 @node Objective-C
9604 @subsection Objective-C
9605
9606 @cindex Objective-C
9607 This section provides information about some commands and command
9608 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9609 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9610 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9611
9612 @menu
9613 * Method Names in Commands::
9614 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9615 @end menu
9616
9617 @node Method Names in Commands
9618 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9619
9620 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9621 names as line specifications:
9622
9623 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9624 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9625 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9626 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9627 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9628 @itemize
9629 @item @code{clear}
9630 @item @code{break}
9631 @item @code{info line}
9632 @item @code{jump}
9633 @item @code{list}
9634 @end itemize
9635
9636 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9637
9638 @smallexample
9639 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9640 @end smallexample
9641
9642 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9643 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9644 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9645 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9646 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9647 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9648 debugged, enter:
9649
9650 @smallexample
9651 break -[Fruit create]
9652 @end smallexample
9653
9654 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9655 enter:
9656
9657 @smallexample
9658 list +[NSText initialize]
9659 @end smallexample
9660
9661 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9662 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9663 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9664 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9665
9666 @smallexample
9667 break create
9668 @end smallexample
9669
9670 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9671 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9672 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9673 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9674 none apply.
9675
9676 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9677 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9678
9679 @smallexample
9680 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9681 @end smallexample
9682
9683 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9684 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9685 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9686 @kindex print-object
9687 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9688
9689 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9690
9691 @smallexample
9692 print -[@var{object} hash]
9693 @end smallexample
9694
9695 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9696 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9697 @noindent
9698 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9699 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9700 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9701 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9702 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9703 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9704
9705 @node Fortran
9706 @subsection Fortran
9707 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9708
9709 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9710 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9711
9712 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9713 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9714 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9715 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9716 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9717 underscore.
9718
9719 @menu
9720 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9721 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9722 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9723 @end menu
9724
9725 @node Fortran Operators
9726 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9727
9728 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9729
9730 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9731 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9732 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9733
9734 @table @code
9735 @item **
9736 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9737 of the second one.
9738
9739 @item :
9740 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9741 represent a section of array.
9742 @end table
9743
9744 @node Fortran Defaults
9745 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9746
9747 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9748
9749 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9750 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9751 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9752 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9753
9754 @node Special Fortran Commands
9755 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9756
9757 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9758
9759 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9760 such as displaying common blocks.
9761
9762 @table @code
9763 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9764 @kindex info common
9765 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9766 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9767 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9768 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9769 printed.
9770 @end table
9771
9772 @node Pascal
9773 @subsection Pascal
9774
9775 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9776 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9777 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9778 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9779 syntax.
9780
9781 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9782 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9783 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9784
9785 @node Modula-2
9786 @subsection Modula-2
9787
9788 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9789
9790 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9791 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9792 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9793 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9794 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9795 table.
9796
9797 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9798 @menu
9799 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9800 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9801 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9802 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9803 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9804 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9805 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9806 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9807 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9808 @end menu
9809
9810 @node M2 Operators
9811 @subsubsection Operators
9812 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9813
9814 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9815 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9816 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9817 following definitions hold:
9818
9819 @itemize @bullet
9820
9821 @item
9822 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9823 their subranges.
9824
9825 @item
9826 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9827
9828 @item
9829 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9830
9831 @item
9832 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9833 @var{type}}.
9834
9835 @item
9836 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9837
9838 @item
9839 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9840
9841 @item
9842 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9843 @end itemize
9844
9845 @noindent
9846 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9847 increasing precedence:
9848
9849 @table @code
9850 @item ,
9851 Function argument or array index separator.
9852
9853 @item :=
9854 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9855 @var{value}.
9856
9857 @item <@r{, }>
9858 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9859 types.
9860
9861 @item <=@r{, }>=
9862 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9863 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9864 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9865
9866 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9867 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9868 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9869 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9870 comment character.
9871
9872 @item IN
9873 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9874 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9875
9876 @item OR
9877 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9878
9879 @item AND@r{, }&
9880 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9881
9882 @item @@
9883 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9884
9885 @item +@r{, }-
9886 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9887 and difference on set types.
9888
9889 @item *
9890 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9891 on set types.
9892
9893 @item /
9894 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9895 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9896
9897 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9898 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9899 precedence as @code{*}.
9900
9901 @item -
9902 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9903
9904 @item ^
9905 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9906
9907 @item NOT
9908 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9909 @code{^}.
9910
9911 @item .
9912 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9913 precedence as @code{^}.
9914
9915 @item []
9916 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9917
9918 @item ()
9919 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9920 as @code{^}.
9921
9922 @item ::@r{, }.
9923 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9924 @end table
9925
9926 @quotation
9927 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9928 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9929 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9930 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9931 @end quotation
9932
9933
9934 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9935 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
9936 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9937
9938 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9939 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9940
9941 @table @var
9942
9943 @item a
9944 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9945
9946 @item c
9947 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9948
9949 @item i
9950 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9951
9952 @item m
9953 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9954 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9955 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9956
9957 @item n
9958 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9959
9960 @item r
9961 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9962
9963 @item t
9964 represents a type.
9965
9966 @item v
9967 represents a variable.
9968
9969 @item x
9970 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9971 explanation of the function for details.
9972 @end table
9973
9974 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9975
9976 @table @code
9977 @item ABS(@var{n})
9978 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9979
9980 @item CAP(@var{c})
9981 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9982 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9983
9984 @item CHR(@var{i})
9985 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9986
9987 @item DEC(@var{v})
9988 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9989
9990 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9991 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9992 new value.
9993
9994 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9995 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9996 set.
9997
9998 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9999 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10000
10001 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10002 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10003
10004 @item INC(@var{v})
10005 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10006
10007 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10008 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10009 new value.
10010
10011 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10012 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10013 there. Returns the new set.
10014
10015 @item MAX(@var{t})
10016 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10017
10018 @item MIN(@var{t})
10019 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10020
10021 @item ODD(@var{i})
10022 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10023
10024 @item ORD(@var{x})
10025 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10026 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10027 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10028 integral, character and enumerated types.
10029
10030 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10031 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10032
10033 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10034 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10035
10036 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10037 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10038
10039 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10040 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10041 @end table
10042
10043 @quotation
10044 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10045 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10046 an error.
10047 @end quotation
10048
10049 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10050 @node M2 Constants
10051 @subsubsection Constants
10052
10053 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10054 ways:
10055
10056 @itemize @bullet
10057
10058 @item
10059 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10060 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10061 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10062 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10063
10064 @item
10065 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10066 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10067 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10068 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10069 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10070 digits.
10071
10072 @item
10073 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10074 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10075 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10076 followed by a @samp{C}.
10077
10078 @item
10079 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10080 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10081 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10082 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10083 sequences.
10084
10085 @item
10086 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10087
10088 @item
10089 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10090 @code{FALSE}.
10091
10092 @item
10093 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10094
10095 @item
10096 Set constants are not yet supported.
10097 @end itemize
10098
10099 @node M2 Types
10100 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10101 @cindex Modula-2 types
10102
10103 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10104 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10105 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10106 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10107 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10108 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10109
10110 The first example contains the following section of code:
10111
10112 @smallexample
10113 VAR
10114 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10115 r: [20..40] ;
10116 @end smallexample
10117
10118 @noindent
10119 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10120 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10121
10122 @smallexample
10123 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10124 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10125 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10126 SET OF CHAR
10127 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10128 21
10129 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10130 [20..40]
10131 @end smallexample
10132
10133 @noindent
10134 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10135
10136 @smallexample
10137 VAR
10138 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10139 @end smallexample
10140
10141 @noindent
10142 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10143
10144 @smallexample
10145 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10146 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10147 @end smallexample
10148
10149 @noindent
10150 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10151 expressions using the debugger.
10152
10153 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10154 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10155
10156 @smallexample
10157 VAR
10158 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10159 @end smallexample
10160
10161 @smallexample
10162 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10163 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10164 @end smallexample
10165
10166 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10167 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10168 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10169 above.
10170
10171 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10172
10173 @smallexample
10174 TYPE
10175 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10176 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10177 VAR
10178 s: t ;
10179 BEGIN
10180 s := blue ;
10181 @end smallexample
10182
10183 @noindent
10184 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10185 and value of a variable.
10186
10187 @smallexample
10188 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10189 $1 = blue
10190 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10191 type = [blue..yellow]
10192 @end smallexample
10193
10194 @noindent
10195 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10196 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10197 their @code{C} counterparts.
10198
10199 @smallexample
10200 VAR
10201 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10202 BEGIN
10203 s[1] := 1 ;
10204 @end smallexample
10205
10206 @smallexample
10207 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10208 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10209 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10210 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10211 @end smallexample
10212
10213 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10214 pointer types as shown in this example:
10215
10216 @smallexample
10217 VAR
10218 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10219 BEGIN
10220 NEW(s) ;
10221 s^[1] := 1 ;
10222 @end smallexample
10223
10224 @noindent
10225 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10226
10227 @smallexample
10228 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10229 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10230 @end smallexample
10231
10232 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10233 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10234 types:
10235
10236 @smallexample
10237 TYPE
10238 foo = RECORD
10239 f1: CARDINAL ;
10240 f2: CHAR ;
10241 f3: myarray ;
10242 END ;
10243
10244 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10245 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10246 VAR
10247 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10248 @end smallexample
10249
10250 @noindent
10251 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10252 below.
10253
10254 @smallexample
10255 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10256 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10257 f1 : CARDINAL;
10258 f2 : CHAR;
10259 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10260 END
10261 @end smallexample
10262
10263 @node M2 Defaults
10264 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10265 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10266
10267 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10268 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10269 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10270 selected the working language.
10271
10272 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10273 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10274 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10275 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10276
10277 @node Deviations
10278 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10279 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10280
10281 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10282 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10283
10284 @itemize @bullet
10285 @item
10286 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10287 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10288 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10289 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10290 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10291 returned a pointer.)
10292
10293 @item
10294 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10295 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10296 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10297 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10298
10299 @item
10300 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10301 argument.
10302
10303 @item
10304 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10305 @end itemize
10306
10307 @node M2 Checks
10308 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10309 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10310
10311 @quotation
10312 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10313 range checking.
10314 @end quotation
10315 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10316
10317 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10318
10319 @itemize @bullet
10320 @item
10321 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10322 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10323
10324 @item
10325 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10326 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10327 @end itemize
10328
10329 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10330 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10331
10332 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10333 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10334
10335 @node M2 Scope
10336 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10337 @cindex scope
10338 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10339 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10340 @ifinfo
10341 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10342 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10343 @end ifinfo
10344 @iftex
10345 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10346 @end iftex
10347
10348 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10349 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10350 similar syntax:
10351
10352 @smallexample
10353
10354 @var{module} . @var{id}
10355 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10356 @end smallexample
10357
10358 @noindent
10359 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10360 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10361 identifier within your program, except another module.
10362
10363 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10364 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10365 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10366 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10367
10368 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10369 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10370 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10371 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10372 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10373 @var{module}.
10374
10375 @node GDB/M2
10376 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10377
10378 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10379 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10380 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10381 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10382 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10383 analogue in Modula-2.
10384
10385 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10386 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10387 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10388 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10389 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10390 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10391
10392 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10393 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10394 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10395
10396 @node Ada
10397 @subsection Ada
10398 @cindex Ada
10399
10400 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10401 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10402 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10403 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10404 to be difficult.
10405
10406
10407 @cindex expressions in Ada
10408 @menu
10409 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10410 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10411 in @value{GDBN}.
10412 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10413 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10414 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10415 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10416 @end menu
10417
10418 @node Ada Mode Intro
10419 @subsubsection Introduction
10420 @cindex Ada mode, general
10421
10422 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10423 syntax, with some extensions.
10424 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10425
10426 @itemize @bullet
10427 @item
10428 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10429 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10430 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10431 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10432
10433 @item
10434 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10435 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10436
10437 @item
10438 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10439 @end itemize
10440
10441 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10442 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10443 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10444 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10445 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10446
10447 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10448 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10449 was translated from an Ada source file.
10450
10451 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10452 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10453 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10454 middle (to allow based literals).
10455
10456 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10457 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10458 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10459 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10460 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10461 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10462
10463 @node Omissions from Ada
10464 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10465 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10466
10467 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10468
10469 @itemize @bullet
10470 @item
10471 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10472
10473 @itemize @minus
10474 @item
10475 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10476 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10477
10478 @item
10479 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10480
10481 @item
10482 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10483
10484 @item
10485 @t{'Tag}.
10486
10487 @item
10488 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10489 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10490
10491 @item
10492 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10493 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10494
10495 @item
10496 @t{'Address}.
10497 @end itemize
10498
10499 @item
10500 The names in
10501 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10502 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10503 not currently available.
10504
10505 @item
10506 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10507 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10508 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10509 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10510 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10511 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10512 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10513 indeterminate values.
10514
10515 @item
10516 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10517 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10518 are not implemented.
10519
10520 @item
10521 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10522 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10523 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10524 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10525 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10526
10527 @smallexample
10528 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10529 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10530 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10531 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10532 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10533 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10534 @end smallexample
10535
10536 Changing a
10537 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10538 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10539 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10540 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10541 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10542 declared to have a type such as:
10543
10544 @smallexample
10545 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10546 Id : Integer;
10547 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10548 end record;
10549 @end smallexample
10550
10551 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10552 assignments:
10553
10554 @smallexample
10555 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10556 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10557 @end smallexample
10558
10559 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10560 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10561 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10562 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10563 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10564 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10565 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10566 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10567
10568 @item
10569 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10570
10571 @item
10572 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10573 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10574 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10575 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10576 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10577 the proper resolution.
10578
10579 @item
10580 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10581
10582 @item
10583 Entry calls are not implemented.
10584
10585 @item
10586 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10587 formats are not supported.
10588
10589 @item
10590 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10591 @end itemize
10592
10593 @node Additions to Ada
10594 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10595 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10596
10597 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10598 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10599
10600 @itemize @bullet
10601 @item
10602 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10603 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10604 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10605 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10606 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10607 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10608 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10609 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10610
10611 @item
10612 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10613 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10614 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10615
10616 @item
10617 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10618 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10619
10620 @item
10621 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10622 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10623 @end itemize
10624
10625 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10626 additions specific to Ada:
10627
10628 @itemize @bullet
10629 @item
10630 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10631 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10632
10633 @smallexample
10634 set x := y + 3
10635 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10636 @end smallexample
10637
10638 @item
10639 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10640 the value of its right-hand operand.
10641 This allows, for example,
10642 complex conditional breaks:
10643
10644 @smallexample
10645 break f
10646 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10647 @end smallexample
10648
10649 @item
10650 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10651 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10652 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10653 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10654 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10655 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10656 in strings. For example,
10657 @smallexample
10658 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10659 @end smallexample
10660 @noindent
10661 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10662 after each period.
10663
10664 @item
10665 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10666 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10667 to write
10668
10669 @smallexample
10670 print 'max(x, y)
10671 @end smallexample
10672
10673 @item
10674 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10675 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10676 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10677 of 3 might print as
10678
10679 @smallexample
10680 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10681 @end smallexample
10682
10683 @noindent
10684 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10685 clause.
10686
10687 @item
10688 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10689 multi-character subsequence of
10690 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10691 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10692 in place of @t{a'length}.
10693
10694 @item
10695 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10696 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10697 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10698 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10699 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10700 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10701 For example,
10702 @smallexample
10703 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10704 @end smallexample
10705
10706 @item
10707 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10708 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10709 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10710 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10711 object.
10712
10713 @end itemize
10714
10715 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10716 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10717
10718 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10719 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10720 before reaching the main procedure.
10721 As defined in the Ada Reference
10722 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10723 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10724 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10725 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10726
10727 @node Ada Glitches
10728 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10729 @cindex Ada, problems
10730
10731 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10732 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10733 @value{GDBN},
10734 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10735 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10736
10737 @itemize @bullet
10738 @item
10739 Currently, the debugger
10740 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10741 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10742 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10743 to get it printed properly.
10744
10745 @item
10746 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10747 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10748
10749 @item
10750 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10751 argument lists are treated as positional).
10752
10753 @item
10754 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10755
10756 @item
10757 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10758 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10759 the host machine.
10760
10761 @item
10762 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10763
10764 @item
10765 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10766 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10767 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10768 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10769 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10770 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10771 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10772 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10773 you can usually resolve the confusion
10774 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10775 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10776 @end itemize
10777
10778 @node Unsupported Languages
10779 @section Unsupported Languages
10780
10781 @cindex unsupported languages
10782 @cindex minimal language
10783 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10784 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10785 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10786 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10787 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10788 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10789
10790 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10791 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10792 language.
10793
10794 @node Symbols
10795 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10796
10797 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10798 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10799 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10800 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10801 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10802 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10803 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10804
10805 @cindex symbol names
10806 @cindex names of symbols
10807 @cindex quoting names
10808 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10809 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10810 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10811 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10812 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10813 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10814 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10815 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10816
10817 @smallexample
10818 p 'foo.c'::x
10819 @end smallexample
10820
10821 @noindent
10822 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10823
10824 @table @code
10825 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10826 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10827 @kindex set case-sensitive
10828 @item set case-sensitive on
10829 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10830 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10831 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10832 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10833 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10834 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10835 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10836 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10837 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10838 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10839 case-insensitive matches.
10840
10841 @kindex show case-sensitive
10842 @item show case-sensitive
10843 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10844 lookups.
10845
10846 @kindex info address
10847 @cindex address of a symbol
10848 @item info address @var{symbol}
10849 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10850 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10851 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10852 is always stored.
10853
10854 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10855 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10856 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10857
10858 @kindex info symbol
10859 @cindex symbol from address
10860 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10861 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10862 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10863 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10864 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10865
10866 @smallexample
10867 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10868 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10869 @end smallexample
10870
10871 @noindent
10872 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10873 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10874
10875 @kindex whatis
10876 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10877 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10878 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10879 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10880 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10881 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10882 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10883 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10884 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10885 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10886 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10887
10888 @kindex ptype
10889 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10890 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10891 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10892 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10893
10894 For example, for this variable declaration:
10895
10896 @smallexample
10897 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10898 @end smallexample
10899
10900 @noindent
10901 the two commands give this output:
10902
10903 @smallexample
10904 @group
10905 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10906 type = struct complex
10907 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10908 type = struct complex @{
10909 double real;
10910 double imag;
10911 @}
10912 @end group
10913 @end smallexample
10914
10915 @noindent
10916 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10917 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10918
10919 @cindex incomplete type
10920 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10921 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10922 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10923 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10924 given these declarations:
10925
10926 @smallexample
10927 struct foo;
10928 struct foo *fooptr;
10929 @end smallexample
10930
10931 @noindent
10932 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10933
10934 @smallexample
10935 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10936 $1 = <incomplete type>
10937 @end smallexample
10938
10939 @noindent
10940 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10941 completely specified.
10942
10943 @kindex info types
10944 @item info types @var{regexp}
10945 @itemx info types
10946 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10947 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10948 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10949 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10950 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10951 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10952 name is @code{value}.
10953
10954 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10955 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10956 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10957
10958 @kindex info scope
10959 @cindex local variables
10960 @item info scope @var{location}
10961 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10962 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10963 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10964 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10965
10966 @smallexample
10967 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10968 Scope for command_line_handler:
10969 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10970 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10971 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10972 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10973 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10974 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10975 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10976 @end smallexample
10977
10978 @noindent
10979 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10980 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10981 collect}.
10982
10983 @kindex info source
10984 @item info source
10985 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10986 the function containing the current point of execution:
10987 @itemize @bullet
10988 @item
10989 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10990 @item
10991 the directory it was compiled in,
10992 @item
10993 its length, in lines,
10994 @item
10995 which programming language it is written in,
10996 @item
10997 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10998 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10999 @item
11000 whether the debugging information includes information about
11001 preprocessor macros.
11002 @end itemize
11003
11004
11005 @kindex info sources
11006 @item info sources
11007 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11008 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11009 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11010
11011 @kindex info functions
11012 @item info functions
11013 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11014
11015 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11016 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11017 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11018 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11019 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11020 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11021 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11022 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11023
11024 @kindex info variables
11025 @item info variables
11026 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11027 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11028
11029 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11030 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11031 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11032 @var{regexp}.
11033
11034 @kindex info classes
11035 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11036 @item info classes
11037 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11038 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11039 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11040 expression.
11041
11042 @kindex info selectors
11043 @item info selectors
11044 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11045 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11046 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11047 expression.
11048
11049 @ignore
11050 This was never implemented.
11051 @kindex info methods
11052 @item info methods
11053 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11054 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11055 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11056 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11057 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11058 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11059 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11060 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11061 @end ignore
11062
11063 @cindex reloading symbols
11064 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11065 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11066 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11067 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11068 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11069
11070 @table @code
11071 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11072 @item set symbol-reloading on
11073 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11074 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11075
11076 @item set symbol-reloading off
11077 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11078 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11079 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11080 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11081 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11082 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11083 name.
11084
11085 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11086 @item show symbol-reloading
11087 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11088 @end table
11089
11090 @cindex opaque data types
11091 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11092 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11093 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11094 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11095 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11096 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11097 another source file. The default is on.
11098
11099 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11100 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11101
11102 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11103 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11104 is printed as follows:
11105 @smallexample
11106 @{<no data fields>@}
11107 @end smallexample
11108
11109 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11110 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11111 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11112
11113 @kindex maint print symbols
11114 @cindex symbol dump
11115 @kindex maint print psymbols
11116 @cindex partial symbol dump
11117 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11118 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11119 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11120 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11121 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11122 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11123 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11124 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11125 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11126 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11127 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11128 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11129 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11130 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11131 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11132 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11133 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11134
11135 @kindex maint info symtabs
11136 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11137 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11138 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11139 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11140 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11141 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11142 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11143
11144 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11145 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11146 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11147 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11148 structure in more detail. For example:
11149
11150 @smallexample
11151 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11152 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11153 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11154 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11155 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11156 readin no
11157 fullname (null)
11158 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11159 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11160 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11161 dependencies (none)
11162 @}
11163 @}
11164 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11165 (@value{GDBP})
11166 @end smallexample
11167 @noindent
11168 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11169 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11170 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11171 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11172 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11173
11174 @smallexample
11175 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11176 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11177 line 1574.
11178 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11179 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11180 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11181 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11182 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11183 dirname (null)
11184 fullname (null)
11185 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11186 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11187 debugformat DWARF 2
11188 @}
11189 @}
11190 (@value{GDBP})
11191 @end smallexample
11192 @end table
11193
11194
11195 @node Altering
11196 @chapter Altering Execution
11197
11198 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11199 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11200 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11201 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11202 program.
11203
11204 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11205 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11206 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11207
11208 @menu
11209 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11210 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11211 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11212 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11213 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11214 * Patching:: Patching your program
11215 @end menu
11216
11217 @node Assignment
11218 @section Assignment to Variables
11219
11220 @cindex assignment
11221 @cindex setting variables
11222 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11223 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11224
11225 @smallexample
11226 print x=4
11227 @end smallexample
11228
11229 @noindent
11230 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11231 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11232 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11233 information on operators in supported languages.
11234
11235 @kindex set variable
11236 @cindex variables, setting
11237 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11238 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11239 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11240 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11241 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11242
11243 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11244 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11245 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11246 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11247 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11248 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11249 command @code{set width}:
11250
11251 @smallexample
11252 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11253 type = double
11254 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11255 $4 = 13
11256 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11257 Invalid syntax in expression.
11258 @end smallexample
11259
11260 @noindent
11261 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11262 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11263
11264 @smallexample
11265 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11266 @end smallexample
11267
11268 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11269 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11270 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11271 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11272 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11273 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11274
11275 @smallexample
11276 @group
11277 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11278 type = double
11279 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11280 $1 = 1
11281 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11282 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11283 $2 = 1
11284 (@value{GDBP}) r
11285 The program being debugged has been started already.
11286 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11287 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11288 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11289 Invalid bfd target.
11290 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11291 The current BFD target is "=4".
11292 @end group
11293 @end smallexample
11294
11295 @noindent
11296 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11297 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11298 @code{g}, use
11299
11300 @smallexample
11301 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11302 @end smallexample
11303
11304 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11305 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11306 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11307 same length or shorter.
11308 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11309 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11310
11311 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11312 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11313 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11314 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11315 and representation in memory), and
11316
11317 @smallexample
11318 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11319 @end smallexample
11320
11321 @noindent
11322 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11323
11324 @node Jumping
11325 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11326
11327 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11328 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11329 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11330
11331 @table @code
11332 @kindex jump
11333 @item jump @var{linespec}
11334 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11335 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11336 Source Lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11337 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11338 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11339 Breakpoints}.
11340
11341 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11342 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11343 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11344 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11345 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11346 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11347 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11348 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11349 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11350
11351 @item jump *@var{address}
11352 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11353 @end table
11354
11355 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11356 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11357 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11358 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11359 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11360 example,
11361
11362 @smallexample
11363 set $pc = 0x485
11364 @end smallexample
11365
11366 @noindent
11367 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11368 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11369 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11370
11371 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11372 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11373 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11374 detail.
11375
11376 @c @group
11377 @node Signaling
11378 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11379 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11380
11381 @table @code
11382 @kindex signal
11383 @item signal @var{signal}
11384 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11385 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11386 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11387 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11388
11389 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11390 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11391 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11392 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11393 signal.
11394
11395 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11396 after executing the command.
11397 @end table
11398 @c @end group
11399
11400 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11401 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11402 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11403 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11404 passes the signal directly to your program.
11405
11406
11407 @node Returning
11408 @section Returning from a Function
11409
11410 @table @code
11411 @cindex returning from a function
11412 @kindex return
11413 @item return
11414 @itemx return @var{expression}
11415 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11416 command. If you give an
11417 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11418 value.
11419 @end table
11420
11421 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11422 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11423 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11424 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11425
11426 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11427 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11428 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11429 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11430 of functions.
11431
11432 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11433 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11434 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11435 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11436 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11437
11438 @node Calling
11439 @section Calling Program Functions
11440
11441 @table @code
11442 @cindex calling functions
11443 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11444 @item print @var{expr}
11445 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11446 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11447 debugged.
11448
11449 @kindex call
11450 @item call @var{expr}
11451 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11452 returned values.
11453
11454 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11455 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11456 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11457 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11458 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11459 value history.
11460 @end table
11461
11462 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11463 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11464 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11465 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11466
11467 @table @code
11468 @item set unwindonsignal
11469 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11470 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11471 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11472 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11473 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11474 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11475 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11476 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11477 received.
11478
11479 @item show unwindonsignal
11480 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11481 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11482 @value{GDBN}.
11483 @end table
11484
11485 @cindex weak alias functions
11486 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11487 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11488 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11489 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11490 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11491 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11492 function instead.
11493
11494 @node Patching
11495 @section Patching Programs
11496
11497 @cindex patching binaries
11498 @cindex writing into executables
11499 @cindex writing into corefiles
11500
11501 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11502 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11503 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11504 patching your program's binary.
11505
11506 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11507 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11508 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11509 repairs.
11510
11511 @table @code
11512 @kindex set write
11513 @item set write on
11514 @itemx set write off
11515 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11516 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11517 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11518
11519 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11520 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11521 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11522
11523 @item show write
11524 @kindex show write
11525 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11526 as well as reading.
11527 @end table
11528
11529 @node GDB Files
11530 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11531
11532 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11533 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11534 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11535 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11536
11537 @menu
11538 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11539 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11540 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11541 @end menu
11542
11543 @node Files
11544 @section Commands to Specify Files
11545
11546 @cindex symbol table
11547 @cindex core dump file
11548
11549 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11550 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11551 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11552 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11553
11554 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11555 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11556 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11557 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11558 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11559 new files are useful.
11560
11561 @table @code
11562 @cindex executable file
11563 @kindex file
11564 @item file @var{filename}
11565 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11566 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11567 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11568 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11569 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11570 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11571 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11572 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11573
11574 @cindex unlinked object files
11575 @cindex patching object files
11576 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11577 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11578 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11579 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11580 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11581 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11582 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11583 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11584
11585 @item file
11586 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11587 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11588
11589 @kindex exec-file
11590 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11591 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11592 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11593 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11594 discard information on the executable file.
11595
11596 @kindex symbol-file
11597 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11598 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11599 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11600 table and program to run from the same file.
11601
11602 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11603 program's symbol table.
11604
11605 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11606 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11607 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11608 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11609 @value{GDBN}.
11610
11611 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11612 executing it once.
11613
11614 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11615 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11616 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11617 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11618 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11619 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11620 optimized code.
11621
11622 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11623 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11624 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11625 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11626 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11627
11628 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11629 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11630 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11631 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11632 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11633 Warnings and Messages}.)
11634
11635 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11636 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11637 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11638 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11639 in stabs format.
11640
11641 @kindex readnow
11642 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11643 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11644 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11645 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11646 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11647 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11648 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11649 entire symbol table available.
11650
11651 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11652 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11653 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11654 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11655 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11656 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11657 @c files.
11658
11659 @kindex core-file
11660 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11661 @itemx core
11662 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11663 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11664 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11665 executable file itself for other parts.
11666
11667 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11668 to be used.
11669
11670 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11671 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11672 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11673 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11674 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11675
11676 @kindex add-symbol-file
11677 @cindex dynamic linking
11678 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11679 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11680 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11681 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11682 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11683 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11684 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11685 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11686 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11687 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11688 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11689 @var{address} as an expression.
11690
11691 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11692 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11693 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11694 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11695 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11696
11697 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11698 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11699 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11700 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11701 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11702 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11703 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11704 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11705 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11706
11707 @itemize @bullet
11708 @item
11709 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11710 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11711 @item
11712 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11713 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11714 @item
11715 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11716 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11717 @end itemize
11718
11719 @noindent
11720 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11721 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11722 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11723 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11724 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11725 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11726 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11727 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11728 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11729 way.
11730
11731 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11732
11733 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11734 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11735 @cindex load symbols from memory
11736 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11737 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11738 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11739 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11740 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11741 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11742 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11743 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11744 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11745
11746 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11747 @kindex assf
11748 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11749 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11750 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11751 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11752 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11753 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11754 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11755 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11756 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11757 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11758
11759 @kindex section
11760 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11761 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11762 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11763 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11764 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11765 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11766 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11767 their addresses.
11768
11769 @kindex info files
11770 @kindex info target
11771 @item info files
11772 @itemx info target
11773 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11774 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11775 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11776 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11777 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11778 current ones.
11779
11780 @kindex maint info sections
11781 @item maint info sections
11782 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11783 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11784 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11785 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11786 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11787 may be arbitrarily combined):
11788
11789 @table @code
11790 @item ALLOBJ
11791 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11792 @item @var{sections}
11793 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11794 @item @var{section-flags}
11795 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11796 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11797 @table @code
11798 @item ALLOC
11799 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11800 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11801 @item LOAD
11802 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11803 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11804 @item RELOC
11805 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11806 @item READONLY
11807 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11808 @item CODE
11809 Section contains executable code only.
11810 @item DATA
11811 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11812 @item ROM
11813 Section will reside in ROM.
11814 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11815 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11816 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11817 Section is not empty.
11818 @item NEVER_LOAD
11819 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11820 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11821 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11822 COFF shared library information.
11823 @item IS_COMMON
11824 Section contains common symbols.
11825 @end table
11826 @end table
11827 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11828 @cindex read-only sections
11829 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11830 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11831 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11832 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11833 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11834 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11835 enhancement to debugging performance.
11836
11837 The default is off.
11838
11839 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11840 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11841 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11842 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11843
11844 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11845 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11846 @end table
11847
11848 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11849 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11850 name and remembers it that way.
11851
11852 @cindex shared libraries
11853 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
11854 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11855 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11856
11857 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
11858 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
11859
11860 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11861 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11862 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11863 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11864 debugging a core file).
11865
11866 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11867 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11868
11869 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11870 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11871 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11872
11873 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11874 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11875 particularly large or there are many of them.
11876
11877 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11878 commands:
11879
11880 @table @code
11881 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11882 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11883 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11884 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11885 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11886 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11887 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11888 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11889
11890 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11891 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11892 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11893 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11894 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11895 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11896 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11897 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
11898 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11899
11900 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11901 @item show auto-solib-add
11902 Display the current autoloading mode.
11903 @end table
11904
11905 @cindex load shared library
11906 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11907 command:
11908
11909 @table @code
11910 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11911 @kindex info share
11912 @item info share
11913 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11914 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11915
11916 @kindex sharedlibrary
11917 @kindex share
11918 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11919 @itemx share @var{regex}
11920 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11921 Unix regular expression.
11922 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11923 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11924 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11925 loaded.
11926
11927 @item nosharedlibrary
11928 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11929 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11930 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11931 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11932 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11933 discarded.
11934 @end table
11935
11936 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11937 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11938 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11939
11940 @table @code
11941 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11942 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11943 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11944 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11945 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11946 shared library.
11947
11948 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11949 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11950 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11951 library events happen.
11952 @end table
11953
11954 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11955 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11956 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11957 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11958 not.
11959
11960 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11961 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11962 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11963 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11964 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11965
11966 @table @code
11967 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11968 @cindex system root, alternate
11969 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11970 @kindex set sysroot
11971 @item set sysroot @var{path}
11972 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
11973 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
11974 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
11975 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
11976 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
11977 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
11978 under @var{path}.
11979
11980 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
11981 sysroot}.
11982
11983 @cindex default system root
11984 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11985 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
11986 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
11987 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
11988 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
11989 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
11990 location.
11991
11992 @kindex show sysroot
11993 @item show sysroot
11994 Display the current shared library prefix.
11995
11996 @kindex set solib-search-path
11997 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11998 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
11999 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12000 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12001 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12002 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12003 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12004 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12005 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12006 of shared library symbols.
12007
12008 @kindex show solib-search-path
12009 @item show solib-search-path
12010 Display the current shared library search path.
12011 @end table
12012
12013
12014 @node Separate Debug Files
12015 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12016 @cindex separate debugging information files
12017 @cindex debugging information in separate files
12018 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12019 @cindex debugging information directory, global
12020 @cindex global debugging information directory
12021 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12022 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12023
12024 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12025 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12026 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12027 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12028 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12029 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12030 install only when they need to debug a problem.
12031
12032 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12033 file:
12034
12035 @itemize @bullet
12036 @item
12037 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12038 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12039 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12040 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12041 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12042 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12043 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12044 came from the same build.
12045
12046 @item
12047 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12048 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12049 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12050 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12051 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12052 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12053 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12054 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12055 below.
12056 @end itemize
12057
12058 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12059 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12060
12061 @itemize @bullet
12062 @item
12063 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12064 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12065 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12066 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12067 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12068
12069 @item
12070 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12071 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12072 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12073 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12074 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12075 hex characters, not 10.)
12076 @end itemize
12077
12078 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12079 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12080 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12081 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12082 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12083 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12084
12085 @itemize @minus
12086 @item
12087 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12088 @item
12089 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12090 @item
12091 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12092 @item
12093 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12094 @end itemize
12095
12096 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12097 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12098
12099 @table @code
12100
12101 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12102 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12103 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12104 information files to @var{directory}.
12105
12106 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12107 @item show debug-file-directory
12108 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12109 information files.
12110
12111 @end table
12112
12113 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12114 @cindex debug link sections
12115 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12116 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12117
12118 @itemize
12119 @item
12120 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12121 a zero byte,
12122 @item
12123 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12124 boundary within the section, and
12125 @item
12126 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12127 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12128 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12129 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12130 @end itemize
12131
12132 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12133 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12134 described above.
12135
12136 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12137 @cindex build ID sections
12138 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12139 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12140 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12141 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12142 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12143 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12144 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12145 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12146 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12147
12148 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12149 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12150 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12151 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12152 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12153 in an ordinary executable.
12154
12155 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12156 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12157 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12158 following commands:
12159
12160 @smallexample
12161 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12162 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12163 @end smallexample
12164
12165 @noindent
12166 These commands remove the debugging
12167 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12168 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12169 two files:
12170
12171 @itemize @bullet
12172 @item
12173 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12174 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12175
12176 @smallexample
12177 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12178 @end smallexample
12179
12180 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12181 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12182 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12183 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12184
12185 @item
12186 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12187 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12188 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12189 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12190 @end itemize
12191
12192 @noindent
12193
12194 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12195 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12196 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12197 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12198
12199 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12200 @smallexample
12201 unsigned long
12202 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12203 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12204 @{
12205 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12206 @{
12207 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12208 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12209 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12210 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12211 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12212 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12213 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12214 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12215 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12216 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12217 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12218 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12219 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12220 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12221 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12222 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12223 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12224 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12225 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12226 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12227 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12228 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12229 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12230 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12231 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12232 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12233 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12234 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12235 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12236 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12237 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12238 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12239 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12240 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12241 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12242 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12243 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12244 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12245 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12246 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12247 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12248 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12249 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12250 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12251 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12252 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12253 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12254 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12255 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12256 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12257 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12258 0x2d02ef8d
12259 @};
12260 unsigned char *end;
12261
12262 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12263 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12264 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12265 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12266 @}
12267 @end smallexample
12268
12269 @noindent
12270 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12271
12272
12273 @node Symbol Errors
12274 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12275
12276 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12277 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12278 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12279 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12280 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12281 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12282 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12283 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12284 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12285 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12286 Messages}).
12287
12288 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12289
12290 @table @code
12291 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12292
12293 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12294 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12295 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12296 in its outer scope blocks.
12297
12298 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12299 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12300 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12301 function.
12302
12303 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12304
12305 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12306 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12307 do so.
12308
12309 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12310 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12311 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12312 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12313 Messages}.)
12314
12315 @item bad block start address patched
12316
12317 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12318 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12319 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12320
12321 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12322 starting on the previous source line.
12323
12324 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12325
12326 @cindex foo
12327 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12328 larger than the size of the string table.
12329
12330 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12331 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12332 with this name.
12333
12334 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12335
12336 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12337 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12338 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12339
12340 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12341 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12342 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12343 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12344 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12345 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12346
12347 @item stub type has NULL name
12348
12349 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12350
12351 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12352 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12353 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12354 it.
12355
12356 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12357
12358 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12359
12360 @end table
12361
12362 @node Targets
12363 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12364
12365 @cindex debugging target
12366 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12367
12368 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12369 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12370 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12371 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12372 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12373 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12374 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12375 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12376
12377 @cindex target architecture
12378 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12379 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12380 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12381 command.
12382
12383 @table @code
12384 @kindex set architecture
12385 @kindex show architecture
12386 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12387 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12388 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12389 supported architectures.
12390
12391 @item show architecture
12392 Show the current target architecture.
12393
12394 @item set processor
12395 @itemx processor
12396 @kindex set processor
12397 @kindex show processor
12398 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12399 and @code{show architecture}.
12400 @end table
12401
12402 @menu
12403 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12404 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12405 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12406 @end menu
12407
12408 @node Active Targets
12409 @section Active Targets
12410
12411 @cindex stacking targets
12412 @cindex active targets
12413 @cindex multiple targets
12414
12415 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12416 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12417 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12418 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12419 a core file.
12420
12421 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12422 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12423 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12424 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12425 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12426 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12427 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12428 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12429 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12430
12431 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12432 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12433 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12434 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12435 process target is active.
12436
12437 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12438 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12439 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12440 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12441 Process}).
12442
12443 @node Target Commands
12444 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12445
12446 @table @code
12447 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12448 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12449 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12450 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12451 protocol of the target machine.
12452
12453 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12454 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12455 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12456
12457 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12458 after executing the command.
12459
12460 @kindex help target
12461 @item help target
12462 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12463 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12464 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12465
12466 @item help target @var{name}
12467 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12468 select it.
12469
12470 @kindex set gnutarget
12471 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12472 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12473 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12474 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12475 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12476 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12477
12478 @quotation
12479 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12480 you must know the actual BFD name.
12481 @end quotation
12482
12483 @noindent
12484 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12485
12486 @kindex show gnutarget
12487 @item show gnutarget
12488 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12489 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12490 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12491 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12492 @end table
12493
12494 @cindex common targets
12495 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12496 configuration):
12497
12498 @table @code
12499 @kindex target
12500 @item target exec @var{program}
12501 @cindex executable file target
12502 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12503 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12504
12505 @item target core @var{filename}
12506 @cindex core dump file target
12507 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12508 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12509
12510 @item target remote @var{medium}
12511 @cindex remote target
12512 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12513 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12514 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12515
12516 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12517 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12518
12519 @smallexample
12520 target remote /dev/ttya
12521 @end smallexample
12522
12523 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12524 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12525 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12526 clobbered by the download.
12527
12528 @item target sim
12529 @cindex built-in simulator target
12530 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12531 In general,
12532 @smallexample
12533 target sim
12534 load
12535 run
12536 @end smallexample
12537 @noindent
12538 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12539 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12540 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12541 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12542 Processors}.
12543
12544 @end table
12545
12546 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12547
12548 @table @code
12549
12550 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12551 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12552 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12553
12554 @end table
12555
12556 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12557 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12558
12559 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12560 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12561 various aspects of this process.
12562
12563 @table @code
12564
12565 @item set hash
12566 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12567 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12568 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12569 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12570 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12571 monitor.
12572
12573 @item show hash
12574 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12575 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12576
12577 @item set debug monitor
12578 @kindex set debug monitor
12579 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12580 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12581 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12582
12583 @item show debug monitor
12584 @kindex show debug monitor
12585 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12586 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12587 @end table
12588
12589 @table @code
12590
12591 @kindex load @var{filename}
12592 @item load @var{filename}
12593 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12594 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12595 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12596 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12597 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12598 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12599
12600 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12601 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12602 target is @dots{}}''
12603
12604 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12605 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12606 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12607 specifies a fixed address.
12608 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12609
12610 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12611 load programs into flash memory.
12612
12613 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12614 @end table
12615
12616 @node Byte Order
12617 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12618
12619 @cindex choosing target byte order
12620 @cindex target byte order
12621
12622 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12623 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12624 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12625 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12626 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12627 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12628
12629 @table @code
12630 @kindex set endian
12631 @item set endian big
12632 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12633
12634 @item set endian little
12635 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12636
12637 @item set endian auto
12638 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12639 executable.
12640
12641 @item show endian
12642 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12643
12644 @end table
12645
12646 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12647 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12648 target system.
12649
12650
12651 @node Remote Debugging
12652 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12653 @cindex remote debugging
12654
12655 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12656 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12657 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12658 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12659 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12660
12661 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12662 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12663 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12664 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12665 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12666 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12667
12668 Other remote targets may be available in your
12669 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12670
12671 @menu
12672 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12673 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12674 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12675 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12676 @end menu
12677
12678 @node Connecting
12679 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
12680
12681 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12682 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12683 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12684 program as the first argument.
12685
12686 @cindex @code{target remote}
12687 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12688 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12689 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12690 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12691 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12692 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12693
12694 @table @code
12695
12696 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12697 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12698 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12699 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12700
12701 @smallexample
12702 target remote /dev/ttyb
12703 @end smallexample
12704
12705 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12706 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12707 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12708 @code{target} command.
12709
12710 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12711 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12712 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12713 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12714 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12715 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12716 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12717 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12718 target.
12719
12720 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12721 @code{manyfarms}:
12722
12723 @smallexample
12724 target remote manyfarms:2828
12725 @end smallexample
12726
12727 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12728 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12729 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12730 port 1234 on your local machine:
12731
12732 @smallexample
12733 target remote :1234
12734 @end smallexample
12735 @noindent
12736
12737 Note that the colon is still required here.
12738
12739 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12740 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12741 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12742 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12743
12744 @smallexample
12745 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12746 @end smallexample
12747
12748 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12749 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12750 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12751 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12752
12753 @item target remote | @var{command}
12754 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12755 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12756 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12757 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12758 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12759 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12760 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12761 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12762
12763 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12764 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12765 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12766
12767 @end table
12768
12769 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12770 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12771 remote program.
12772
12773 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12774 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12775 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12776 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12777 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12778 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12779 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12780
12781 @smallexample
12782 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12783 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12784 @end smallexample
12785
12786 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12787 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12788 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12789 goes back to waiting.
12790
12791 @table @code
12792 @kindex detach (remote)
12793 @item detach
12794 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12795 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12796 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12797 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12798 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12799
12800 @kindex disconnect
12801 @item disconnect
12802 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12803 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12804 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12805 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12806 another target.
12807
12808 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12809 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12810 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12811 @kindex monitor
12812 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12813 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12814 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12815 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12816 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12817 and implement.
12818 @end table
12819
12820 @node Server
12821 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
12822
12823 @kindex gdbserver
12824 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12825 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12826 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12827 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12828
12829 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12830 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12831 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12832 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12833 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12834 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12835 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12836 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12837 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12838 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12839 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12840 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12841 choice for debugging.
12842
12843 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12844 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12845 protocol.
12846
12847 @table @emph
12848 @item On the target machine,
12849 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12850 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12851 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12852 system does all the symbol handling.
12853
12854 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12855 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12856 syntax is:
12857
12858 @smallexample
12859 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12860 @end smallexample
12861
12862 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12863 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12864 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12865 @file{/dev/com1}:
12866
12867 @smallexample
12868 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12869 @end smallexample
12870
12871 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12872 with it.
12873
12874 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12875
12876 @smallexample
12877 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12878 @end smallexample
12879
12880 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12881 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12882 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12883 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12884 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12885 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12886 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12887 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12888 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12889 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12890 @code{target remote} command.
12891
12892 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12893 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12894
12895 @smallexample
12896 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12897 @end smallexample
12898
12899 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12900 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12901
12902 @pindex pidof
12903 @cindex attach to a program by name
12904 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12905 @code{pidof} utility:
12906
12907 @smallexample
12908 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{program}`
12909 @end smallexample
12910
12911 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
12912 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12913 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12914
12915 @item On the host machine,
12916 first make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
12917 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
12918 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
12919 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-system-root}).
12920
12921 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
12922 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
12923 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
12924 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
12925 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
12926 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
12927 programs.
12928
12929 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
12930 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12931 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12932 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12933 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12934 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12935 already on the target.
12936
12937 @end table
12938
12939 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
12940 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
12941
12942 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
12943 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
12944 Here are the available commands; they are only of interest when
12945 debugging @value{GDBN} or @code{gdbserver}.
12946
12947 @table @code
12948 @item monitor help
12949 List the available monitor commands.
12950
12951 @item monitor set debug 0
12952 @itemx monitor set debug 1
12953 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
12954
12955 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
12956 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
12957 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
12958 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
12959
12960 @end table
12961
12962 @node Remote Configuration
12963 @section Remote Configuration
12964
12965 @kindex set remote
12966 @kindex show remote
12967 This section documents the configuration options available when
12968 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12969 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12970 system-call-allowed}.
12971
12972 @table @code
12973 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12974 @cindex address size for remote targets
12975 @cindex bits in remote address
12976 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12977 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12978 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12979 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12980
12981 @item show remoteaddresssize
12982 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12983
12984 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12985 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12986 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12987 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12988 remote targets.
12989
12990 @item show remotebaud
12991 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12992
12993 @item set remotebreak
12994 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12995 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12996 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12997 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12998 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
12999 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13000 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13001 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13002
13003 @item show remotebreak
13004 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13005 interrupt the remote program.
13006
13007 @item set remoteflow on
13008 @itemx set remoteflow off
13009 @kindex set remoteflow
13010 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13011 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13012
13013 @item show remoteflow
13014 @kindex show remoteflow
13015 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13016
13017 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13018 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13019 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13020 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13021 @code{ascii}.
13022
13023 @item show remotelogbase
13024 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13025 protocol.
13026
13027 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13028 @cindex record serial communications on file
13029 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13030 default is not to record at all.
13031
13032 @item show remotelogfile.
13033 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13034 serial communications.
13035
13036 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13037 @cindex timeout for serial communications
13038 @cindex remote timeout
13039 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13040 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13041
13042 @item show remotetimeout
13043 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13044 responses.
13045
13046 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13047 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13048 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13049 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13050 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13051 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13052 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13053 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13054 @end table
13055
13056 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13057 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13058 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13059 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13060 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13061 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13062 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13063 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13064 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13065
13066 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13067 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13068 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13069 @value{GDBN} developers.
13070
13071 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13072 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13073 are:
13074
13075 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13076 @item Command Name
13077 @tab Remote Packet
13078 @tab Related Features
13079
13080 @item @code{fetch-register}
13081 @tab @code{p}
13082 @tab @code{info registers}
13083
13084 @item @code{set-register}
13085 @tab @code{P}
13086 @tab @code{set}
13087
13088 @item @code{binary-download}
13089 @tab @code{X}
13090 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13091
13092 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13093 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13094 @tab @code{info auxv}
13095
13096 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13097 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13098 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13099
13100 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13101 @tab @code{vCont}
13102 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13103
13104 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13105 @tab @code{Z0}
13106 @tab @code{break}
13107
13108 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13109 @tab @code{Z1}
13110 @tab @code{hbreak}
13111
13112 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13113 @tab @code{Z2}
13114 @tab @code{watch}
13115
13116 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13117 @tab @code{Z3}
13118 @tab @code{rwatch}
13119
13120 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13121 @tab @code{Z4}
13122 @tab @code{awatch}
13123
13124 @item @code{target-features}
13125 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13126 @tab @code{set architecture}
13127
13128 @item @code{library-info}
13129 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13130 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13131
13132 @item @code{memory-map}
13133 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13134 @tab @code{info mem}
13135
13136 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13137 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13138 @tab @code{info spu}
13139
13140 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13141 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13142 @tab @code{info spu}
13143
13144 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13145 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13146 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13147
13148 @item @code{supported-packets}
13149 @tab @code{qSupported}
13150 @tab Remote communications parameters
13151
13152 @item @code{pass-signals}
13153 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
13154 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13155
13156 @end multitable
13157
13158 @node Remote Stub
13159 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
13160
13161 @cindex debugging stub, example
13162 @cindex remote stub, example
13163 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
13164 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13165 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13166 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13167 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13168 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13169 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13170 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13171
13172 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13173 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13174 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13175 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13176 program, you need:
13177
13178 @enumerate
13179 @item
13180 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13181 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13182 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13183
13184 @item
13185 A C subroutine library to support your program's
13186 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13187
13188 @item
13189 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13190 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13191 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13192 documentation.
13193 @end enumerate
13194
13195 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13196 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13197 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13198
13199 @table @emph
13200 @item On the host,
13201 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13202 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13203 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13204
13205 @item On the target,
13206 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13207 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13208 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13209
13210 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13211 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13212 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13213 @end table
13214
13215 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13216 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13217 @sc{sparc} boards.
13218
13219 @cindex remote serial stub list
13220 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13221
13222 @table @code
13223
13224 @item i386-stub.c
13225 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13226 @cindex Intel
13227 @cindex i386
13228 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13229
13230 @item m68k-stub.c
13231 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13232 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13233 @cindex m680x0
13234 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13235
13236 @item sh-stub.c
13237 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13238 @cindex Renesas
13239 @cindex SH
13240 For Renesas SH architectures.
13241
13242 @item sparc-stub.c
13243 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13244 @cindex Sparc
13245 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13246
13247 @item sparcl-stub.c
13248 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13249 @cindex Fujitsu
13250 @cindex SparcLite
13251 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13252
13253 @end table
13254
13255 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13256 recently added stubs.
13257
13258 @menu
13259 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13260 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13261 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13262 @end menu
13263
13264 @node Stub Contents
13265 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13266
13267 @cindex remote serial stub
13268 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13269 subroutines:
13270
13271 @table @code
13272 @item set_debug_traps
13273 @findex set_debug_traps
13274 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13275 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13276 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13277 beginning of your program.
13278
13279 @item handle_exception
13280 @findex handle_exception
13281 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13282 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13283 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13284 run when a trap is triggered.
13285
13286 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13287 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13288 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13289 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13290 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13291 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13292 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13293 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13294 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13295 machine.
13296
13297 @item breakpoint
13298 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13299 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13300 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13301 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13302 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13303 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13304 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13305 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13306 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13307 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13308 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13309
13310 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13311 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13312 start of your debugging session.
13313 @end table
13314
13315 @node Bootstrapping
13316 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13317
13318 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13319 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13320 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13321 debugging target machine.
13322
13323 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13324 serial port.
13325
13326 @table @code
13327 @item int getDebugChar()
13328 @findex getDebugChar
13329 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13330 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13331 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13332
13333 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13334 @findex putDebugChar
13335 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13336 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13337 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13338 @end table
13339
13340 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13341 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13342 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13343 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13344 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13345 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13346 remote system to stop.
13347
13348 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13349 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13350 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13351 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13352
13353 Other routines you need to supply are:
13354
13355 @table @code
13356 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13357 @findex exceptionHandler
13358 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13359 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13360 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13361 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13362 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13363 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13364 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13365 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13366 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13367 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13368 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13369 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13370 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13371
13372 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13373 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13374 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13375 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13376 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13377
13378 @item void flush_i_cache()
13379 @findex flush_i_cache
13380 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13381 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13382 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13383
13384 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13385 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13386 @end table
13387
13388 @noindent
13389 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13390
13391 @table @code
13392 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13393 @findex memset
13394 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13395 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13396 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13397 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13398 @end table
13399
13400 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13401 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13402 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13403 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13404
13405
13406 @node Debug Session
13407 @subsection Putting it All Together
13408
13409 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13410 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13411 steps.
13412
13413 @enumerate
13414 @item
13415 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13416 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13417 @display
13418 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13419 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13420 @end display
13421
13422 @item
13423 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13424
13425 @smallexample
13426 set_debug_traps();
13427 breakpoint();
13428 @end smallexample
13429
13430 @item
13431 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13432 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13433
13434 @smallexample
13435 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13436 @end smallexample
13437
13438 @noindent
13439 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13440 function in your program, that function is called when
13441 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13442 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13443 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13444
13445 @item
13446 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13447 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13448
13449 @item
13450 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13451 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13452
13453 @item
13454 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13455 @c document that. FIXME.
13456 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13457 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13458
13459 @item
13460 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13461 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13462
13463 @end enumerate
13464
13465 @node Configurations
13466 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13467
13468 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13469 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13470 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13471
13472 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13473 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13474 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13475 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13476 are quite different from each other.
13477
13478 @menu
13479 * Native::
13480 * Embedded OS::
13481 * Embedded Processors::
13482 * Architectures::
13483 @end menu
13484
13485 @node Native
13486 @section Native
13487
13488 This section describes details specific to particular native
13489 configurations.
13490
13491 @menu
13492 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13493 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13494 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13495 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13496 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13497 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13498 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13499 @end menu
13500
13501 @node HP-UX
13502 @subsection HP-UX
13503
13504 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13505 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13506 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13507
13508
13509 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13510 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13511
13512 @cindex libkvm
13513 @cindex kernel memory image
13514 @cindex kernel crash dump
13515
13516 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13517 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13518 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13519 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13520 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13521 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13522 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13523 @code{kvm} target:
13524
13525 @smallexample
13526 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13527 @end smallexample
13528
13529 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13530 argument:
13531
13532 @smallexample
13533 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13534 @end smallexample
13535
13536 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13537 available:
13538
13539 @table @code
13540 @kindex kvm
13541 @item kvm pcb
13542 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13543
13544 @item kvm proc
13545 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13546 modern FreeBSD systems.
13547 @end table
13548
13549 @node SVR4 Process Information
13550 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
13551 @cindex /proc
13552 @cindex examine process image
13553 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13554
13555 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13556 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13557 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13558 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13559 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13560 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13561 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13562 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13563 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13564
13565 @table @code
13566 @kindex info proc
13567 @cindex process ID
13568 @item info proc
13569 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13570 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13571 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13572 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13573 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13574 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13575 executable file's absolute file name.
13576
13577 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13578 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13579 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13580 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13581 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13582 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13583
13584 @item info proc mappings
13585 @cindex memory address space mappings
13586 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13587 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13588 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13589 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13590 memory access rights to that range.
13591
13592 @item info proc stat
13593 @itemx info proc status
13594 @cindex process detailed status information
13595 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13596 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13597 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13598 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13599 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13600 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13601 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13602
13603 @item info proc all
13604 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13605 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13606
13607 @ignore
13608 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13609 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13610 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13611 @kindex info proc times
13612 @item info proc times
13613 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13614 its children.
13615
13616 @kindex info proc id
13617 @item info proc id
13618 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13619 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13620 @end ignore
13621
13622 @item set procfs-trace
13623 @kindex set procfs-trace
13624 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13625 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13626
13627 @item show procfs-trace
13628 @kindex show procfs-trace
13629 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13630
13631 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13632 @kindex set procfs-file
13633 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13634 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13635 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13636 standard output.
13637
13638 @item show procfs-file
13639 @kindex show procfs-file
13640 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13641
13642 @item proc-trace-entry
13643 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13644 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13645 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13646 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13647 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13648 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13649 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13650 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13651 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13652
13653 @item info pidlist
13654 @kindex info pidlist
13655 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13656 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13657 processes and all the threads within each process.
13658
13659 @item info meminfo
13660 @kindex info meminfo
13661 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13662 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13663 @end table
13664
13665 @node DJGPP Native
13666 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13667 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13668 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13669 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13670
13671 @cindex DPMI
13672 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13673 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13674 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13675 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13676
13677 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13678 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13679 subsection describes those commands.
13680
13681 @table @code
13682 @kindex info dos
13683 @item info dos
13684 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13685 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13686
13687 @kindex sysinfo
13688 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13689 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13690 @item info dos sysinfo
13691 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13692 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13693 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13694
13695 @cindex GDT
13696 @cindex LDT
13697 @cindex IDT
13698 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13699 @cindex descriptor tables display
13700 @item info dos gdt
13701 @itemx info dos ldt
13702 @itemx info dos idt
13703 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13704 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13705 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13706 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13707 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13708 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13709 rights.
13710
13711 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13712 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13713 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13714 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13715 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13716
13717 @cindex garbled pointers
13718 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13719 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13720 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13721 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13722 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13723 debugged program's data segment:
13724
13725 @smallexample
13726 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13727 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13728 @end smallexample
13729
13730 @noindent
13731 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13732 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13733
13734 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13735 @item info dos pde
13736 @itemx info dos pte
13737 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13738 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13739 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13740 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13741 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13742 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13743 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13744 that is currently in use.
13745
13746 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13747 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13748 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13749 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13750 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13751 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13752 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13753
13754 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13755 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13756 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13757 controller.
13758
13759 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13760
13761 @cindex physical address from linear address
13762 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13763 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13764 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13765 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13766 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13767 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13768 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13769
13770 @smallexample
13771 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13772 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13773 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13774 @end smallexample
13775
13776 @noindent
13777 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13778 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13779 attributes of that page.
13780
13781 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13782 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13783 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13784 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13785 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13786 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13787
13788 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13789 transfer buffer:
13790
13791 @smallexample
13792 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13793 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13794 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13795 @end smallexample
13796
13797 @noindent
13798 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13799 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13800 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13801 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13802 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13803
13804 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13805 @end table
13806
13807 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13808 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13809 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13810 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13811
13812 @table @code
13813 @kindex set com1base
13814 @kindex set com1irq
13815 @kindex set com2base
13816 @kindex set com2irq
13817 @kindex set com3base
13818 @kindex set com3irq
13819 @kindex set com4base
13820 @kindex set com4irq
13821 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13822 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13823 port.
13824
13825 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13826 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13827 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13828
13829 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13830 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13831 other 3 COM ports.
13832
13833 @kindex show com1base
13834 @kindex show com1irq
13835 @kindex show com2base
13836 @kindex show com2irq
13837 @kindex show com3base
13838 @kindex show com3irq
13839 @kindex show com4base
13840 @kindex show com4irq
13841 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13842 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13843 lines used by the COM ports.
13844
13845 @item info serial
13846 @kindex info serial
13847 @cindex DOS serial port status
13848 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13849 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13850 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13851 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13852 @end table
13853
13854
13855 @node Cygwin Native
13856 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
13857 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13858 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13859 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13860
13861 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13862 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13863 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
13864 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
13865 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
13866
13867 @table @code
13868 @kindex info w32
13869 @item info w32
13870 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
13871 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13872
13873 @item info w32 selector
13874 This command displays information returned by
13875 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13876 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13877 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13878 Without argument, this command displays information
13879 about the six segment registers.
13880
13881 @kindex info dll
13882 @item info dll
13883 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
13884
13885 @kindex dll-symbols
13886 @item dll-symbols
13887 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13888 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13889
13890 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13891 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13892 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13893 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13894 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13895 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13896 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13897 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13898 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13899 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13900 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13901
13902 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13903 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13904 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13905 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13906
13907 @kindex set new-console
13908 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13909 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13910 be started in a new console on next start.
13911 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13912 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13913
13914 @kindex show new-console
13915 @item show new-console
13916 Displays whether a new console is used
13917 when the debuggee is started.
13918
13919 @kindex set new-group
13920 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13921 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13922 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13923 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13924 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
13925
13926 @kindex show new-group
13927 @item show new-group
13928 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13929
13930 @kindex set debugevents
13931 @item set debugevents
13932 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13933 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13934 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13935 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13936 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13937
13938 @kindex set debugexec
13939 @item set debugexec
13940 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13941 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13942
13943 @kindex set debugexceptions
13944 @item set debugexceptions
13945 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13946 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13947
13948 @kindex set debugmemory
13949 @item set debugmemory
13950 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13951 and writes by the debugger.
13952
13953 @kindex set shell
13954 @item set shell
13955 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13956 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13957
13958 @kindex show shell
13959 @item show shell
13960 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13961
13962 @end table
13963
13964 @menu
13965 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13966 @end menu
13967
13968 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
13969 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
13970 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13971 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13972
13973 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13974 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13975 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13976 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13977 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
13978 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13979 ``minimal symbols''.
13980
13981 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13982 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13983 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13984 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13985 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13986 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
13987 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13988 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13989 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13990 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13991
13992 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
13993
13994 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13995 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13996 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13997 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13998 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13999 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14000 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14001 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14002 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14003
14004 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14005 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14006 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14007 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14008 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14009 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14010
14011 @smallexample
14012 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14013 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14014
14015 Non-debugging symbols:
14016 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
14017 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14018 @end smallexample
14019
14020 @smallexample
14021 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
14022 All functions matching regular expression "!":
14023
14024 Non-debugging symbols:
14025 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
14026 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
14027 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14028 [etc...]
14029 @end smallexample
14030
14031 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14032
14033 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14034 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14035 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14036 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14037 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14038 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14039 a function within a DLL without a running program.
14040
14041 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14042 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14043 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14044 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14045 problem:
14046
14047 @smallexample
14048 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14049 $1 = 268572168
14050 @end smallexample
14051
14052 @smallexample
14053 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
14054 0x10021610: "\230y\""
14055 @end smallexample
14056
14057 And two possible solutions:
14058
14059 @smallexample
14060 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14061 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14062 @end smallexample
14063
14064 @smallexample
14065 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14066 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14067 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14068 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14069 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14070 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14071 @end smallexample
14072
14073 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14074 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14075 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14076 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14077 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14078
14079 @smallexample
14080 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14081 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14082 @end smallexample
14083
14084 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14085 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14086 safe.
14087
14088 @node Hurd Native
14089 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14090 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14091
14092 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14093 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14094
14095 @table @code
14096 @item set signals
14097 @itemx set sigs
14098 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14099 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14100 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14101 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14102 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14103 @code{signals}.
14104
14105 @item show signals
14106 @itemx show sigs
14107 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14108 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14109 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14110
14111 @item set signal-thread
14112 @itemx set sigthread
14113 @kindex set signal-thread
14114 @kindex set sigthread
14115 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14116 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14117 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14118 signal-thread}.
14119
14120 @item show signal-thread
14121 @itemx show sigthread
14122 @kindex show signal-thread
14123 @kindex show sigthread
14124 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14125 delivered a signal.
14126
14127 @item set stopped
14128 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14129 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14130 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14131 continued by delivering a signal to it.
14132
14133 @item show stopped
14134 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14135 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14136 stopped.
14137
14138 @item set exceptions
14139 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14140 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14141 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14142 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14143 trapping on.
14144
14145 @item show exceptions
14146 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14147 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14148
14149 @item set task pause
14150 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14151 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14152 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14153 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14154 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14155 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14156 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14157 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14158 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14159
14160 @item show task pause
14161 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14162 Show the current state of task suspension.
14163
14164 @item set task detach-suspend-count
14165 @cindex task suspend count
14166 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14167 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14168 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14169
14170 @item show task detach-suspend-count
14171 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14172
14173 @item set task exception-port
14174 @itemx set task excp
14175 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14176 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14177 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14178 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14179
14180 @item set noninvasive
14181 @cindex noninvasive task options
14182 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14183 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14184 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14185 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14186
14187 @item info send-rights
14188 @itemx info receive-rights
14189 @itemx info port-rights
14190 @itemx info port-sets
14191 @itemx info dead-names
14192 @itemx info ports
14193 @itemx info psets
14194 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14195 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14196 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14197 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14198 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14199 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14200 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14201 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14202 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14203
14204 @item set thread pause
14205 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14206 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14207 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14208 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14209 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14210 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14211 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14212 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14213 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14214 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14215 only the current thread.
14216
14217 @item show thread pause
14218 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14219 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14220
14221 @item set thread run
14222 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14223
14224 @item show thread run
14225 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14226
14227 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14228 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14229 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14230 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14231 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14232 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14233 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14234
14235 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14236 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14237 detaching.
14238
14239 @item set thread exception-port
14240 @itemx set thread excp
14241 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14242 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14243 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14244
14245 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14246 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14247 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14248 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14249
14250 @item set thread default
14251 @itemx show thread default
14252 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14253 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14254 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14255 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14256 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14257 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14258 the non-default commands.
14259 @end table
14260
14261
14262 @node Neutrino
14263 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14264 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14265
14266 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14267 Neutrino target:
14268
14269 @table @code
14270 @item set debug nto-debug
14271 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14272 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14273 Neutrino support.
14274
14275 @item show debug nto-debug
14276 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14277 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14278 @end table
14279
14280
14281 @node Embedded OS
14282 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14283
14284 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14285 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14286 architectures.
14287
14288 @menu
14289 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14290 @end menu
14291
14292 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14293 various real-time operating systems.
14294
14295 @node VxWorks
14296 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14297
14298 @cindex VxWorks
14299
14300 @table @code
14301
14302 @kindex target vxworks
14303 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14304 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14305 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14306
14307 @end table
14308
14309 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14310 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14311
14312 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14313 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14314 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14315 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14316 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14317 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14318 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14319
14320 @table @code
14321 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14322 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14323 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14324 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14325 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14326 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14327 of a thin network line.
14328 @end table
14329
14330 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14331 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14332 procedures.
14333
14334 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14335 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14336 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14337 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14338 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14339 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14340 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14341 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14342 manual.
14343 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14344
14345 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14346 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14347 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14348 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14349
14350 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14351
14352 @smallexample
14353 (vxgdb)
14354 @end smallexample
14355
14356 @menu
14357 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14358 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14359 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14360 @end menu
14361
14362 @node VxWorks Connection
14363 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14364
14365 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14366 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14367
14368 @smallexample
14369 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14370 @end smallexample
14371
14372 @need 750
14373 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14374
14375 @smallexample
14376 Attaching remote machine across net...
14377 Connected to tt.
14378 @end smallexample
14379
14380 @need 1000
14381 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14382 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14383 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14384 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14385 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14386
14387 @smallexample
14388 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14389 @end smallexample
14390
14391 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14392 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14393 command again.
14394
14395 @node VxWorks Download
14396 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14397
14398 @cindex download to VxWorks
14399 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14400 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14401 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14402 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14403 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14404 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14405 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14406 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14407 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14408 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14409 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14410 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14411 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14412 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14413 program, type this on VxWorks:
14414
14415 @smallexample
14416 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14417 @end smallexample
14418
14419 @noindent
14420 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14421
14422 @smallexample
14423 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14424 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14425 @end smallexample
14426
14427 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14428
14429 @smallexample
14430 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14431 @end smallexample
14432
14433 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14434 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14435 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14436 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14437 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14438 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14439 table.)
14440
14441 @node VxWorks Attach
14442 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14443
14444 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14445 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14446 follows:
14447
14448 @smallexample
14449 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14450 @end smallexample
14451
14452 @noindent
14453 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14454 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14455 the time of attachment.
14456
14457 @node Embedded Processors
14458 @section Embedded Processors
14459
14460 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14461 configurations.
14462
14463 @cindex send command to simulator
14464 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14465 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14466
14467 @table @code
14468 @item sim @var{command}
14469 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14470 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14471 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14472 acceptable commands.
14473 @end table
14474
14475
14476 @menu
14477 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14478 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14479 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14480 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14481 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14482 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14483 * PowerPC:: PowerPC
14484 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14485 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14486 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14487 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14488 * CRIS:: CRIS
14489 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14490 @end menu
14491
14492 @node ARM
14493 @subsection ARM
14494 @cindex ARM RDI
14495
14496 @table @code
14497 @kindex target rdi
14498 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14499 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14500 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14501 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14502
14503 @kindex target rdp
14504 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14505 ARM Demon monitor.
14506
14507 @end table
14508
14509 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14510
14511 @table @code
14512 @item set arm disassembler
14513 @kindex set arm
14514 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14515 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14516
14517 @item show arm disassembler
14518 @kindex show arm
14519 Show the current disassembly style.
14520
14521 @item set arm apcs32
14522 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14523 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14524
14525 @item show arm apcs32
14526 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14527
14528 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14529 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14530 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14531
14532 @table @code
14533 @item auto
14534 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14535 @item softfpa
14536 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14537 processors.
14538 @item fpa
14539 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14540 @item softvfp
14541 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14542 @item vfp
14543 VFP co-processor.
14544 @end table
14545
14546 @item show arm fpu
14547 Show the current type of the FPU.
14548
14549 @item set arm abi
14550 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14551
14552 @item show arm abi
14553 Show the currently used ABI.
14554
14555 @item set debug arm
14556 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14557 target support subsystem.
14558
14559 @item show debug arm
14560 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14561 @end table
14562
14563 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14564 using the RDI interface:
14565
14566 @table @code
14567 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14568 @kindex rdilogfile
14569 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14570 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14571 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14572 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14573 @file{rdi.log}.
14574
14575 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14576 @kindex rdilogenable
14577 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14578 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14579 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14580 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14581 are logged to a file.
14582
14583 @item set rdiromatzero
14584 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14585 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14586 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14587 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14588 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14589 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14590
14591 @item show rdiromatzero
14592 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14593 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14594
14595 @item set rdiheartbeat
14596 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14597 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14598 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14599 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14600 well as the Angel monitor.
14601
14602 @item show rdiheartbeat
14603 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14604 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14605 @end table
14606
14607
14608 @node M32R/D
14609 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14610
14611 @table @code
14612 @kindex target m32r
14613 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14614 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14615
14616 @kindex target m32rsdi
14617 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14618 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14619 @end table
14620
14621 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14622
14623 @table @code
14624 @item set download-path @var{path}
14625 @kindex set download-path
14626 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14627 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14628
14629 @item show download-path
14630 @kindex show download-path
14631 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14632
14633 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14634 @kindex set board-address
14635 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14636 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14637
14638 @item show board-address
14639 @kindex show board-address
14640 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14641
14642 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14643 @kindex set server-address
14644 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14645 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14646 host machine.
14647
14648 @item show server-address
14649 @kindex show server-address
14650 Display the IP address of the download server.
14651
14652 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14653 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14654 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14655 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14656 executable file is uploaded.
14657
14658 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14659 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14660 Test the @code{upload} command.
14661 @end table
14662
14663 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14664
14665 @table @code
14666 @item sdireset
14667 @kindex sdireset
14668 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14669 This command resets the SDI connection.
14670
14671 @item sdistatus
14672 @kindex sdistatus
14673 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14674
14675 @item debug_chaos
14676 @kindex debug_chaos
14677 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14678 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14679
14680 @item use_debug_dma
14681 @kindex use_debug_dma
14682 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14683
14684 @item use_mon_code
14685 @kindex use_mon_code
14686 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14687
14688 @item use_ib_break
14689 @kindex use_ib_break
14690 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14691
14692 @item use_dbt_break
14693 @kindex use_dbt_break
14694 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14695 @end table
14696
14697 @node M68K
14698 @subsection M68k
14699
14700 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
14701 target command for the following ROM monitor.
14702
14703 @table @code
14704
14705 @kindex target dbug
14706 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14707 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14708
14709 @end table
14710
14711 @node MIPS Embedded
14712 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14713
14714 @cindex MIPS boards
14715 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14716 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14717 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14718
14719 @need 1000
14720 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14721
14722 @table @code
14723 @item target mips @var{port}
14724 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14725 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14726 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14727 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14728 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14729 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14730 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14731
14732 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14733 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14734 debugger:
14735
14736 @smallexample
14737 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14738 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14739 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14740 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14741 (@value{GDBP}) run
14742 @end smallexample
14743
14744 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14745 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14746 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14747 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14748 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14749
14750 @item target pmon @var{port}
14751 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14752 PMON ROM monitor.
14753
14754 @item target ddb @var{port}
14755 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14756 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14757
14758 @item target lsi @var{port}
14759 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14760 LSI variant of PMON.
14761
14762 @kindex target r3900
14763 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14764 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14765
14766 @kindex target array
14767 @item target array @var{dev}
14768 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14769
14770 @end table
14771
14772
14773 @noindent
14774 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14775
14776 @table @code
14777 @item set mipsfpu double
14778 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14779 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14780 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14781 @itemx show mipsfpu
14782 @kindex set mipsfpu
14783 @kindex show mipsfpu
14784 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14785 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14786 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14787 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14788 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14789 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14790 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14791 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14792 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14793 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14794 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14795 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14796 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14797
14798 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14799 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14800 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14801
14802 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14803 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14804
14805 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14806 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14807 @itemx show timeout
14808 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14809 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14810 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14811 @kindex set timeout
14812 @kindex show timeout
14813 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14814 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14815 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14816 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14817 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14818 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14819 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14820 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14821 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14822 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14823
14824 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14825 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14826 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14827 to run before stopping.
14828
14829 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14830 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14831 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14832 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14833 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14834 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14835
14836 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14837 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14838 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14839 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14840
14841 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14842 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14843 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14844 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14845 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14846 @table @asis
14847 @item pmon target
14848 @samp{PMON}
14849 @item ddb target
14850 @samp{NEC010}
14851 @item lsi target
14852 @samp{PMON>}
14853 @end table
14854
14855 @item show monitor-prompt
14856 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14857 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14858 remote monitor.
14859
14860 @item set monitor-warnings
14861 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14862 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14863 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14864 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14865 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14866
14867 @item show monitor-warnings
14868 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14869 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14870
14871 @item pmon @var{command}
14872 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14873 @cindex send PMON command
14874 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14875 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14876 @end table
14877
14878 @node OpenRISC 1000
14879 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14880 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14881
14882 @cindex or1k boards
14883 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14884 about platform and commands.
14885
14886 @table @code
14887
14888 @kindex target jtag
14889 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14890
14891 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14892 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14893 connected via parallel port to the board.
14894
14895 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14896
14897 @kindex or1ksim
14898 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14899 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14900 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14901
14902 @kindex info or1k spr
14903 @item info or1k spr
14904 Displays spr groups.
14905
14906 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14907 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14908 Displays register names in selected group.
14909
14910 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14911 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14912 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14913 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14914 Shows information about specified spr register.
14915
14916 @kindex spr
14917 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14918 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14919 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14920 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14921 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14922 @end table
14923
14924 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14925 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14926 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14927 triggers can be set using:
14928 @table @code
14929 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14930 Load effective address/data
14931 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14932 Store effective address/data
14933 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14934 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14935 @item $FETCH
14936 Fetch data
14937 @end table
14938
14939 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14940 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14941
14942 @code{htrace} commands:
14943 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14944 @table @code
14945 @kindex hwatch
14946 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14947 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
14948 or Data. For example:
14949
14950 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14951
14952 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14953
14954 @kindex htrace
14955 @item htrace info
14956 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14957
14958 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14959 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14960
14961 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14962 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14963
14964 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14965 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14966
14967 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14968 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14969 triggered.
14970
14971 @item htrace enable
14972 @itemx htrace disable
14973 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14974
14975 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14976 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14977
14978 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14979 will be written there.
14980
14981 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14982 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14983
14984 @item htrace mode continuous
14985 Set continuous trace mode.
14986
14987 @item htrace mode suspend
14988 Set suspend trace mode.
14989
14990 @end table
14991
14992 @node PowerPC
14993 @subsection PowerPC
14994
14995 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
14996
14997 @table @code
14998 @kindex set powerpc
14999 @item set powerpc soft-float
15000 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
15001 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15002 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15003 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15004
15005 @item set powerpc vector-abi
15006 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15007 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15008 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15009 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15010 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15011 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15012 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15013
15014 @kindex target dink32
15015 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15016 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15017
15018 @kindex target ppcbug
15019 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15020 @kindex target ppcbug1
15021 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15022 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15023
15024 @kindex target sds
15025 @item target sds @var{dev}
15026 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15027 @end table
15028
15029 @cindex SDS protocol
15030 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15031 by @value{GDBN}:
15032
15033 @table @code
15034 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15035 @kindex set sdstimeout
15036 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15037 default is 2 seconds.
15038
15039 @item show sdstimeout
15040 @kindex show sdstimeout
15041 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15042
15043 @item sds @var{command}
15044 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15045 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15046 @end table
15047
15048
15049 @node PA
15050 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15051
15052 @table @code
15053
15054 @kindex target op50n
15055 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15056 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15057
15058 @kindex target w89k
15059 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15060 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15061
15062 @end table
15063
15064 @node Sparclet
15065 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15066
15067 @cindex Sparclet
15068
15069 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15070 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15071 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15072 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15073 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15074
15075 @table @code
15076 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15077 @kindex remotetimeout
15078 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15079 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15080 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15081 @end table
15082
15083 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15084 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15085 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15086 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15087 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15088
15089 @smallexample
15090 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15091 @end smallexample
15092
15093 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15094
15095 @smallexample
15096 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15097 @end smallexample
15098
15099 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15100 Once you have set
15101 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15102 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15103 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15104
15105 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15106
15107 @smallexample
15108 (gdbslet)
15109 @end smallexample
15110
15111 @menu
15112 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15113 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15114 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15115 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15116 @end menu
15117
15118 @node Sparclet File
15119 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15120
15121 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15122
15123 @smallexample
15124 (gdbslet) file prog
15125 @end smallexample
15126
15127 @need 1000
15128 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15129 @value{GDBN} locates
15130 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15131 path.
15132 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15133 files will be searched as well.
15134 @value{GDBN} locates
15135 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15136 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15137 If it fails
15138 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15139
15140 @smallexample
15141 prog: No such file or directory.
15142 @end smallexample
15143
15144 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15145 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15146 @code{target} command again.
15147
15148 @node Sparclet Connection
15149 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15150
15151 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15152 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15153
15154 @smallexample
15155 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15156 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15157 main () at ../prog.c:3
15158 @end smallexample
15159
15160 @need 750
15161 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15162
15163 @smallexample
15164 Connected to ttya.
15165 @end smallexample
15166
15167 @node Sparclet Download
15168 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
15169
15170 @cindex download to Sparclet
15171 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15172 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15173 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15174 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15175 command.
15176 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15177 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15178 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15179 of each of the file's sections.
15180 For instance, if the program
15181 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15182 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15183
15184 @smallexample
15185 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15186 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15187 @end smallexample
15188
15189 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15190 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15191 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15192
15193 @node Sparclet Execution
15194 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
15195
15196 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15197 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15198 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15199 manual for the list of commands.
15200
15201 @smallexample
15202 (gdbslet) b main
15203 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15204 (gdbslet) run
15205 Starting program: prog
15206 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15207 3 char *symarg = 0;
15208 (gdbslet) step
15209 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15210 (gdbslet)
15211 @end smallexample
15212
15213 @node Sparclite
15214 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15215
15216 @table @code
15217
15218 @kindex target sparclite
15219 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15220 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15221 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15222 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15223 remote protocol.
15224
15225 @end table
15226
15227 @node Z8000
15228 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15229
15230 @cindex Z8000
15231 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15232 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15233
15234 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15235 a Z8000 simulator.
15236
15237 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15238 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15239 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15240 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15241
15242 @table @code
15243 @item target sim @var{args}
15244 @kindex sim
15245 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15246 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15247 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15248 @end table
15249
15250 @noindent
15251 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15252 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15253 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15254 to run your program, and so on.
15255
15256 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15257 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15258 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15259
15260 @table @code
15261
15262 @item cycles
15263 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15264
15265 @item insts
15266 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15267
15268 @item time
15269 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15270
15271 @end table
15272
15273 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15274 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15275 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15276 simulated clock ticks.
15277
15278 @node AVR
15279 @subsection Atmel AVR
15280 @cindex AVR
15281
15282 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15283 following AVR-specific commands:
15284
15285 @table @code
15286 @item info io_registers
15287 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15288 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15289 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15290 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15291 @end table
15292
15293 @node CRIS
15294 @subsection CRIS
15295 @cindex CRIS
15296
15297 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15298 following CRIS-specific commands:
15299
15300 @table @code
15301 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15302 @cindex CRIS version
15303 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15304 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15305 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15306
15307 @item show cris-version
15308 Show the current CRIS version.
15309
15310 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15311 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15312 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15313 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15314 @code{R59}.
15315
15316 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15317 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15318
15319 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15320 @cindex CRIS mode
15321 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15322 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15323 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15324
15325 @item show cris-mode
15326 Show the current CRIS mode.
15327 @end table
15328
15329 @node Super-H
15330 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15331 @cindex Super-H
15332
15333 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15334 commands:
15335
15336 @table @code
15337 @item regs
15338 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15339 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15340 @end table
15341
15342
15343 @node Architectures
15344 @section Architectures
15345
15346 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15347 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15348
15349 @menu
15350 * i386::
15351 * A29K::
15352 * Alpha::
15353 * MIPS::
15354 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15355 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15356 @end menu
15357
15358 @node i386
15359 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15360
15361 @table @code
15362 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15363 @kindex set struct-convention
15364 @cindex struct return convention
15365 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15366 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15367 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15368 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15369 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15370 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15371 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15372 be returned in a register.
15373
15374 @item show struct-convention
15375 @kindex show struct-convention
15376 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15377 from functions.
15378 @end table
15379
15380 @node A29K
15381 @subsection A29K
15382
15383 @table @code
15384
15385 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15386 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15387 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15388 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15389 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15390 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15391 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15392 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15393 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15394 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15395 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15396 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15397 hexadecimal.
15398
15399 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15400 @item show rstack_high_address
15401 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15402 processors.
15403
15404 @end table
15405
15406 @node Alpha
15407 @subsection Alpha
15408
15409 See the following section.
15410
15411 @node MIPS
15412 @subsection MIPS
15413
15414 @cindex stack on Alpha
15415 @cindex stack on MIPS
15416 @cindex Alpha stack
15417 @cindex MIPS stack
15418 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15419 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15420 find the beginning of a function.
15421
15422 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15423 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15424 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15425 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15426 commands:
15427
15428 @table @code
15429 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15430 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15431 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15432 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15433 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15434 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15435 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15436 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15437
15438 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15439 Display the current limit.
15440 @end table
15441
15442 @noindent
15443 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15444 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15445
15446 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15447 programs:
15448
15449 @table @code
15450 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15451 @kindex set mips abi
15452 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15453 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15454 values of @var{arg} are:
15455
15456 @table @samp
15457 @item auto
15458 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15459 default).
15460 @item o32
15461 @item o64
15462 @item n32
15463 @item n64
15464 @item eabi32
15465 @item eabi64
15466 @item auto
15467 @end table
15468
15469 @item show mips abi
15470 @kindex show mips abi
15471 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15472
15473 @item set mipsfpu
15474 @itemx show mipsfpu
15475 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15476
15477 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15478 @kindex set mips mask-address
15479 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15480 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15481 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15482 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15483 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15484
15485 @item show mips mask-address
15486 @kindex show mips mask-address
15487 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15488 not.
15489
15490 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15491 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15492 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15493 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15494 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15495 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15496
15497 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15498 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15499 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15500
15501 @item set debug mips
15502 @kindex set debug mips
15503 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15504 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15505
15506 @item show debug mips
15507 @kindex show debug mips
15508 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15509 @end table
15510
15511
15512 @node HPPA
15513 @subsection HPPA
15514 @cindex HPPA support
15515
15516 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15517 following special commands:
15518
15519 @table @code
15520 @item set debug hppa
15521 @kindex set debug hppa
15522 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15523 messages are to be displayed.
15524
15525 @item show debug hppa
15526 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15527
15528 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15529 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15530 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15531 given @var{address}.
15532
15533 @end table
15534
15535
15536 @node SPU
15537 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15538 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
15539 @cindex SPU
15540
15541 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
15542 it provides the following special commands:
15543
15544 @table @code
15545 @item info spu event
15546 @kindex info spu
15547 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
15548 and pending event status.
15549
15550 @item info spu signal
15551 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
15552 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
15553 notification channels.
15554
15555 @item info spu mailbox
15556 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
15557 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
15558 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
15559
15560 @item info spu dma
15561 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15562 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15563 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15564
15565 @item info spu proxydma
15566 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15567 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15568 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15569
15570 @end table
15571
15572
15573 @node Controlling GDB
15574 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15575
15576 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15577 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15578 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15579 described here.
15580
15581 @menu
15582 * Prompt:: Prompt
15583 * Editing:: Command editing
15584 * Command History:: Command history
15585 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15586 * Numbers:: Numbers
15587 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15588 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15589 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15590 @end menu
15591
15592 @node Prompt
15593 @section Prompt
15594
15595 @cindex prompt
15596
15597 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15598 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15599 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15600 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15601 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15602 which one you are talking to.
15603
15604 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15605 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15606 or a prompt that does not.
15607
15608 @table @code
15609 @kindex set prompt
15610 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15611 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15612
15613 @kindex show prompt
15614 @item show prompt
15615 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15616 @end table
15617
15618 @node Editing
15619 @section Command Editing
15620 @cindex readline
15621 @cindex command line editing
15622
15623 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15624 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15625 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15626 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15627 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15628 debugging sessions.
15629
15630 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15631 command @code{set}.
15632
15633 @table @code
15634 @kindex set editing
15635 @cindex editing
15636 @item set editing
15637 @itemx set editing on
15638 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15639
15640 @item set editing off
15641 Disable command line editing.
15642
15643 @kindex show editing
15644 @item show editing
15645 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15646 @end table
15647
15648 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15649 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15650 encouraged to read that chapter.
15651
15652 @node Command History
15653 @section Command History
15654 @cindex command history
15655
15656 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15657 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15658 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15659 history facility.
15660
15661 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15662 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15663 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15664
15665 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15666 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
15667 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
15668 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15669 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15670 pressed on a line by itself.
15671
15672 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15673 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15674 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15675 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15676
15677 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15678 history.
15679
15680 @table @code
15681 @cindex history substitution
15682 @cindex history file
15683 @kindex set history filename
15684 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15685 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15686 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15687 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15688 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15689 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15690 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15691 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15692 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15693 is not set.
15694
15695 @cindex save command history
15696 @kindex set history save
15697 @item set history save
15698 @itemx set history save on
15699 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15700 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15701
15702 @item set history save off
15703 Stop recording command history in a file.
15704
15705 @cindex history size
15706 @kindex set history size
15707 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15708 @item set history size @var{size}
15709 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15710 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15711 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15712 @end table
15713
15714 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15715 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15716
15717 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15718 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15719 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15720 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15721 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15722 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15723 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15724 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15725
15726 The commands to control history expansion are:
15727
15728 @table @code
15729 @item set history expansion on
15730 @itemx set history expansion
15731 @kindex set history expansion
15732 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15733
15734 @item set history expansion off
15735 Disable history expansion.
15736
15737 @c @group
15738 @kindex show history
15739 @item show history
15740 @itemx show history filename
15741 @itemx show history save
15742 @itemx show history size
15743 @itemx show history expansion
15744 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15745 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15746 @c @end group
15747 @end table
15748
15749 @table @code
15750 @kindex show commands
15751 @cindex show last commands
15752 @cindex display command history
15753 @item show commands
15754 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15755
15756 @item show commands @var{n}
15757 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15758
15759 @item show commands +
15760 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15761 @end table
15762
15763 @node Screen Size
15764 @section Screen Size
15765 @cindex size of screen
15766 @cindex pauses in output
15767
15768 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15769 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15770 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15771 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15772 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15773 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15774 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15775 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15776
15777 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15778 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15779 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15780 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15781 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15782 width} commands:
15783
15784 @table @code
15785 @kindex set height
15786 @kindex set width
15787 @kindex show width
15788 @kindex show height
15789 @item set height @var{lpp}
15790 @itemx show height
15791 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15792 @itemx show width
15793 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15794 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15795 commands display the current settings.
15796
15797 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15798 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15799 file or to an editor buffer.
15800
15801 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15802 from wrapping its output.
15803
15804 @item set pagination on
15805 @itemx set pagination off
15806 @kindex set pagination
15807 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15808 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15809
15810 @item show pagination
15811 @kindex show pagination
15812 Show the current pagination mode.
15813 @end table
15814
15815 @node Numbers
15816 @section Numbers
15817 @cindex number representation
15818 @cindex entering numbers
15819
15820 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15821 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15822 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15823 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15824 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15825 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15826 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15827 both input and output with the commands described below.
15828
15829 @table @code
15830 @kindex set input-radix
15831 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15832 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15833 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15834 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15835 example, any of
15836
15837 @smallexample
15838 set input-radix 012
15839 set input-radix 10.
15840 set input-radix 0xa
15841 @end smallexample
15842
15843 @noindent
15844 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15845 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15846 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15847 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15848 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15849 change the radix.
15850
15851 @kindex set output-radix
15852 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15853 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15854 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15855 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15856
15857 @kindex show input-radix
15858 @item show input-radix
15859 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15860
15861 @kindex show output-radix
15862 @item show output-radix
15863 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15864
15865 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15866 @itemx show radix
15867 @kindex set radix
15868 @kindex show radix
15869 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15870 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15871 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15872 default value of 10.
15873
15874 @end table
15875
15876 @node ABI
15877 @section Configuring the Current ABI
15878
15879 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15880 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15881 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15882 current ABI.
15883
15884 @cindex OS ABI
15885 @kindex set osabi
15886 @kindex show osabi
15887
15888 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15889 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15890 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15891 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15892 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15893 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15894 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15895 platform provides.
15896
15897 @table @code
15898 @item show osabi
15899 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15900
15901 @item set osabi
15902 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15903
15904 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15905 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15906 @end table
15907
15908 @cindex float promotion
15909
15910 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15911 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15912 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15913 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15914 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15915 @code{double} and then passed.
15916
15917 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15918 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15919 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15920
15921 @table @code
15922 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15923 @item set coerce-float-to-double
15924 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15925 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15926 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15927
15928 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
15929 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15930 functions.
15931
15932 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
15933 @item show coerce-float-to-double
15934 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
15935 @end table
15936
15937 @kindex set cp-abi
15938 @kindex show cp-abi
15939 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
15940 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
15941 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
15942 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
15943 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
15944 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
15945 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
15946 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
15947 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
15948 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
15949 ``auto''.
15950
15951 @table @code
15952 @item show cp-abi
15953 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
15954
15955 @item set cp-abi
15956 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
15957
15958 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
15959 @itemx set cp-abi auto
15960 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
15961 @end table
15962
15963 @node Messages/Warnings
15964 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
15965
15966 @cindex verbose operation
15967 @cindex optional warnings
15968 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
15969 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
15970 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
15971 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
15972
15973 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
15974 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
15975 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
15976
15977 @table @code
15978 @kindex set verbose
15979 @item set verbose on
15980 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15981
15982 @item set verbose off
15983 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15984
15985 @kindex show verbose
15986 @item show verbose
15987 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
15988 @end table
15989
15990 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
15991 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
15992 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
15993 Symbol Files}).
15994
15995 @table @code
15996
15997 @kindex set complaints
15998 @item set complaints @var{limit}
15999 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16000 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16001 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16002 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16003
16004 @kindex show complaints
16005 @item show complaints
16006 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16007
16008 @end table
16009
16010 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16011 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16012 you try to run a program which is already running:
16013
16014 @smallexample
16015 (@value{GDBP}) run
16016 The program being debugged has been started already.
16017 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16018 @end smallexample
16019
16020 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16021 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16022
16023 @table @code
16024
16025 @kindex set confirm
16026 @cindex flinching
16027 @cindex confirmation
16028 @cindex stupid questions
16029 @item set confirm off
16030 Disables confirmation requests.
16031
16032 @item set confirm on
16033 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16034
16035 @kindex show confirm
16036 @item show confirm
16037 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16038
16039 @end table
16040
16041 @cindex command tracing
16042 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16043 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16044 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16045 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16046
16047 @table @code
16048 @kindex set trace-commands
16049 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16050 @item set trace-commands on
16051 Enable command tracing.
16052 @item set trace-commands off
16053 Disable command tracing.
16054 @item show trace-commands
16055 Display the current state of command tracing.
16056 @end table
16057
16058 @node Debugging Output
16059 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16060 @cindex optional debugging messages
16061
16062 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16063 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16064 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16065 section documents those commands.
16066
16067 @table @code
16068 @kindex set exec-done-display
16069 @item set exec-done-display
16070 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16071 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16072 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16073 @kindex show exec-done-display
16074 @item show exec-done-display
16075 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16076 notification.
16077 @kindex set debug
16078 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16079 @cindex architecture debugging info
16080 @item set debug arch
16081 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16082 @kindex show debug
16083 @item show debug arch
16084 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16085 @item set debug aix-thread
16086 @cindex AIX threads
16087 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16088 module.
16089 @item show debug aix-thread
16090 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16091 @item set debug event
16092 @cindex event debugging info
16093 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16094 default is off.
16095 @item show debug event
16096 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16097 info.
16098 @item set debug expression
16099 @cindex expression debugging info
16100 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16101 expression parsing. The default is off.
16102 @item show debug expression
16103 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16104 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16105 @item set debug frame
16106 @cindex frame debugging info
16107 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16108 default is off.
16109 @item show debug frame
16110 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16111 info.
16112 @item set debug infrun
16113 @cindex inferior debugging info
16114 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16115 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16116 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16117 @item show debug infrun
16118 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16119 @item set debug lin-lwp
16120 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16121 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16122 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16123 @item show debug lin-lwp
16124 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16125 @item set debug observer
16126 @cindex observer debugging info
16127 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16128 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16129 @item show debug observer
16130 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16131 @item set debug overload
16132 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16133 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16134 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16135 is off.
16136 @item show debug overload
16137 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16138 debugging info.
16139 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16140 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16141 @cindex debug remote protocol
16142 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16143 @cindex display remote packets
16144 @item set debug remote
16145 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16146 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16147 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16148 @item show debug remote
16149 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16150 @item set debug serial
16151 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16152 default is off.
16153 @item show debug serial
16154 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16155 info.
16156 @item set debug solib-frv
16157 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16158 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16159 @item show debug solib-frv
16160 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16161 messages.
16162 @item set debug target
16163 @cindex target debugging info
16164 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16165 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16166 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16167 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16168 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16169 @item show debug target
16170 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16171 info.
16172 @item set debugvarobj
16173 @cindex variable object debugging info
16174 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16175 info. The default is off.
16176 @item show debugvarobj
16177 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16178 debugging info.
16179 @item set debug xml
16180 @cindex XML parser debugging
16181 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16182 @item show debug xml
16183 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16184 @end table
16185
16186 @node Sequences
16187 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16188
16189 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16190 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16191 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16192 files.
16193
16194 @menu
16195 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16196 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16197 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16198 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16199 @end menu
16200
16201 @node Define
16202 @section User-defined Commands
16203
16204 @cindex user-defined command
16205 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16206 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16207 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16208 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16209 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16210 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16211
16212 @smallexample
16213 define adder
16214 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16215 end
16216 @end smallexample
16217
16218 @noindent
16219 To execute the command use:
16220
16221 @smallexample
16222 adder 1 2 3
16223 @end smallexample
16224
16225 @noindent
16226 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16227 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16228 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16229 functions calls.
16230
16231 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16232 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16233 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16234 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16235
16236 @smallexample
16237 define adder
16238 if $argc == 2
16239 print $arg0 + $arg1
16240 end
16241 if $argc == 3
16242 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16243 end
16244 end
16245 @end smallexample
16246
16247 @table @code
16248
16249 @kindex define
16250 @item define @var{commandname}
16251 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16252 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16253
16254 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16255 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16256 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16257
16258 @kindex document
16259 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16260 @item document @var{commandname}
16261 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16262 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16263 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16264 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16265 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16266 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16267
16268 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16269 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16270 does not change the documentation.
16271
16272 @kindex dont-repeat
16273 @cindex don't repeat command
16274 @item dont-repeat
16275 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16276 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16277 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16278
16279 @kindex help user-defined
16280 @item help user-defined
16281 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16282 (if any) for each.
16283
16284 @kindex show user
16285 @item show user
16286 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16287 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16288 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16289 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16290
16291 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16292 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16293 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16294 @item show max-user-call-depth
16295 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16296 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16297 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16298 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16299 @end table
16300
16301 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16302 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16303
16304 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16305 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16306 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16307
16308 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16309 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16310 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16311 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16312
16313 @node Hooks
16314 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16315 @cindex command hooks
16316 @cindex hooks, for commands
16317 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16318
16319 @kindex hook
16320 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16321 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16322 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16323 before that command.
16324
16325 @cindex hooks, post-command
16326 @kindex hookpost
16327 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16328 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16329 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16330 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16331 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16332
16333 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16334 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16335
16336 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16337 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16338
16339 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16340 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16341 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16342 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16343 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16344
16345 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16346 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16347 you could define:
16348
16349 @smallexample
16350 define hook-stop
16351 handle SIGALRM nopass
16352 end
16353
16354 define hook-run
16355 handle SIGALRM pass
16356 end
16357
16358 define hook-continue
16359 handle SIGALRM pass
16360 end
16361 @end smallexample
16362
16363 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16364 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16365 you could define:
16366
16367 @smallexample
16368 define hook-echo
16369 echo <<<---
16370 end
16371
16372 define hookpost-echo
16373 echo --->>>\n
16374 end
16375
16376 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16377 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16378 (@value{GDBP})
16379
16380 @end smallexample
16381
16382 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16383 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16384 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16385 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16386 @c or not?
16387 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16388 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16389 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16390
16391 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16392 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16393
16394 @node Command Files
16395 @section Command Files
16396
16397 @cindex command files
16398 @cindex scripting commands
16399 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16400 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16401 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16402 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16403 terminal.
16404
16405 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16406 command:
16407
16408 @table @code
16409 @kindex source
16410 @cindex execute commands from a file
16411 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16412 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16413 @end table
16414
16415 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16416 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16417 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16418 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16419 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16420
16421 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16422 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16423
16424 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16425 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16426 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16427
16428 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16429 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16430 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16431 when called from command files.
16432
16433 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16434 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16435 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16436 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16437 the next command.
16438
16439 @smallexample
16440 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16441 @end smallexample
16442
16443 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16444 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16445 would be directed to @file{log}.
16446
16447 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16448 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16449 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16450 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16451 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16452 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16453 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16454 conditionally, etc.
16455
16456 @table @code
16457 @kindex if
16458 @kindex else
16459 @item if
16460 @itemx else
16461 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16462 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16463 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16464 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16465 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16466 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16467 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16468
16469 @kindex while
16470 @item while
16471 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16472 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16473 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16474 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16475 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16476 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16477
16478 @kindex loop_break
16479 @item loop_break
16480 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16481 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16482 line.
16483
16484 @kindex loop_continue
16485 @item loop_continue
16486 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16487 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16488 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16489 the controlling expression.
16490
16491 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16492 @item end
16493 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16494 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16495 @end table
16496
16497
16498 @node Output
16499 @section Commands for Controlled Output
16500
16501 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16502 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16503 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16504 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16505 want.
16506
16507 @table @code
16508 @kindex echo
16509 @item echo @var{text}
16510 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16511 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16512 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16513 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16514 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16515 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16516 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16517 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16518 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16519 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16520 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16521
16522 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16523 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16524
16525 @smallexample
16526 echo This is some text\n\
16527 which is continued\n\
16528 onto several lines.\n
16529 @end smallexample
16530
16531 produces the same output as
16532
16533 @smallexample
16534 echo This is some text\n
16535 echo which is continued\n
16536 echo onto several lines.\n
16537 @end smallexample
16538
16539 @kindex output
16540 @item output @var{expression}
16541 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16542 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16543 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16544 on expressions.
16545
16546 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16547 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16548 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16549 Formats}, for more information.
16550
16551 @kindex printf
16552 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16553 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
16554 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
16555 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
16556 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
16557 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
16558 executing the code below:
16559
16560 @smallexample
16561 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16562 @end smallexample
16563
16564 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
16565 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
16566 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
16567 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
16568 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
16569 printed.
16570
16571 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16572
16573 @smallexample
16574 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16575 @end smallexample
16576
16577 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
16578 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
16579 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
16580
16581 @itemize @bullet
16582 @item
16583 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
16584
16585 @item
16586 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
16587 width.
16588
16589 @item
16590 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
16591 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
16592
16593 @item
16594 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
16595 supported.
16596
16597 @item
16598 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
16599
16600 @item
16601 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
16602 @end itemize
16603
16604 @noindent
16605 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
16606 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
16607 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
16608 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
16609
16610 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
16611 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
16612 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
16613 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
16614 supported.
16615
16616 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
16617 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following conversion
16618 letters:
16619
16620 @itemize @bullet
16621 @item
16622 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
16623
16624 @item
16625 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
16626
16627 @item
16628 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
16629 @end itemize
16630
16631 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
16632 support for the three conversion letters for DFP types, other modifiers
16633 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
16634
16635 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
16636 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
16637
16638 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
16639 @smallexample
16640 printf "D32: %H - D64: %D - D128: %DD\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
16641 @end smallexample
16642
16643 @end table
16644
16645 @node Interpreters
16646 @chapter Command Interpreters
16647 @cindex command interpreters
16648
16649 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16650 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16651 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16652
16653 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16654 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16655 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16656 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16657
16658 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16659 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16660 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16661 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16662
16663 @table @code
16664 @item console
16665 @cindex console interpreter
16666 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16667 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16668 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16669
16670 @item mi
16671 @cindex mi interpreter
16672 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16673 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16674 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16675 Interface}.
16676
16677 @item mi2
16678 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16679 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16680
16681 @item mi1
16682 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16683 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16684
16685 @end table
16686
16687 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16688 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16689 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16690 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16691 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16692 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16693 the IDE inoperable!
16694
16695 @kindex interpreter-exec
16696 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16697 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16698 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16699 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16700
16701 @smallexample
16702 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16703 @end smallexample
16704
16705 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16706 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16707
16708 @node TUI
16709 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16710 @cindex TUI
16711 @cindex Text User Interface
16712
16713 @menu
16714 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16715 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16716 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16717 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
16718 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16719 @end menu
16720
16721 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
16722 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16723 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16724 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
16725 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
16726 is available.
16727
16728 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
16729 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
16730 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
16731 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
16732 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
16733 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
16734
16735 @node TUI Overview
16736 @section TUI Overview
16737
16738 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
16739
16740 @table @emph
16741 @item command
16742 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16743 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16744 managed using readline.
16745
16746 @item source
16747 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16748 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16749
16750 @item assembly
16751 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16752
16753 @item register
16754 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
16755 when their values change.
16756 @end table
16757
16758 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16759 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
16760 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
16761 indicates the breakpoint type:
16762
16763 @table @code
16764 @item B
16765 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16766
16767 @item b
16768 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16769
16770 @item H
16771 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16772
16773 @item h
16774 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16775 @end table
16776
16777 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16778
16779 @table @code
16780 @item +
16781 Breakpoint is enabled.
16782
16783 @item -
16784 Breakpoint is disabled.
16785 @end table
16786
16787 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
16788 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
16789 changes.
16790
16791 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
16792 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
16793 layouts:
16794
16795 @itemize @bullet
16796 @item
16797 source only,
16798
16799 @item
16800 assembly only,
16801
16802 @item
16803 source and assembly,
16804
16805 @item
16806 source and registers, or
16807
16808 @item
16809 assembly and registers.
16810 @end itemize
16811
16812 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
16813
16814 @table @emph
16815 @item target
16816 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
16817 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16818
16819 @item process
16820 Gives the current process or thread number.
16821 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16822
16823 @item function
16824 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16825 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16826 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
16827 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16828
16829 @item line
16830 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16831 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
16832
16833 @item pc
16834 Indicates the current program counter address.
16835 @end table
16836
16837 @node TUI Keys
16838 @section TUI Key Bindings
16839 @cindex TUI key bindings
16840
16841 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16842 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
16843 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16844
16845 @table @kbd
16846 @kindex C-x C-a
16847 @item C-x C-a
16848 @kindex C-x a
16849 @itemx C-x a
16850 @kindex C-x A
16851 @itemx C-x A
16852 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
16853 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
16854 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
16855 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
16856 The screen is then refreshed.
16857
16858 @kindex C-x 1
16859 @item C-x 1
16860 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16861 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16862 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16863
16864 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16865
16866 @kindex C-x 2
16867 @item C-x 2
16868 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16869 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
16870 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16871 previous layout and the new one.
16872
16873 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16874
16875 @kindex C-x o
16876 @item C-x o
16877 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16878 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
16879 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16880
16881 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16882
16883 @kindex C-x s
16884 @item C-x s
16885 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
16886 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16887 @end table
16888
16889 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
16890
16891 @table @asis
16892 @kindex PgUp
16893 @item @key{PgUp}
16894 Scroll the active window one page up.
16895
16896 @kindex PgDn
16897 @item @key{PgDn}
16898 Scroll the active window one page down.
16899
16900 @kindex Up
16901 @item @key{Up}
16902 Scroll the active window one line up.
16903
16904 @kindex Down
16905 @item @key{Down}
16906 Scroll the active window one line down.
16907
16908 @kindex Left
16909 @item @key{Left}
16910 Scroll the active window one column left.
16911
16912 @kindex Right
16913 @item @key{Right}
16914 Scroll the active window one column right.
16915
16916 @kindex C-L
16917 @item @kbd{C-L}
16918 Refresh the screen.
16919 @end table
16920
16921 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
16922 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
16923 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
16924 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
16925 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
16926
16927 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16928 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16929 @cindex TUI single key mode
16930
16931 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
16932 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
16933 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
16934
16935 @table @kbd
16936 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16937 @item c
16938 continue
16939
16940 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16941 @item d
16942 down
16943
16944 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16945 @item f
16946 finish
16947
16948 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16949 @item n
16950 next
16951
16952 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16953 @item q
16954 exit the SingleKey mode.
16955
16956 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16957 @item r
16958 run
16959
16960 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16961 @item s
16962 step
16963
16964 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16965 @item u
16966 up
16967
16968 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16969 @item v
16970 info locals
16971
16972 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16973 @item w
16974 where
16975 @end table
16976
16977 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
16978 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
16979 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
16980 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
16981 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
16982 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
16983
16984
16985 @node TUI Commands
16986 @section TUI-specific Commands
16987 @cindex TUI commands
16988
16989 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
16990 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
16991 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
16992 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
16993
16994 @table @code
16995 @item info win
16996 @kindex info win
16997 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
16998
16999 @item layout next
17000 @kindex layout
17001 Display the next layout.
17002
17003 @item layout prev
17004 Display the previous layout.
17005
17006 @item layout src
17007 Display the source window only.
17008
17009 @item layout asm
17010 Display the assembly window only.
17011
17012 @item layout split
17013 Display the source and assembly window.
17014
17015 @item layout regs
17016 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17017
17018 @item focus next
17019 @kindex focus
17020 Make the next window active for scrolling.
17021
17022 @item focus prev
17023 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
17024
17025 @item focus src
17026 Make the source window active for scrolling.
17027
17028 @item focus asm
17029 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
17030
17031 @item focus regs
17032 Make the register window active for scrolling.
17033
17034 @item focus cmd
17035 Make the command window active for scrolling.
17036
17037 @item refresh
17038 @kindex refresh
17039 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17040
17041 @item tui reg float
17042 @kindex tui reg
17043 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17044
17045 @item tui reg general
17046 Show the general registers in the register window.
17047
17048 @item tui reg next
17049 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17050 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17051 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17052 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17053
17054 @item tui reg system
17055 Show the system registers in the register window.
17056
17057 @item update
17058 @kindex update
17059 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17060
17061 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17062 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17063 @kindex winheight
17064 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17065 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17066 decrease it.
17067
17068 @item tabset @var{nchars}
17069 @kindex tabset
17070 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17071 @end table
17072
17073 @node TUI Configuration
17074 @section TUI Configuration Variables
17075 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17076
17077 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
17078
17079 @table @code
17080 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17081 @kindex set tui border-kind
17082 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17083 The possible values are the following:
17084 @table @code
17085 @item space
17086 Use a space character to draw the border.
17087
17088 @item ascii
17089 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
17090
17091 @item acs
17092 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17093 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17094 @end table
17095
17096 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17097 @kindex set tui border-mode
17098 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17099 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17100 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
17101 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17102 @table @code
17103 @item normal
17104 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17105
17106 @item standout
17107 Use standout mode.
17108
17109 @item reverse
17110 Use reverse video mode.
17111
17112 @item half
17113 Use half bright mode.
17114
17115 @item half-standout
17116 Use half bright and standout mode.
17117
17118 @item bold
17119 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17120
17121 @item bold-standout
17122 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17123 @end table
17124 @end table
17125
17126 @node Emacs
17127 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17128
17129 @cindex Emacs
17130 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17131 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17132 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17133 @value{GDBN}.
17134
17135 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17136 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17137 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17138 created Emacs buffer.
17139 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17140
17141 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17142 things:
17143
17144 @itemize @bullet
17145 @item
17146 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17147 the GUD buffer.
17148
17149 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17150 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17151
17152 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17153 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17154 in this way.
17155
17156 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17157 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17158 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17159 stop.
17160
17161 @item
17162 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17163
17164 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17165 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17166 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17167 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17168 and the source.
17169
17170 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17171 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17172 @end itemize
17173
17174 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17175 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17176 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17177 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17178
17179 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17180 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17181 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17182 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17183 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17184 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17185 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17186 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17187 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17188
17189 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17190 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17191 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17192 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17193
17194 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17195 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17196 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17197 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17198 one you want.
17199
17200 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17201 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17202
17203 @table @kbd
17204 @item C-h m
17205 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17206
17207 @item C-c C-s
17208 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17209 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17210
17211 @item C-c C-n
17212 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17213 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17214 to show the current file and location.
17215
17216 @item C-c C-i
17217 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17218 display window accordingly.
17219
17220 @item C-c C-f
17221 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17222 @code{finish} command.
17223
17224 @item C-c C-r
17225 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17226 command.
17227
17228 @item C-c <
17229 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17230 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17231 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17232
17233 @item C-c >
17234 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17235 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17236 @end table
17237
17238 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17239 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17240
17241 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17242 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17243 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17244 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17245 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17246 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17247 speedbar displays watch expressions.
17248
17249 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17250 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17251 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17252 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17253 frame.
17254
17255 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17256 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17257 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17258 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17259 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17260 to correspond properly with the code.
17261
17262 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17263 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17264 Emacs Manual}).
17265
17266 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17267 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17268 @ignore
17269 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17270 @kindex Epoch
17271 @kindex inspect
17272
17273 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17274 called the @code{epoch}
17275 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17276 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17277 each value is printed in its own window.
17278 @end ignore
17279
17280
17281 @node GDB/MI
17282 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17283
17284 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17285
17286 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17287 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17288 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17289 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17290 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17291 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17292
17293 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17294 in the form of a reference manual.
17295
17296 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17297 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17298 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17299
17300 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17301
17302 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17303 This chapter uses the following notation:
17304
17305 @itemize @bullet
17306 @item
17307 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17308
17309 @item
17310 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17311 it may or may not be given.
17312
17313 @item
17314 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17315 may repeat zero or more times.
17316
17317 @item
17318 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17319 may repeat one or more times.
17320
17321 @item
17322 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17323 @end itemize
17324
17325 @ignore
17326 @heading Dependencies
17327 @end ignore
17328
17329 @menu
17330 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17331 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17332 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17333 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17334 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17335 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17336 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17337 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17338 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17339 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17340 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17341 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17342 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17343 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17344 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17345 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17346 @ignore
17347 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17348 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17349 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17350 @end ignore
17351 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17352 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17353 @end menu
17354
17355 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17356 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17357 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17358
17359 @menu
17360 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17361 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17362 @end menu
17363
17364 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17365 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17366
17367 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17368 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17369 @table @code
17370 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17371 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17372
17373 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17374 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17375 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17376
17377 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17378 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17379 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17380
17381 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17382 "any sequence of digits"
17383
17384 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17385 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17386
17387 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17388 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17389
17390 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17391 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17392
17393 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17394 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17395 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17396
17397 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17398 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17399
17400 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17401 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17402 @end table
17403
17404 @noindent
17405 Notes:
17406
17407 @itemize @bullet
17408 @item
17409 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17410 output is described below.
17411
17412 @item
17413 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17414 finishes.
17415
17416 @item
17417 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17418 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17419 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17420 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17421 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17422 @end itemize
17423
17424 Pragmatics:
17425
17426 @itemize @bullet
17427 @item
17428 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17429
17430 @item
17431 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17432 @end itemize
17433
17434 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17435 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17436
17437 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17438 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17439 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17440 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17441 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17442 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17443
17444 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17445 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17446 @var{token}.
17447
17448 @table @code
17449 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17450 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17451
17452 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17453 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17454
17455 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17456 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17457
17458 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17459 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17460
17461 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17462 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17463
17464 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17465 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17466
17467 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17468 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17469
17470 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17471 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17472
17473 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17474 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17475
17476 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17477 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17478 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17479
17480 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17481 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17482
17483 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17484 @code{ @var{string} }
17485
17486 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17487 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17488
17489 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17490 @code{@var{c-string}}
17491
17492 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17493 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17494
17495 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17496 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17497 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17498
17499 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17500 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17501
17502 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17503 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17504
17505 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17506 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17507
17508 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17509 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17510
17511 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17512 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17513
17514 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17515 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17516 @end table
17517
17518 @noindent
17519 Notes:
17520
17521 @itemize @bullet
17522 @item
17523 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17524
17525 @item
17526 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17527 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17528 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17529 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17530
17531 @item
17532 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17533 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17534 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17535 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17536
17537 @item
17538 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17539 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17540 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17541 @samp{*}.
17542
17543 @item
17544 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17545 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17546 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17547 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17548
17549 @item
17550 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17551 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17552 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17553 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17554
17555 @item
17556 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17557 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17558 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17559
17560 @item
17561 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17562 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17563 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17564 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17565
17566 @item
17567 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17568 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17569 @var{values}.
17570
17571
17572 @end itemize
17573
17574 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17575 details about the various output records.
17576
17577 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17578 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17579 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17580
17581 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17582 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17583
17584 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17585 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17586 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17587 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17588 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17589 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17590
17591 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17592 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17593 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17594
17595 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17596 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17597 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17598 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17599
17600 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17601 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17602
17603 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17604 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17605 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17606 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17607 might change.
17608
17609 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17610 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17611 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17612 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17613
17614 @itemize @bullet
17615 @item
17616 New MI commands may be added.
17617
17618 @item
17619 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17620
17621 @item
17622 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17623 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17624
17625 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17626 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17627
17628 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17629 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17630 @end itemize
17631
17632 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17633 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17634 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17635 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17636 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17637
17638 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17639 @c version?
17640
17641 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17642 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17643 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17644 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17645 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17646 Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17647 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17648 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17649 @cindex mailing lists
17650
17651 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17652 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17653 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17654
17655 @menu
17656 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17657 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17658 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17659 @end menu
17660
17661 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17662 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17663
17664 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17665 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17666 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17667 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17668
17669 @table @code
17670 @findex ^done
17671 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17672 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17673 values.
17674
17675 @item "^running"
17676 @findex ^running
17677 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17678 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17679 running.
17680
17681 @item "^connected"
17682 @findex ^connected
17683 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
17684
17685 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17686 @findex ^error
17687 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17688 error message.
17689
17690 @item "^exit"
17691 @findex ^exit
17692 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
17693
17694 @end table
17695
17696 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17697 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17698
17699 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17700 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17701 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17702 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17703 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17704
17705 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17706 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17707 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17708 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17709 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17710
17711 @table @code
17712 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17713 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17714 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17715
17716 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17717 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17718 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17719 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17720
17721 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17722 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17723 internals.
17724 @end table
17725
17726 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17727 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17728
17729 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17730 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17731 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17732 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17733 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17734 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17735
17736 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17737 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17738
17739 @table @code
17740 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17741 @end table
17742
17743 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17744
17745 @table @code
17746 @item breakpoint-hit
17747 A breakpoint was reached.
17748 @item watchpoint-trigger
17749 A watchpoint was triggered.
17750 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17751 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17752 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17753 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17754 @item function-finished
17755 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17756 @item location-reached
17757 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17758 @item watchpoint-scope
17759 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17760 @item end-stepping-range
17761 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17762 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17763 @item exited-signalled
17764 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17765 @item exited
17766 The inferior exited.
17767 @item exited-normally
17768 The inferior exited normally.
17769 @item signal-received
17770 A signal was received by the inferior.
17771 @end table
17772
17773
17774 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17775 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17776 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17777 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17778
17779 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17780 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17781 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17782 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17783
17784 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17785 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17786
17787 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
17788
17789 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17790 information of the breakpoint.
17791
17792 @smallexample
17793 -> -break-insert main
17794 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17795 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17796 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17797 <- (gdb)
17798 @end smallexample
17799
17800 @subheading Program Execution
17801
17802 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17803 reason that execution stopped.
17804
17805 @smallexample
17806 -> -exec-run
17807 <- ^running
17808 <- (gdb)
17809 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17810 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17811 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17812 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17813 <- (gdb)
17814 -> -exec-continue
17815 <- ^running
17816 <- (gdb)
17817 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17818 <- (gdb)
17819 @end smallexample
17820
17821 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
17822
17823 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17824
17825 @smallexample
17826 -> (gdb)
17827 <- -gdb-exit
17828 <- ^exit
17829 @end smallexample
17830
17831 @subheading A Bad Command
17832
17833 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17834
17835 @smallexample
17836 -> -rubbish
17837 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17838 <- (gdb)
17839 @end smallexample
17840
17841
17842 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17843 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17844 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17845
17846 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17847 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17848
17849 @subheading Motivation
17850
17851 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17852
17853 @subheading Introduction
17854
17855 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17856
17857 @subheading Commands
17858
17859 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17860
17861 @subsubheading Synopsis
17862
17863 @smallexample
17864 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17865 @end smallexample
17866
17867 @subsubheading Result
17868
17869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17870
17871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17872
17873 @subsubheading Example
17874
17875 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17876 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17877
17878
17879 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17880 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17881 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17882
17883 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17884 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17885 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17886 breakpoints.
17887
17888 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17889 @findex -break-after
17890
17891 @subsubheading Synopsis
17892
17893 @smallexample
17894 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17895 @end smallexample
17896
17897 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17898 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17899 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17900 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17901
17902 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17903
17904 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17905
17906 @subsubheading Example
17907
17908 @smallexample
17909 (gdb)
17910 -break-insert main
17911 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17912 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17913 (gdb)
17914 -break-after 1 3
17915 ~
17916 ^done
17917 (gdb)
17918 -break-list
17919 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17920 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17921 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17922 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17923 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17924 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17925 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17926 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17927 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17928 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17929 (gdb)
17930 @end smallexample
17931
17932 @ignore
17933 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17934 @findex -break-catch
17935
17936 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17937 @findex -break-commands
17938 @end ignore
17939
17940
17941 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17942 @findex -break-condition
17943
17944 @subsubheading Synopsis
17945
17946 @smallexample
17947 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17948 @end smallexample
17949
17950 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17951 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17952 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17953 command below).
17954
17955 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17956
17957 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17958
17959 @subsubheading Example
17960
17961 @smallexample
17962 (gdb)
17963 -break-condition 1 1
17964 ^done
17965 (gdb)
17966 -break-list
17967 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17968 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17969 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17970 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17971 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17972 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17973 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17974 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17975 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17976 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17977 (gdb)
17978 @end smallexample
17979
17980 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17981 @findex -break-delete
17982
17983 @subsubheading Synopsis
17984
17985 @smallexample
17986 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17987 @end smallexample
17988
17989 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
17990 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
17991
17992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17993
17994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
17995
17996 @subsubheading Example
17997
17998 @smallexample
17999 (gdb)
18000 -break-delete 1
18001 ^done
18002 (gdb)
18003 -break-list
18004 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18005 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18006 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18007 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18008 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18009 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18010 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18011 body=[]@}
18012 (gdb)
18013 @end smallexample
18014
18015 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18016 @findex -break-disable
18017
18018 @subsubheading Synopsis
18019
18020 @smallexample
18021 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18022 @end smallexample
18023
18024 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18025 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18026
18027 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18028
18029 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18030
18031 @subsubheading Example
18032
18033 @smallexample
18034 (gdb)
18035 -break-disable 2
18036 ^done
18037 (gdb)
18038 -break-list
18039 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18040 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18041 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18042 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18043 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18044 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18045 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18046 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18047 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18048 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18049 (gdb)
18050 @end smallexample
18051
18052 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18053 @findex -break-enable
18054
18055 @subsubheading Synopsis
18056
18057 @smallexample
18058 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18059 @end smallexample
18060
18061 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18062
18063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18064
18065 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18066
18067 @subsubheading Example
18068
18069 @smallexample
18070 (gdb)
18071 -break-enable 2
18072 ^done
18073 (gdb)
18074 -break-list
18075 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18076 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18077 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18078 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18079 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18080 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18081 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18082 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18083 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18084 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18085 (gdb)
18086 @end smallexample
18087
18088 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18089 @findex -break-info
18090
18091 @subsubheading Synopsis
18092
18093 @smallexample
18094 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18095 @end smallexample
18096
18097 @c REDUNDANT???
18098 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18099
18100 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18101
18102 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18103
18104 @subsubheading Example
18105 N.A.
18106
18107 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18108 @findex -break-insert
18109
18110 @subsubheading Synopsis
18111
18112 @smallexample
18113 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
18114 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18115 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
18116 @end smallexample
18117
18118 @noindent
18119 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
18120
18121 @itemize @bullet
18122 @item function
18123 @c @item +offset
18124 @c @item -offset
18125 @c @item linenum
18126 @item filename:linenum
18127 @item filename:function
18128 @item *address
18129 @end itemize
18130
18131 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18132
18133 @table @samp
18134 @item -t
18135 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18136 @item -h
18137 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18138 @item -c @var{condition}
18139 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18140 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18141 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18142 @item -r
18143 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
18144 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
18145 expressions.
18146 @end table
18147
18148 @subsubheading Result
18149
18150 The result is in the form:
18151
18152 @smallexample
18153 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18154 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18155 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18156 times="@var{times}"@}
18157 @end smallexample
18158
18159 @noindent
18160 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18161 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18162 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18163 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18164 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18165 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18166 which use the same output).
18167
18168 Note: this format is open to change.
18169 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18170
18171 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18172
18173 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18174 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18175
18176 @subsubheading Example
18177
18178 @smallexample
18179 (gdb)
18180 -break-insert main
18181 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18182 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18183 (gdb)
18184 -break-insert -t foo
18185 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18186 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18187 (gdb)
18188 -break-list
18189 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18190 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18191 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18192 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18193 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18194 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18195 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18196 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18197 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18198 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18199 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18200 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18201 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18202 (gdb)
18203 -break-insert -r foo.*
18204 ~int foo(int, int);
18205 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18206 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18207 (gdb)
18208 @end smallexample
18209
18210 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18211 @findex -break-list
18212
18213 @subsubheading Synopsis
18214
18215 @smallexample
18216 -break-list
18217 @end smallexample
18218
18219 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18220
18221 @table @samp
18222 @item Number
18223 number of the breakpoint
18224 @item Type
18225 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18226 @item Disposition
18227 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18228 or @samp{nokeep}
18229 @item Enabled
18230 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18231 @item Address
18232 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18233 @item What
18234 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18235 name, line number
18236 @item Times
18237 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18238 @end table
18239
18240 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18241 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18242
18243 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18244
18245 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18246
18247 @subsubheading Example
18248
18249 @smallexample
18250 (gdb)
18251 -break-list
18252 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18253 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18254 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18255 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18256 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18257 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18258 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18259 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18260 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18261 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18262 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18263 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18264 (gdb)
18265 @end smallexample
18266
18267 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18268
18269 @smallexample
18270 (gdb)
18271 -break-list
18272 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18273 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18274 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18275 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18276 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18277 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18278 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18279 body=[]@}
18280 (gdb)
18281 @end smallexample
18282
18283 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18284 @findex -break-watch
18285
18286 @subsubheading Synopsis
18287
18288 @smallexample
18289 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18290 @end smallexample
18291
18292 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18293 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18294 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18295 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18296 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18297 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18298 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18299 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18300
18301 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18302 breakpoints inserted.
18303
18304 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18305
18306 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18307 @samp{rwatch}.
18308
18309 @subsubheading Example
18310
18311 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18312
18313 @smallexample
18314 (gdb)
18315 -break-watch x
18316 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18317 (gdb)
18318 -exec-continue
18319 ^running
18320 (gdb)
18321 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18322 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18323 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18324 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18325 (gdb)
18326 @end smallexample
18327
18328 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18329 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18330 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18331
18332 @smallexample
18333 (gdb)
18334 -break-watch C
18335 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18336 (gdb)
18337 -exec-continue
18338 ^running
18339 (gdb)
18340 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18341 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18342 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18343 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18344 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18345 (gdb)
18346 -exec-continue
18347 ^running
18348 (gdb)
18349 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18350 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18351 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18352 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18353 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18354 (gdb)
18355 @end smallexample
18356
18357 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18358 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18359 deleted.
18360
18361 @smallexample
18362 (gdb)
18363 -break-watch C
18364 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18365 (gdb)
18366 -break-list
18367 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18368 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18369 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18370 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18371 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18372 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18373 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18374 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18375 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18376 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18377 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18378 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18379 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18380 (gdb)
18381 -exec-continue
18382 ^running
18383 (gdb)
18384 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18385 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18386 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18387 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18388 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18389 (gdb)
18390 -break-list
18391 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18392 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18393 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18394 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18395 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18396 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18397 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18398 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18399 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18400 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18401 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18402 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18403 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18404 (gdb)
18405 -exec-continue
18406 ^running
18407 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18408 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18409 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18410 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18411 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18412 (gdb)
18413 -break-list
18414 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18415 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18416 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18417 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18418 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18419 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18420 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18421 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18422 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18423 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18424 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18425 times="1"@}]@}
18426 (gdb)
18427 @end smallexample
18428
18429 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18430 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18431 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18432
18433 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18434 @findex -exec-arguments
18435
18436
18437 @subsubheading Synopsis
18438
18439 @smallexample
18440 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18441 @end smallexample
18442
18443 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18444 @samp{-exec-run}.
18445
18446 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18447
18448 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18449
18450 @subsubheading Example
18451
18452 @c FIXME!
18453 Don't have one around.
18454
18455
18456 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18457 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18458
18459 @subsubheading Synopsis
18460
18461 @smallexample
18462 -exec-show-arguments
18463 @end smallexample
18464
18465 Print the arguments of the program.
18466
18467 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18468
18469 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18470
18471 @subsubheading Example
18472 N.A.
18473
18474
18475 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18476 @findex -environment-cd
18477
18478 @subsubheading Synopsis
18479
18480 @smallexample
18481 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18482 @end smallexample
18483
18484 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18485
18486 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18487
18488 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18489
18490 @subsubheading Example
18491
18492 @smallexample
18493 (gdb)
18494 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18495 ^done
18496 (gdb)
18497 @end smallexample
18498
18499
18500 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18501 @findex -environment-directory
18502
18503 @subsubheading Synopsis
18504
18505 @smallexample
18506 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18507 @end smallexample
18508
18509 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18510 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18511 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18512 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18513 occurs as normal.
18514 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18515 multiple directories in a single command
18516 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18517 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18518 If blanks are needed as
18519 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18520 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18521 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18522 character must not be used
18523 in any directory name.
18524 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18525
18526 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18527
18528 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18529
18530 @subsubheading Example
18531
18532 @smallexample
18533 (gdb)
18534 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18535 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18536 (gdb)
18537 -environment-directory ""
18538 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18539 (gdb)
18540 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18541 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18542 (gdb)
18543 -environment-directory -r
18544 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18545 (gdb)
18546 @end smallexample
18547
18548
18549 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18550 @findex -environment-path
18551
18552 @subsubheading Synopsis
18553
18554 @smallexample
18555 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18556 @end smallexample
18557
18558 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18559 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18560 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18561 supplied in addition to the
18562 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18563 occurs as normal.
18564 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18565 multiple directories in a single command
18566 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18567 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18568 If blanks are needed as
18569 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18570 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18571 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18572 character must not be used
18573 in any directory name.
18574 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18575
18576
18577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18578
18579 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18580
18581 @subsubheading Example
18582
18583 @smallexample
18584 (gdb)
18585 -environment-path
18586 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18587 (gdb)
18588 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18589 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18590 (gdb)
18591 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18592 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18593 (gdb)
18594 @end smallexample
18595
18596
18597 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18598 @findex -environment-pwd
18599
18600 @subsubheading Synopsis
18601
18602 @smallexample
18603 -environment-pwd
18604 @end smallexample
18605
18606 Show the current working directory.
18607
18608 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18609
18610 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18611
18612 @subsubheading Example
18613
18614 @smallexample
18615 (gdb)
18616 -environment-pwd
18617 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18618 (gdb)
18619 @end smallexample
18620
18621 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18622 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18623 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18624
18625
18626 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18627 @findex -thread-info
18628
18629 @subsubheading Synopsis
18630
18631 @smallexample
18632 -thread-info
18633 @end smallexample
18634
18635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18636
18637 No equivalent.
18638
18639 @subsubheading Example
18640 N.A.
18641
18642
18643 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18644 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18645
18646 @subsubheading Synopsis
18647
18648 @smallexample
18649 -thread-list-all-threads
18650 @end smallexample
18651
18652 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18653
18654 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18655
18656 @subsubheading Example
18657 N.A.
18658
18659
18660 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18661 @findex -thread-list-ids
18662
18663 @subsubheading Synopsis
18664
18665 @smallexample
18666 -thread-list-ids
18667 @end smallexample
18668
18669 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18670 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18671
18672 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18673
18674 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18675
18676 @subsubheading Example
18677
18678 No threads present, besides the main process:
18679
18680 @smallexample
18681 (gdb)
18682 -thread-list-ids
18683 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18684 (gdb)
18685 @end smallexample
18686
18687
18688 Several threads:
18689
18690 @smallexample
18691 (gdb)
18692 -thread-list-ids
18693 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18694 number-of-threads="3"
18695 (gdb)
18696 @end smallexample
18697
18698
18699 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18700 @findex -thread-select
18701
18702 @subsubheading Synopsis
18703
18704 @smallexample
18705 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18706 @end smallexample
18707
18708 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18709 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18710
18711 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18712
18713 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18714
18715 @subsubheading Example
18716
18717 @smallexample
18718 (gdb)
18719 -exec-next
18720 ^running
18721 (gdb)
18722 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18723 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18724 (gdb)
18725 -thread-list-ids
18726 ^done,
18727 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18728 number-of-threads="3"
18729 (gdb)
18730 -thread-select 3
18731 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18732 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18733 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18734 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18735 (gdb)
18736 @end smallexample
18737
18738 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18739 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18740 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18741
18742 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18743 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
18744 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18745 other cases.
18746
18747 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18748 @findex -exec-continue
18749
18750 @subsubheading Synopsis
18751
18752 @smallexample
18753 -exec-continue
18754 @end smallexample
18755
18756 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18757 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18758
18759 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18760
18761 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18762
18763 @subsubheading Example
18764
18765 @smallexample
18766 -exec-continue
18767 ^running
18768 (gdb)
18769 @@Hello world
18770 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18771 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18772 (gdb)
18773 @end smallexample
18774
18775
18776 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18777 @findex -exec-finish
18778
18779 @subsubheading Synopsis
18780
18781 @smallexample
18782 -exec-finish
18783 @end smallexample
18784
18785 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18786 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18787
18788 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18789
18790 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18791
18792 @subsubheading Example
18793
18794 Function returning @code{void}.
18795
18796 @smallexample
18797 -exec-finish
18798 ^running
18799 (gdb)
18800 @@hello from foo
18801 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18802 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18803 (gdb)
18804 @end smallexample
18805
18806 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18807 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18808 value itself.
18809
18810 @smallexample
18811 -exec-finish
18812 ^running
18813 (gdb)
18814 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18815 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18816 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18817 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18818 (gdb)
18819 @end smallexample
18820
18821
18822 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18823 @findex -exec-interrupt
18824
18825 @subsubheading Synopsis
18826
18827 @smallexample
18828 -exec-interrupt
18829 @end smallexample
18830
18831 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18832 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18833 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18834 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18835 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18836
18837 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18838
18839 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18840
18841 @subsubheading Example
18842
18843 @smallexample
18844 (gdb)
18845 111-exec-continue
18846 111^running
18847
18848 (gdb)
18849 222-exec-interrupt
18850 222^done
18851 (gdb)
18852 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18853 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18854 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18855 (gdb)
18856
18857 (gdb)
18858 -exec-interrupt
18859 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18860 (gdb)
18861 @end smallexample
18862
18863
18864 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18865 @findex -exec-next
18866
18867 @subsubheading Synopsis
18868
18869 @smallexample
18870 -exec-next
18871 @end smallexample
18872
18873 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18874 of the next source line is reached.
18875
18876 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18877
18878 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18879
18880 @subsubheading Example
18881
18882 @smallexample
18883 -exec-next
18884 ^running
18885 (gdb)
18886 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18887 (gdb)
18888 @end smallexample
18889
18890
18891 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18892 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18893
18894 @subsubheading Synopsis
18895
18896 @smallexample
18897 -exec-next-instruction
18898 @end smallexample
18899
18900 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18901 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18902 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18903 printed as well.
18904
18905 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18906
18907 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18908
18909 @subsubheading Example
18910
18911 @smallexample
18912 (gdb)
18913 -exec-next-instruction
18914 ^running
18915
18916 (gdb)
18917 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18918 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18919 (gdb)
18920 @end smallexample
18921
18922
18923 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18924 @findex -exec-return
18925
18926 @subsubheading Synopsis
18927
18928 @smallexample
18929 -exec-return
18930 @end smallexample
18931
18932 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18933 Displays the new current frame.
18934
18935 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18936
18937 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18938
18939 @subsubheading Example
18940
18941 @smallexample
18942 (gdb)
18943 200-break-insert callee4
18944 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18945 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18946 (gdb)
18947 000-exec-run
18948 000^running
18949 (gdb)
18950 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18951 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18952 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18953 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18954 (gdb)
18955 205-break-delete
18956 205^done
18957 (gdb)
18958 111-exec-return
18959 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18960 args=[@{name="strarg",
18961 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18962 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18963 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18964 (gdb)
18965 @end smallexample
18966
18967
18968 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18969 @findex -exec-run
18970
18971 @subsubheading Synopsis
18972
18973 @smallexample
18974 -exec-run
18975 @end smallexample
18976
18977 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
18978 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
18979 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
18980 the program has exited exceptionally.
18981
18982 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18983
18984 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
18985
18986 @subsubheading Examples
18987
18988 @smallexample
18989 (gdb)
18990 -break-insert main
18991 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18992 (gdb)
18993 -exec-run
18994 ^running
18995 (gdb)
18996 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18997 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18998 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18999 (gdb)
19000 @end smallexample
19001
19002 @noindent
19003 Program exited normally:
19004
19005 @smallexample
19006 (gdb)
19007 -exec-run
19008 ^running
19009 (gdb)
19010 x = 55
19011 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19012 (gdb)
19013 @end smallexample
19014
19015 @noindent
19016 Program exited exceptionally:
19017
19018 @smallexample
19019 (gdb)
19020 -exec-run
19021 ^running
19022 (gdb)
19023 x = 55
19024 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19025 (gdb)
19026 @end smallexample
19027
19028 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19029 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19030
19031 @smallexample
19032 (gdb)
19033 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19034 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19035 @end smallexample
19036
19037
19038 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19039
19040
19041 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19042 @findex -exec-step
19043
19044 @subsubheading Synopsis
19045
19046 @smallexample
19047 -exec-step
19048 @end smallexample
19049
19050 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19051 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19052 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19053 function.
19054
19055 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19056
19057 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19058
19059 @subsubheading Example
19060
19061 Stepping into a function:
19062
19063 @smallexample
19064 -exec-step
19065 ^running
19066 (gdb)
19067 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19068 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19069 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19070 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19071 (gdb)
19072 @end smallexample
19073
19074 Regular stepping:
19075
19076 @smallexample
19077 -exec-step
19078 ^running
19079 (gdb)
19080 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19081 (gdb)
19082 @end smallexample
19083
19084
19085 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19086 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19087
19088 @subsubheading Synopsis
19089
19090 @smallexample
19091 -exec-step-instruction
19092 @end smallexample
19093
19094 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19095 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19096 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19097 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19098 well.
19099
19100 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19101
19102 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19103
19104 @subsubheading Example
19105
19106 @smallexample
19107 (gdb)
19108 -exec-step-instruction
19109 ^running
19110
19111 (gdb)
19112 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19113 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19114 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19115 (gdb)
19116 -exec-step-instruction
19117 ^running
19118
19119 (gdb)
19120 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19121 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19122 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19123 (gdb)
19124 @end smallexample
19125
19126
19127 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19128 @findex -exec-until
19129
19130 @subsubheading Synopsis
19131
19132 @smallexample
19133 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19134 @end smallexample
19135
19136 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19137 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19138 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19139 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19140
19141 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19142
19143 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19144
19145 @subsubheading Example
19146
19147 @smallexample
19148 (gdb)
19149 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19150 ^running
19151 (gdb)
19152 x = 55
19153 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19154 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19155 (gdb)
19156 @end smallexample
19157
19158 @ignore
19159 @subheading -file-clear
19160 Is this going away????
19161 @end ignore
19162
19163 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19164 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19165 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19166
19167
19168 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19169 @findex -stack-info-frame
19170
19171 @subsubheading Synopsis
19172
19173 @smallexample
19174 -stack-info-frame
19175 @end smallexample
19176
19177 Get info on the selected frame.
19178
19179 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19180
19181 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19182 (without arguments).
19183
19184 @subsubheading Example
19185
19186 @smallexample
19187 (gdb)
19188 -stack-info-frame
19189 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19190 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19191 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19192 (gdb)
19193 @end smallexample
19194
19195 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19196 @findex -stack-info-depth
19197
19198 @subsubheading Synopsis
19199
19200 @smallexample
19201 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19202 @end smallexample
19203
19204 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19205 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19206
19207 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19208
19209 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19210
19211 @subsubheading Example
19212
19213 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19214
19215 @smallexample
19216 (gdb)
19217 -stack-info-depth
19218 ^done,depth="12"
19219 (gdb)
19220 -stack-info-depth 4
19221 ^done,depth="4"
19222 (gdb)
19223 -stack-info-depth 12
19224 ^done,depth="12"
19225 (gdb)
19226 -stack-info-depth 11
19227 ^done,depth="11"
19228 (gdb)
19229 -stack-info-depth 13
19230 ^done,depth="12"
19231 (gdb)
19232 @end smallexample
19233
19234 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19235 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19236
19237 @subsubheading Synopsis
19238
19239 @smallexample
19240 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19241 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19242 @end smallexample
19243
19244 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19245 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19246 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19247 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19248 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19249 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19250 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19251 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19252
19253 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19254 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19255 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19256
19257 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19258
19259 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19260 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19261 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19262
19263 @subsubheading Example
19264
19265 @smallexample
19266 (gdb)
19267 -stack-list-frames
19268 ^done,
19269 stack=[
19270 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19271 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19272 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19273 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19274 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19275 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19276 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19277 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19278 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19279 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19280 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19281 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19282 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19283 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19284 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19285 (gdb)
19286 -stack-list-arguments 0
19287 ^done,
19288 stack-args=[
19289 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19290 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19291 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19292 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19293 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19294 (gdb)
19295 -stack-list-arguments 1
19296 ^done,
19297 stack-args=[
19298 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19299 frame=@{level="1",
19300 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19301 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19302 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19303 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19304 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19305 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19306 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19307 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19308 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19309 (gdb)
19310 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19311 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19312 (gdb)
19313 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19314 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19315 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19316 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19317 (gdb)
19318 @end smallexample
19319
19320 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19321
19322
19323 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19324 @findex -stack-list-frames
19325
19326 @subsubheading Synopsis
19327
19328 @smallexample
19329 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19330 @end smallexample
19331
19332 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19333 following info:
19334
19335 @table @samp
19336 @item @var{level}
19337 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19338 @item @var{addr}
19339 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19340 @item @var{func}
19341 Function name.
19342 @item @var{file}
19343 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19344 @item @var{line}
19345 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19346 @end table
19347
19348 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19349 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19350 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19351 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19352 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19353 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19354 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19355
19356 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19357
19358 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19359
19360 @subsubheading Example
19361
19362 Full stack backtrace:
19363
19364 @smallexample
19365 (gdb)
19366 -stack-list-frames
19367 ^done,stack=
19368 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19369 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19370 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19371 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19372 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19373 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19374 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19375 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19376 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19377 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19378 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19379 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19380 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19381 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19382 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19383 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19384 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19385 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19386 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19387 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19388 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19389 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19390 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19391 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19392 (gdb)
19393 @end smallexample
19394
19395 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19396
19397 @smallexample
19398 (gdb)
19399 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19400 ^done,stack=
19401 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19402 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19403 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19404 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19405 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19406 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19407 (gdb)
19408 @end smallexample
19409
19410 Show a single frame:
19411
19412 @smallexample
19413 (gdb)
19414 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19415 ^done,stack=
19416 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19417 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19418 (gdb)
19419 @end smallexample
19420
19421
19422 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19423 @findex -stack-list-locals
19424
19425 @subsubheading Synopsis
19426
19427 @smallexample
19428 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19429 @end smallexample
19430
19431 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19432 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19433 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19434 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19435 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19436 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19437 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19438 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19439 more detail.
19440
19441 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19442
19443 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19444
19445 @subsubheading Example
19446
19447 @smallexample
19448 (gdb)
19449 -stack-list-locals 0
19450 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19451 (gdb)
19452 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19453 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19454 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19455 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19456 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19457 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19458 (gdb)
19459 @end smallexample
19460
19461
19462 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19463 @findex -stack-select-frame
19464
19465 @subsubheading Synopsis
19466
19467 @smallexample
19468 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19469 @end smallexample
19470
19471 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19472 the stack.
19473
19474 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19475
19476 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19477 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19478
19479 @subsubheading Example
19480
19481 @smallexample
19482 (gdb)
19483 -stack-select-frame 2
19484 ^done
19485 (gdb)
19486 @end smallexample
19487
19488 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19489 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19490 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19491
19492 @ignore
19493
19494 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19495
19496 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19497 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19498 used by @code{Insight}.
19499
19500 The two main reasons for that are:
19501
19502 @enumerate 1
19503 @item
19504 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19505
19506 @item
19507 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19508 now).
19509 @end enumerate
19510
19511 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19512 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19513 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19514 hints about their use.
19515
19516 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19517 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19518 least, the following operations:
19519
19520 @itemize @bullet
19521 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19522 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19523 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19524 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19525 @end itemize
19526
19527 @end ignore
19528
19529 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19530
19531 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19532
19533 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19534 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19535 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19536 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19537 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19538 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19539 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19540 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19541 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19542 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19543 object, or to change display format.
19544
19545 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19546 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19547 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19548 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19549 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19550 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19551 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19552 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19553 child will be created.
19554
19555 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19556 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19557 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19558 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19559 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19560
19561 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19562 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19563 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19564 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19565 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19566 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19567 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19568 variables that frontend has created.
19569
19570 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19571 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19572 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19573 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19574 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19575 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19576 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19577 implicitly updated.
19578
19579 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19580 access this functionality:
19581
19582 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19583 @item @strong{Operation}
19584 @tab @strong{Description}
19585
19586 @item @code{-var-create}
19587 @tab create a variable object
19588 @item @code{-var-delete}
19589 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19590 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19591 @tab set the display format of this variable
19592 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19593 @tab show the display format of this variable
19594 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19595 @tab tells how many children this object has
19596 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19597 @tab return a list of the object's children
19598 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19599 @tab show the type of this variable object
19600 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19601 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
19602 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
19603 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
19604 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19605 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19606 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19607 @tab get the value of this variable
19608 @item @code{-var-assign}
19609 @tab set the value of this variable
19610 @item @code{-var-update}
19611 @tab update the variable and its children
19612 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
19613 @tab set frozeness attribute
19614 @end multitable
19615
19616 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19617 how it can be used.
19618
19619 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19620
19621 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19622 @findex -var-create
19623
19624 @subsubheading Synopsis
19625
19626 @smallexample
19627 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19628 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19629 @end smallexample
19630
19631 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19632 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19633 register.
19634
19635 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19636 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19637 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19638 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19639 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19640
19641 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19642 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19643 frame should be used.
19644
19645 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19646 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19647
19648 @itemize @bullet
19649 @item
19650 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19651
19652 @item
19653 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19654
19655 @item
19656 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19657 @end itemize
19658
19659 @subsubheading Result
19660
19661 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19662 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19663 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19664
19665 @smallexample
19666 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19667 @end smallexample
19668
19669
19670 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19671 @findex -var-delete
19672
19673 @subsubheading Synopsis
19674
19675 @smallexample
19676 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19677 @end smallexample
19678
19679 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19680 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19681
19682 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19683
19684
19685 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19686 @findex -var-set-format
19687
19688 @subsubheading Synopsis
19689
19690 @smallexample
19691 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19692 @end smallexample
19693
19694 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19695 @var{format-spec}.
19696
19697 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19698
19699 @smallexample
19700 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19701 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19702 @end smallexample
19703
19704 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19705 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19706 for pointers, etc.).
19707
19708 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19709 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19710
19711 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19712 @findex -var-show-format
19713
19714 @subsubheading Synopsis
19715
19716 @smallexample
19717 -var-show-format @var{name}
19718 @end smallexample
19719
19720 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19721
19722 @smallexample
19723 @var{format} @expansion{}
19724 @var{format-spec}
19725 @end smallexample
19726
19727
19728 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19729 @findex -var-info-num-children
19730
19731 @subsubheading Synopsis
19732
19733 @smallexample
19734 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19735 @end smallexample
19736
19737 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19738
19739 @smallexample
19740 numchild=@var{n}
19741 @end smallexample
19742
19743
19744 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19745 @findex -var-list-children
19746
19747 @subsubheading Synopsis
19748
19749 @smallexample
19750 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19751 @end smallexample
19752 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19753
19754 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19755 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19756 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19757 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19758 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19759 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19760 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19761 and unions.
19762
19763 @subsubheading Example
19764
19765 @smallexample
19766 (gdb)
19767 -var-list-children n
19768 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19769 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19770 (gdb)
19771 -var-list-children --all-values n
19772 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19773 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19774 @end smallexample
19775
19776
19777 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19778 @findex -var-info-type
19779
19780 @subsubheading Synopsis
19781
19782 @smallexample
19783 -var-info-type @var{name}
19784 @end smallexample
19785
19786 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19787 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19788 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19789
19790 @smallexample
19791 type=@var{typename}
19792 @end smallexample
19793
19794
19795 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19796 @findex -var-info-expression
19797
19798 @subsubheading Synopsis
19799
19800 @smallexample
19801 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19802 @end smallexample
19803
19804 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
19805 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
19806 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
19807
19808 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
19809 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
19810
19811 @smallexample
19812 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
19813 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
19814 @end smallexample
19815
19816 @noindent
19817 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19818
19819 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
19820 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
19821 is of limited use.
19822
19823 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
19824 @findex -var-info-path-expression
19825
19826 @subsubheading Synopsis
19827
19828 @smallexample
19829 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
19830 @end smallexample
19831
19832 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
19833 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
19834 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
19835 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
19836 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
19837 watchpoint from a variable object.
19838
19839 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
19840 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
19841 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
19842 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
19843 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
19844 @smallexample
19845 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
19846 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
19847 @end smallexample
19848
19849 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19850 @findex -var-show-attributes
19851
19852 @subsubheading Synopsis
19853
19854 @smallexample
19855 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19856 @end smallexample
19857
19858 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19859
19860 @smallexample
19861 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19862 @end smallexample
19863
19864 @noindent
19865 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19866
19867 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19868 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19869
19870 @subsubheading Synopsis
19871
19872 @smallexample
19873 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19874 @end smallexample
19875
19876 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19877 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
19878 string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
19879
19880 @smallexample
19881 value=@var{value}
19882 @end smallexample
19883
19884 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19885 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19886
19887 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19888 @findex -var-assign
19889
19890 @subsubheading Synopsis
19891
19892 @smallexample
19893 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19894 @end smallexample
19895
19896 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19897 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19898 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19899 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19900
19901 @subsubheading Example
19902
19903 @smallexample
19904 (gdb)
19905 -var-assign var1 3
19906 ^done,value="3"
19907 (gdb)
19908 -var-update *
19909 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19910 (gdb)
19911 @end smallexample
19912
19913 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19914 @findex -var-update
19915
19916 @subsubheading Synopsis
19917
19918 @smallexample
19919 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19920 @end smallexample
19921
19922 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
19923 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
19924 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
19925 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
19926 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
19927 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
19928 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
19929 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
19930 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
19931 names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
19932 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
19933 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
19934 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
19935
19936
19937 @subsubheading Example
19938
19939 @smallexample
19940 (gdb)
19941 -var-assign var1 3
19942 ^done,value="3"
19943 (gdb)
19944 -var-update --all-values var1
19945 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19946 type_changed="false"@}]
19947 (gdb)
19948 @end smallexample
19949
19950 @anchor{-var-update}
19951 The field in_scope may take three values:
19952
19953 @table @code
19954 @item "true"
19955 The variable object's current value is valid.
19956
19957 @item "false"
19958 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
19959 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
19960 scope.
19961
19962 @item "invalid"
19963 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
19964 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
19965 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
19966 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
19967 objects.
19968 @end table
19969
19970 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
19971 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
19972
19973 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
19974 @findex -var-set-frozen
19975 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
19976
19977 @subsubheading Synopsis
19978
19979 @smallexample
19980 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
19981 @end smallexample
19982
19983 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
19984 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
19985 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
19986 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
19987 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
19988 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
19989 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
19990 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
19991 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
19992 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
19993 @code{-var-update} does.
19994
19995 @subsubheading Example
19996
19997 @smallexample
19998 (gdb)
19999 -var-set-frozen V 1
20000 ^done
20001 (gdb)
20002 @end smallexample
20003
20004
20005 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20006 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20007 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20008
20009 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20010 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20011 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20012 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20013
20014 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20015 @c @subheading -data-assign
20016 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20017 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
20018 @c set variable
20019 @c @subsubheading Example
20020 @c N.A.
20021
20022 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20023 @findex -data-disassemble
20024
20025 @subsubheading Synopsis
20026
20027 @smallexample
20028 -data-disassemble
20029 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20030 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20031 -- @var{mode}
20032 @end smallexample
20033
20034 @noindent
20035 Where:
20036
20037 @table @samp
20038 @item @var{start-addr}
20039 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20040 @item @var{end-addr}
20041 is the end address
20042 @item @var{filename}
20043 is the name of the file to disassemble
20044 @item @var{linenum}
20045 is the line number to disassemble around
20046 @item @var{lines}
20047 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20048 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20049 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20050 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20051 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20052 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20053 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20054 are displayed.
20055 @item @var{mode}
20056 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20057 disassembly).
20058 @end table
20059
20060 @subsubheading Result
20061
20062 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20063
20064 @itemize @bullet
20065 @item Address
20066 @item Func-name
20067 @item Offset
20068 @item Instruction
20069 @end itemize
20070
20071 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20072 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20073
20074 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20075
20076 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20077
20078 @subsubheading Example
20079
20080 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20081
20082 @smallexample
20083 (gdb)
20084 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20085 ^done,
20086 asm_insns=[
20087 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20088 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20089 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20090 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20091 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20092 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20093 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20094 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20095 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20096 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20097 (gdb)
20098 @end smallexample
20099
20100 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20101 @code{main}.
20102
20103 @smallexample
20104 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20105 ^done,asm_insns=[
20106 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20107 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20108 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20109 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20110 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20111 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20112 [@dots{}]
20113 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20114 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20115 (gdb)
20116 @end smallexample
20117
20118 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20119
20120 @smallexample
20121 (gdb)
20122 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20123 ^done,asm_insns=[
20124 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20125 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20126 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20127 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20128 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20129 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20130 (gdb)
20131 @end smallexample
20132
20133 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20134
20135 @smallexample
20136 (gdb)
20137 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20138 ^done,asm_insns=[
20139 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20140 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20141 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20142 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20143 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20144 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20145 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20146 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20147 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20148 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20149 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20150 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20151 (gdb)
20152 @end smallexample
20153
20154
20155 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20156 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20157
20158 @subsubheading Synopsis
20159
20160 @smallexample
20161 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20162 @end smallexample
20163
20164 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20165 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20166 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20167
20168 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20169
20170 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20171 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20172 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20173
20174 @subsubheading Example
20175
20176 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20177 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20178 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20179 output.
20180
20181 @smallexample
20182 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20183 211^done,value="1"
20184 (gdb)
20185 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20186 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20187 (gdb)
20188 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20189 411^done,value="4"
20190 (gdb)
20191 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20192 511^done,value="4"
20193 (gdb)
20194 @end smallexample
20195
20196
20197 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20198 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20199
20200 @subsubheading Synopsis
20201
20202 @smallexample
20203 -data-list-changed-registers
20204 @end smallexample
20205
20206 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20207
20208 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20209
20210 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20211 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20212
20213 @subsubheading Example
20214
20215 On a PPC MBX board:
20216
20217 @smallexample
20218 (gdb)
20219 -exec-continue
20220 ^running
20221
20222 (gdb)
20223 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20224 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20225 (gdb)
20226 -data-list-changed-registers
20227 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20228 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20229 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20230 (gdb)
20231 @end smallexample
20232
20233
20234 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20235 @findex -data-list-register-names
20236
20237 @subsubheading Synopsis
20238
20239 @smallexample
20240 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20241 @end smallexample
20242
20243 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20244 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20245 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20246 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20247 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20248 include empty register names.
20249
20250 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20251
20252 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20253 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20254 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20255
20256 @subsubheading Example
20257
20258 For the PPC MBX board:
20259 @smallexample
20260 (gdb)
20261 -data-list-register-names
20262 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20263 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20264 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20265 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20266 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20267 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20268 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20269 (gdb)
20270 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20271 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20272 (gdb)
20273 @end smallexample
20274
20275 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20276 @findex -data-list-register-values
20277
20278 @subsubheading Synopsis
20279
20280 @smallexample
20281 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20282 @end smallexample
20283
20284 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20285 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20286 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20287 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20288
20289 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20290
20291 @table @code
20292 @item x
20293 Hexadecimal
20294 @item o
20295 Octal
20296 @item t
20297 Binary
20298 @item d
20299 Decimal
20300 @item r
20301 Raw
20302 @item N
20303 Natural
20304 @end table
20305
20306 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20307
20308 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20309 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20310
20311 @subsubheading Example
20312
20313 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20314 don't appear in the actual output):
20315
20316 @smallexample
20317 (gdb)
20318 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20319 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20320 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20321 (gdb)
20322 -data-list-register-values x
20323 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20324 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20325 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20326 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20327 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20328 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20329 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20330 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20331 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20332 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20333 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20334 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20335 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20336 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20337 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20338 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20339 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20340 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20341 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20342 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20343 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20344 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20345 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20346 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20347 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20348 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20349 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20350 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20351 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20352 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20353 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20354 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20355 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20356 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20357 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20358 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20359 (gdb)
20360 @end smallexample
20361
20362
20363 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20364 @findex -data-read-memory
20365
20366 @subsubheading Synopsis
20367
20368 @smallexample
20369 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20370 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20371 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20372 @end smallexample
20373
20374 @noindent
20375 where:
20376
20377 @table @samp
20378 @item @var{address}
20379 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20380 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20381 quoted using the C convention.
20382
20383 @item @var{word-format}
20384 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20385 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20386 ,Output Formats}).
20387
20388 @item @var{word-size}
20389 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20390
20391 @item @var{nr-rows}
20392 The number of rows in the output table.
20393
20394 @item @var{nr-cols}
20395 The number of columns in the output table.
20396
20397 @item @var{aschar}
20398 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20399 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20400 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20401 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20402
20403 @item @var{byte-offset}
20404 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20405 @end table
20406
20407 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20408 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20409 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20410 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20411 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20412 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20413 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20414 @samp{addr}.
20415
20416 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20417 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20418 @samp{prev-page}.
20419
20420 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20421
20422 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20423 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20424
20425 @subsubheading Example
20426
20427 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20428 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20429 word. Display each word in hex.
20430
20431 @smallexample
20432 (gdb)
20433 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20434 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20435 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20436 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20437 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20438 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20439 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20440 (gdb)
20441 @end smallexample
20442
20443 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20444 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20445
20446 @smallexample
20447 (gdb)
20448 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20449 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20450 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20451 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20452 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20453 (gdb)
20454 @end smallexample
20455
20456 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20457 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20458 used as the non-printable character.
20459
20460 @smallexample
20461 (gdb)
20462 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20463 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20464 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20465 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20466 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20467 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20468 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20469 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20470 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20471 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20472 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20473 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20474 (gdb)
20475 @end smallexample
20476
20477 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20478 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20479 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20480
20481 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20482
20483 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20484
20485 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20486
20487 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20488
20489 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20490
20491 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20492
20493 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20494
20495 @c @subheading -trace-find
20496
20497 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20498
20499 @c @subheading -trace-info
20500
20501 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20502
20503 @c @subheading -trace-list
20504
20505 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20506
20507 @c @subheading -trace-save
20508
20509 @c @subheading -trace-start
20510
20511 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20512
20513
20514 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20515 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20516 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20517
20518
20519 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20520 @findex -symbol-info-address
20521
20522 @subsubheading Synopsis
20523
20524 @smallexample
20525 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20526 @end smallexample
20527
20528 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20529
20530 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20531
20532 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20533
20534 @subsubheading Example
20535 N.A.
20536
20537
20538 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20539 @findex -symbol-info-file
20540
20541 @subsubheading Synopsis
20542
20543 @smallexample
20544 -symbol-info-file
20545 @end smallexample
20546
20547 Show the file for the symbol.
20548
20549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20550
20551 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20552 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20553
20554 @subsubheading Example
20555 N.A.
20556
20557
20558 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20559 @findex -symbol-info-function
20560
20561 @subsubheading Synopsis
20562
20563 @smallexample
20564 -symbol-info-function
20565 @end smallexample
20566
20567 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20568
20569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20570
20571 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20572
20573 @subsubheading Example
20574 N.A.
20575
20576
20577 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20578 @findex -symbol-info-line
20579
20580 @subsubheading Synopsis
20581
20582 @smallexample
20583 -symbol-info-line
20584 @end smallexample
20585
20586 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20587
20588 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20589
20590 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20591 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20592
20593 @subsubheading Example
20594 N.A.
20595
20596
20597 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20598 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20599
20600 @subsubheading Synopsis
20601
20602 @smallexample
20603 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20604 @end smallexample
20605
20606 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20607
20608 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20609
20610 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20611
20612 @subsubheading Example
20613 N.A.
20614
20615
20616 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20617 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20618
20619 @subsubheading Synopsis
20620
20621 @smallexample
20622 -symbol-list-functions
20623 @end smallexample
20624
20625 List the functions in the executable.
20626
20627 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20628
20629 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20630 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20631
20632 @subsubheading Example
20633 N.A.
20634
20635
20636 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20637 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20638
20639 @subsubheading Synopsis
20640
20641 @smallexample
20642 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20643 @end smallexample
20644
20645 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20646 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20647 ascending PC order.
20648
20649 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20650
20651 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20652
20653 @subsubheading Example
20654 @smallexample
20655 (gdb)
20656 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20657 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20658 (gdb)
20659 @end smallexample
20660
20661
20662 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20663 @findex -symbol-list-types
20664
20665 @subsubheading Synopsis
20666
20667 @smallexample
20668 -symbol-list-types
20669 @end smallexample
20670
20671 List all the type names.
20672
20673 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20674
20675 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20676 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20677
20678 @subsubheading Example
20679 N.A.
20680
20681
20682 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20683 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20684
20685 @subsubheading Synopsis
20686
20687 @smallexample
20688 -symbol-list-variables
20689 @end smallexample
20690
20691 List all the global and static variable names.
20692
20693 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20694
20695 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20696
20697 @subsubheading Example
20698 N.A.
20699
20700
20701 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20702 @findex -symbol-locate
20703
20704 @subsubheading Synopsis
20705
20706 @smallexample
20707 -symbol-locate
20708 @end smallexample
20709
20710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20711
20712 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20713
20714 @subsubheading Example
20715 N.A.
20716
20717
20718 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20719 @findex -symbol-type
20720
20721 @subsubheading Synopsis
20722
20723 @smallexample
20724 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20725 @end smallexample
20726
20727 Show type of @var{variable}.
20728
20729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20730
20731 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20732 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20733
20734 @subsubheading Example
20735 N.A.
20736
20737
20738 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20739 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20740 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20741
20742 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20743 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20744
20745 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20746 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20747
20748 @subsubheading Synopsis
20749
20750 @smallexample
20751 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20752 @end smallexample
20753
20754 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20755 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20756 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20757 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20758 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20759 notification.
20760
20761 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20762
20763 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20764
20765 @subsubheading Example
20766
20767 @smallexample
20768 (gdb)
20769 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20770 ^done
20771 (gdb)
20772 @end smallexample
20773
20774
20775 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20776 @findex -file-exec-file
20777
20778 @subsubheading Synopsis
20779
20780 @smallexample
20781 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20782 @end smallexample
20783
20784 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20785 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20786 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20787 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20788 notification.
20789
20790 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20791
20792 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20793
20794 @subsubheading Example
20795
20796 @smallexample
20797 (gdb)
20798 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20799 ^done
20800 (gdb)
20801 @end smallexample
20802
20803
20804 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20805 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20806
20807 @subsubheading Synopsis
20808
20809 @smallexample
20810 -file-list-exec-sections
20811 @end smallexample
20812
20813 List the sections of the current executable file.
20814
20815 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20816
20817 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20818 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20819 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20820
20821 @subsubheading Example
20822 N.A.
20823
20824
20825 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20826 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20827
20828 @subsubheading Synopsis
20829
20830 @smallexample
20831 -file-list-exec-source-file
20832 @end smallexample
20833
20834 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20835 to the current source file for the current executable.
20836
20837 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20838
20839 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20840
20841 @subsubheading Example
20842
20843 @smallexample
20844 (gdb)
20845 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20846 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20847 (gdb)
20848 @end smallexample
20849
20850
20851 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20852 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20853
20854 @subsubheading Synopsis
20855
20856 @smallexample
20857 -file-list-exec-source-files
20858 @end smallexample
20859
20860 List the source files for the current executable.
20861
20862 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
20863 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20864
20865 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20866
20867 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20868 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20869
20870 @subsubheading Example
20871 @smallexample
20872 (gdb)
20873 -file-list-exec-source-files
20874 ^done,files=[
20875 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20876 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20877 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20878 (gdb)
20879 @end smallexample
20880
20881 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20882 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20883
20884 @subsubheading Synopsis
20885
20886 @smallexample
20887 -file-list-shared-libraries
20888 @end smallexample
20889
20890 List the shared libraries in the program.
20891
20892 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20893
20894 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20895
20896 @subsubheading Example
20897 N.A.
20898
20899
20900 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20901 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20902
20903 @subsubheading Synopsis
20904
20905 @smallexample
20906 -file-list-symbol-files
20907 @end smallexample
20908
20909 List symbol files.
20910
20911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20912
20913 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20914
20915 @subsubheading Example
20916 N.A.
20917
20918
20919 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20920 @findex -file-symbol-file
20921
20922 @subsubheading Synopsis
20923
20924 @smallexample
20925 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20926 @end smallexample
20927
20928 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20929 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20930 produced, except for a completion notification.
20931
20932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20933
20934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20935
20936 @subsubheading Example
20937
20938 @smallexample
20939 (gdb)
20940 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20941 ^done
20942 (gdb)
20943 @end smallexample
20944
20945 @ignore
20946 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20947 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20948 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20949
20950 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20951
20952 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20953
20954 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20955
20956 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20957
20958 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20959
20960 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20961
20962 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20963
20964 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20965
20966 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20967 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20968 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20969
20970 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20971
20972 @c @subheading -signal-handle
20973
20974 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20975
20976 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20977 @end ignore
20978
20979
20980 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20981 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20982 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20983
20984
20985 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20986 @findex -target-attach
20987
20988 @subsubheading Synopsis
20989
20990 @smallexample
20991 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20992 @end smallexample
20993
20994 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20995
20996 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20997
20998 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20999
21000 @subsubheading Example
21001 N.A.
21002
21003
21004 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21005 @findex -target-compare-sections
21006
21007 @subsubheading Synopsis
21008
21009 @smallexample
21010 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21011 @end smallexample
21012
21013 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21014 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21015
21016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21017
21018 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21019
21020 @subsubheading Example
21021 N.A.
21022
21023
21024 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21025 @findex -target-detach
21026
21027 @subsubheading Synopsis
21028
21029 @smallexample
21030 -target-detach
21031 @end smallexample
21032
21033 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21034 There's no output.
21035
21036 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21037
21038 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21039
21040 @subsubheading Example
21041
21042 @smallexample
21043 (gdb)
21044 -target-detach
21045 ^done
21046 (gdb)
21047 @end smallexample
21048
21049
21050 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21051 @findex -target-disconnect
21052
21053 @subsubheading Synopsis
21054
21055 @smallexample
21056 -target-disconnect
21057 @end smallexample
21058
21059 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21060 generally not resumed.
21061
21062 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21063
21064 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21065
21066 @subsubheading Example
21067
21068 @smallexample
21069 (gdb)
21070 -target-disconnect
21071 ^done
21072 (gdb)
21073 @end smallexample
21074
21075
21076 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21077 @findex -target-download
21078
21079 @subsubheading Synopsis
21080
21081 @smallexample
21082 -target-download
21083 @end smallexample
21084
21085 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21086 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21087
21088 @table @samp
21089 @item section
21090 The name of the section.
21091 @item section-sent
21092 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21093 @item section-size
21094 The size of the section.
21095 @item total-sent
21096 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21097 @item total-size
21098 The size of the overall executable to download.
21099 @end table
21100
21101 @noindent
21102 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21103 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21104
21105 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21106 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21107
21108 @table @samp
21109 @item section
21110 The name of the section.
21111 @item section-size
21112 The size of the section.
21113 @item total-size
21114 The size of the overall executable to download.
21115 @end table
21116
21117 @noindent
21118 At the end, a summary is printed.
21119
21120 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21121
21122 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21123
21124 @subsubheading Example
21125
21126 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21127 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21128
21129 @smallexample
21130 (gdb)
21131 -target-download
21132 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21133 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21134 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21135 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21136 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21137 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21138 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21139 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21140 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21141 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21142 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21143 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21144 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21145 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21146 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21147 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21148 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21149 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21150 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21151 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21152 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21153 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21154 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21155 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21156 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21157 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21158 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21159 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21160 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21161 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21162 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21163 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21164 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21165 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21166 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21167 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21168 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21169 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21170 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21171 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21172 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21173 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21174 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21175 write-rate="429"
21176 (gdb)
21177 @end smallexample
21178
21179
21180 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21181 @findex -target-exec-status
21182
21183 @subsubheading Synopsis
21184
21185 @smallexample
21186 -target-exec-status
21187 @end smallexample
21188
21189 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21190 not, for instance).
21191
21192 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21193
21194 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21195
21196 @subsubheading Example
21197 N.A.
21198
21199
21200 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21201 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21202
21203 @subsubheading Synopsis
21204
21205 @smallexample
21206 -target-list-available-targets
21207 @end smallexample
21208
21209 List the possible targets to connect to.
21210
21211 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21212
21213 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21214
21215 @subsubheading Example
21216 N.A.
21217
21218
21219 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21220 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21221
21222 @subsubheading Synopsis
21223
21224 @smallexample
21225 -target-list-current-targets
21226 @end smallexample
21227
21228 Describe the current target.
21229
21230 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21231
21232 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21233 other things).
21234
21235 @subsubheading Example
21236 N.A.
21237
21238
21239 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21240 @findex -target-list-parameters
21241
21242 @subsubheading Synopsis
21243
21244 @smallexample
21245 -target-list-parameters
21246 @end smallexample
21247
21248 @c ????
21249
21250 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21251
21252 No equivalent.
21253
21254 @subsubheading Example
21255 N.A.
21256
21257
21258 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21259 @findex -target-select
21260
21261 @subsubheading Synopsis
21262
21263 @smallexample
21264 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21265 @end smallexample
21266
21267 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21268
21269 @table @samp
21270 @item @var{type}
21271 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21272 @item @var{parameters}
21273 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21274 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21275 @end table
21276
21277 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21278 which the target program is, in the following form:
21279
21280 @smallexample
21281 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21282 args=[@var{arg list}]
21283 @end smallexample
21284
21285 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21286
21287 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21288
21289 @subsubheading Example
21290
21291 @smallexample
21292 (gdb)
21293 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21294 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21295 (gdb)
21296 @end smallexample
21297
21298 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21299 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21300 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21301
21302 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21303
21304 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21305 @findex -gdb-exit
21306
21307 @subsubheading Synopsis
21308
21309 @smallexample
21310 -gdb-exit
21311 @end smallexample
21312
21313 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21314
21315 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21316
21317 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21318
21319 @subsubheading Example
21320
21321 @smallexample
21322 (gdb)
21323 -gdb-exit
21324 ^exit
21325 @end smallexample
21326
21327
21328 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21329 @findex -exec-abort
21330
21331 @subsubheading Synopsis
21332
21333 @smallexample
21334 -exec-abort
21335 @end smallexample
21336
21337 Kill the inferior running program.
21338
21339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21340
21341 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21342
21343 @subsubheading Example
21344 N.A.
21345
21346
21347 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21348 @findex -gdb-set
21349
21350 @subsubheading Synopsis
21351
21352 @smallexample
21353 -gdb-set
21354 @end smallexample
21355
21356 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21357 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21358
21359 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21360
21361 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21362
21363 @subsubheading Example
21364
21365 @smallexample
21366 (gdb)
21367 -gdb-set $foo=3
21368 ^done
21369 (gdb)
21370 @end smallexample
21371
21372
21373 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21374 @findex -gdb-show
21375
21376 @subsubheading Synopsis
21377
21378 @smallexample
21379 -gdb-show
21380 @end smallexample
21381
21382 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21383
21384 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21385
21386 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21387
21388 @subsubheading Example
21389
21390 @smallexample
21391 (gdb)
21392 -gdb-show annotate
21393 ^done,value="0"
21394 (gdb)
21395 @end smallexample
21396
21397 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21398
21399
21400 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21401 @findex -gdb-version
21402
21403 @subsubheading Synopsis
21404
21405 @smallexample
21406 -gdb-version
21407 @end smallexample
21408
21409 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21410
21411 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21412
21413 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21414 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21415
21416 @subsubheading Example
21417
21418 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21419 @c box in TeX.
21420 @smallexample
21421 (gdb)
21422 -gdb-version
21423 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21424 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21425 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21426 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21427 ~ certain conditions.
21428 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21429 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21430 ~ details.
21431 ~This GDB was configured as
21432 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21433 ^done
21434 (gdb)
21435 @end smallexample
21436
21437 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
21438 @findex -list-features
21439
21440 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
21441 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
21442 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
21443 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
21444 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
21445 startup.
21446
21447 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
21448 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
21449 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
21450 is given below.
21451
21452 Example output:
21453
21454 @smallexample
21455 (gdb) -list-features
21456 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
21457 @end smallexample
21458
21459 The current list of features is:
21460
21461 @itemize @minus
21462 @item
21463 @samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
21464 @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
21465 @code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
21466 @end itemize
21467
21468 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21469 @findex -interpreter-exec
21470
21471 @subheading Synopsis
21472
21473 @smallexample
21474 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21475 @end smallexample
21476 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21477
21478 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21479
21480 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21481
21482 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21483
21484 @subheading Example
21485
21486 @smallexample
21487 (gdb)
21488 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21489 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21490 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21491 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21492 ^done
21493 (gdb)
21494 @end smallexample
21495
21496 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21497 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21498
21499 @subheading Synopsis
21500
21501 @smallexample
21502 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21503 @end smallexample
21504
21505 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21506
21507 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21508
21509 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21510
21511 @subheading Example
21512
21513 @smallexample
21514 (gdb)
21515 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21516 ^done
21517 (gdb)
21518 @end smallexample
21519
21520 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21521 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21522
21523 @subheading Synopsis
21524
21525 @smallexample
21526 -inferior-tty-show
21527 @end smallexample
21528
21529 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21530
21531 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21532
21533 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21534
21535 @subheading Example
21536
21537 @smallexample
21538 (gdb)
21539 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21540 ^done
21541 (gdb)
21542 -inferior-tty-show
21543 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21544 (gdb)
21545 @end smallexample
21546
21547 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21548 @findex -enable-timings
21549
21550 @subheading Synopsis
21551
21552 @smallexample
21553 -enable-timings [yes | no]
21554 @end smallexample
21555
21556 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21557 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21558 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21559 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21560
21561 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21562
21563 No equivalent.
21564
21565 @subheading Example
21566
21567 @smallexample
21568 (gdb)
21569 -enable-timings
21570 ^done
21571 (gdb)
21572 -break-insert main
21573 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21574 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21575 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21576 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21577 (gdb)
21578 -enable-timings no
21579 ^done
21580 (gdb)
21581 -exec-run
21582 ^running
21583 (gdb)
21584 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21585 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21586 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21587 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21588 (gdb)
21589 @end smallexample
21590
21591 @node Annotations
21592 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21593
21594 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21595 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21596 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21597 relatively high level.
21598
21599 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21600 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21601
21602 @ignore
21603 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21604 @end ignore
21605
21606 @menu
21607 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21608 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
21609 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21610 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21611 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21612 * Annotations for Running::
21613 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21614 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21615 @end menu
21616
21617 @node Annotations Overview
21618 @section What is an Annotation?
21619 @cindex annotations
21620
21621 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21622 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21623 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21624 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21625 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21626 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21627 cannot contain newline characters.
21628
21629 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21630 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21631 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21632 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21633 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21634 means those three characters as output.
21635
21636 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21637 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21638 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21639 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21640 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21641 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21642 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21643 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21644 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21645
21646 @table @code
21647 @kindex set annotate
21648 @item set annotate @var{level}
21649 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21650 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21651
21652 @item show annotate
21653 @kindex show annotate
21654 Show the current annotation level.
21655 @end table
21656
21657 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21658
21659 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21660
21661 @smallexample
21662 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21663 GNU gdb 6.0
21664 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21665 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21666 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21667 under certain conditions.
21668 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21669 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21670 for details.
21671 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21672
21673 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21674 (@value{GDBP})
21675 ^Z^Zprompt
21676 @kbd{quit}
21677
21678 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21679 $
21680 @end smallexample
21681
21682 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21683 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21684 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21685 output from @value{GDBN}.
21686
21687 @node Server Prefix
21688 @section The Server Prefix
21689 @cindex server prefix
21690
21691 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
21692 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
21693 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
21694 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
21695 a transparent manner.
21696
21697 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21698 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21699 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21700
21701 @node Prompting
21702 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21703
21704 @cindex annotations for prompts
21705 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21706 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21707 over, etc.
21708
21709 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21710 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21711 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21712 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21713 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21714 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21715 features the following annotations:
21716
21717 @smallexample
21718 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21719 ^Z^Zprompt
21720 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21721 @end smallexample
21722
21723 The input types are
21724
21725 @table @code
21726 @findex pre-prompt annotation
21727 @findex prompt annotation
21728 @findex post-prompt annotation
21729 @item prompt
21730 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21731
21732 @findex pre-commands annotation
21733 @findex commands annotation
21734 @findex post-commands annotation
21735 @item commands
21736 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21737 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21738
21739 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21740 @findex overload-choice annotation
21741 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
21742 @item overload-choice
21743 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21744
21745 @findex pre-query annotation
21746 @findex query annotation
21747 @findex post-query annotation
21748 @item query
21749 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21750
21751 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21752 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21753 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21754 @item prompt-for-continue
21755 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21756 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21757 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21758 presence of annotations.
21759 @end table
21760
21761 @node Errors
21762 @section Errors
21763 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21764
21765 @findex quit annotation
21766 @smallexample
21767 ^Z^Zquit
21768 @end smallexample
21769
21770 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21771
21772 @findex error annotation
21773 @smallexample
21774 ^Z^Zerror
21775 @end smallexample
21776
21777 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21778
21779 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21780 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21781 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21782 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21783 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21784 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21785 to the top level.
21786
21787 @findex error-begin annotation
21788 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21789
21790 @smallexample
21791 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21792 @end smallexample
21793
21794 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21795 message.
21796
21797 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21798 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21799 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21800
21801 @node Invalidation
21802 @section Invalidation Notices
21803
21804 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21805 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21806 changed.
21807
21808 @table @code
21809 @findex frames-invalid annotation
21810 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21811
21812 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21813 have changed.
21814
21815 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
21816 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21817
21818 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21819 deleted a breakpoint.
21820 @end table
21821
21822 @node Annotations for Running
21823 @section Running the Program
21824 @cindex annotations for running programs
21825
21826 @findex starting annotation
21827 @findex stopping annotation
21828 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21829 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21830
21831 @smallexample
21832 ^Z^Zstarting
21833 @end smallexample
21834
21835 is output. When the program stops,
21836
21837 @smallexample
21838 ^Z^Zstopped
21839 @end smallexample
21840
21841 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21842 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21843
21844 @table @code
21845 @findex exited annotation
21846 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21847 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21848 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21849
21850 @findex signalled annotation
21851 @findex signal-name annotation
21852 @findex signal-name-end annotation
21853 @findex signal-string annotation
21854 @findex signal-string-end annotation
21855 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21856 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21857 annotation continues:
21858
21859 @smallexample
21860 @var{intro-text}
21861 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21862 @var{name}
21863 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21864 @var{middle-text}
21865 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21866 @var{string}
21867 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21868 @var{end-text}
21869 @end smallexample
21870
21871 @noindent
21872 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21873 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21874 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21875 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21876 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21877
21878 @findex signal annotation
21879 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21880 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21881 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21882 terminated with it.
21883
21884 @findex breakpoint annotation
21885 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21886 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21887
21888 @findex watchpoint annotation
21889 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21890 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21891 @end table
21892
21893 @node Source Annotations
21894 @section Displaying Source
21895 @cindex annotations for source display
21896
21897 @findex source annotation
21898 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21899
21900 @smallexample
21901 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21902 @end smallexample
21903
21904 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21905 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21906 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21907 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21908 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21909 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21910 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21911 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21912 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21913 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21914 depend on the language).
21915
21916 @node GDB Bugs
21917 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21918 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21919 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21920
21921 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21922
21923 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21924 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21925 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21926 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21927
21928 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21929 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21930
21931 @menu
21932 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21933 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21934 @end menu
21935
21936 @node Bug Criteria
21937 @section Have You Found a Bug?
21938 @cindex bug criteria
21939
21940 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21941
21942 @itemize @bullet
21943 @cindex fatal signal
21944 @cindex debugger crash
21945 @cindex crash of debugger
21946 @item
21947 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21948 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21949
21950 @cindex error on valid input
21951 @item
21952 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21953 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21954 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21955
21956 @cindex invalid input
21957 @item
21958 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21959 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21960 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21961 for traditional practice''.
21962
21963 @item
21964 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21965 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21966 @end itemize
21967
21968 @node Bug Reporting
21969 @section How to Report Bugs
21970 @cindex bug reports
21971 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21972
21973 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21974 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21975 contact that organization first.
21976
21977 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21978 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21979 distribution.
21980 @c should add a web page ref...
21981
21982 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21983 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
21984 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21985 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21986 be used.
21987
21988 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21989 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21990 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21991 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21992
21993 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21994 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21995 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21996 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21997 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21998 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21999 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
22000 bug reports to the mailing list.
22001
22002 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
22003 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
22004 fact or leave it out, state it!
22005
22006 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
22007 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
22008 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
22009 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
22010 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22011 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22012 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22013 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22014 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22015
22016 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22017 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22018 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22019 self-contained.
22020
22021 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22022 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22023 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22024 bugs properly.
22025
22026 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22027
22028 @itemize @bullet
22029 @item
22030 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22031 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22032 version}.
22033
22034 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22035 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22036
22037 @item
22038 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22039 version number.
22040
22041 @item
22042 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22043 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22044
22045 @item
22046 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22047 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22048 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
22049 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
22050 those compilers.
22051
22052 @item
22053 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22054 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22055 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22056 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22057
22058 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22059 and then we might not encounter the bug.
22060
22061 @item
22062 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22063 reproduce the bug.
22064
22065 @item
22066 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22067 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22068
22069 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22070 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22071 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22072 a chance to make a mistake.
22073
22074 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22075 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22076 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22077 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22078 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22079 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22080 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22081 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22082
22083 @pindex script
22084 @cindex recording a session script
22085 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22086 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22087 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22088 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22089
22090 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22091 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22092
22093 @item
22094 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22095 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22096 it by context, not by line number.
22097
22098 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22099 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22100
22101 @end itemize
22102
22103 Here are some things that are not necessary:
22104
22105 @itemize @bullet
22106 @item
22107 A description of the envelope of the bug.
22108
22109 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22110 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22111 changes will not affect it.
22112
22113 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22114 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22115 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22116 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22117
22118 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22119 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22120 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22121 less time, and so on.
22122
22123 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22124 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22125
22126 @item
22127 A patch for the bug.
22128
22129 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22130 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22131 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22132 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22133
22134 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22135 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22136 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22137 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22138
22139 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22140 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22141 help us to understand.
22142
22143 @item
22144 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22145
22146 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22147 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22148 @end itemize
22149
22150 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22151 @c and consists of the two following files:
22152 @c rluser.texinfo
22153 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22154 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22155 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22156 @include rluser.texi
22157 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22158
22159
22160 @node Formatting Documentation
22161 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22162
22163 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22164 @cindex reference card
22165 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22166 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22167 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22168 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22169 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22170 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22171
22172 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22173 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22174
22175 @smallexample
22176 make refcard.dvi
22177 @end smallexample
22178
22179 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22180 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22181 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22182 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22183 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22184
22185 @cindex documentation
22186
22187 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22188 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22189 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22190 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22191 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22192 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22193
22194 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22195 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22196 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22197 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22198 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22199 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22200 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22201 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22202
22203 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22204 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22205 @code{makeinfo}.
22206
22207 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22208 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22209 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22210
22211 @smallexample
22212 cd gdb
22213 make gdb.info
22214 @end smallexample
22215
22216 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22217 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22218 Texinfo definitions file.
22219
22220 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22221 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22222 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22223 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22224 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22225 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22226 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22227
22228 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22229 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22230 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22231 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22232 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22233 directory.
22234
22235 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22236 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22237 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22238 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22239
22240 @smallexample
22241 make gdb.dvi
22242 @end smallexample
22243
22244 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22245
22246 @node Installing GDB
22247 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22248 @cindex installation
22249
22250 @menu
22251 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22252 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
22253 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22254 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22255 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22256 @end menu
22257
22258 @node Requirements
22259 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
22260 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22261
22262 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22263 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22264
22265 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
22266 @table @asis
22267 @item ISO C90 compiler
22268 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22269 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22270
22271 @end table
22272
22273 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
22274 @table @asis
22275 @item Expat
22276 @anchor{Expat}
22277 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22278 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22279 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22280 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
22281 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22282 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22283
22284 Expat is used for:
22285
22286 @itemize @bullet
22287 @item
22288 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
22289 @item
22290 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
22291 @item
22292 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
22293 @item
22294 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
22295 @end itemize
22296
22297 @end table
22298
22299 @node Running Configure
22300 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
22301 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22302 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
22303 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22304 build the @code{gdb} program.
22305 @iftex
22306 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22307 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22308 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22309 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22310 @end iftex
22311
22312 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22313 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22314 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22315
22316 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22317 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22318
22319 @table @code
22320 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22321 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22322
22323 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22324 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22325
22326 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22327 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22328
22329 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22330 @sc{gnu} include files
22331
22332 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22333 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22334
22335 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22336 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22337
22338 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22339 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22340
22341 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22342 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22343
22344 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22345 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22346 @end table
22347
22348 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
22349 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22350 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22351
22352 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22353 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
22354 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22355 argument.
22356
22357 For example:
22358
22359 @smallexample
22360 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22361 ./configure @var{host}
22362 make
22363 @end smallexample
22364
22365 @noindent
22366 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22367 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22368 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
22369 correct value by examining your system.)
22370
22371 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22372 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22373 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22374 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22375
22376 @need 750
22377 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22378 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22379 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22380
22381 @smallexample
22382 sh configure @var{host}
22383 @end smallexample
22384
22385 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
22386 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22387 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
22388 @file{configure}
22389 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22390 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22391
22392 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
22393 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22394 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22395 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22396 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22397 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22398 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22399 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22400 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22401
22402 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22403 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22404 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22405 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22406 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22407
22408 @node Separate Objdir
22409 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
22410
22411 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22412 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22413 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22414 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22415 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22416 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22417 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22418 program specified there.
22419
22420 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22421 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22422 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22423 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22424 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22425 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22426
22427 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22428 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22429
22430 @smallexample
22431 @group
22432 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22433 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22434 cd ../gdb-sun4
22435 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22436 make
22437 @end group
22438 @end smallexample
22439
22440 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22441 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22442 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22443 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22444 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22445 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22446
22447 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22448 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22449 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22450 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22451 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22452
22453 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22454 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22455 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22456 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22457 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22458 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22459
22460 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22461 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22462 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22463
22464 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22465 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22466 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22467 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22468 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22469
22470 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22471 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22472 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22473 with each other.
22474
22475 @node Config Names
22476 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22477
22478 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22479 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22480 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22481 of information in the following pattern:
22482
22483 @smallexample
22484 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22485 @end smallexample
22486
22487 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22488 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22489 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22490
22491 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22492 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22493 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22494 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22495 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22496 abbreviations---for example:
22497
22498 @smallexample
22499 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22500 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22501 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22502 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22503 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22504 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22505 % sh config.sub sun4
22506 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22507 % sh config.sub sun3
22508 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22509 % sh config.sub i986v
22510 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22511 @end smallexample
22512
22513 @noindent
22514 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22515 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22516
22517 @node Configure Options
22518 @section @file{configure} Options
22519
22520 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22521 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22522 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22523 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22524
22525 @smallexample
22526 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22527 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22528 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22529 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22530 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22531 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22532 @var{host}
22533 @end smallexample
22534
22535 @noindent
22536 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22537 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22538 @samp{--}.
22539
22540 @table @code
22541 @item --help
22542 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
22543
22544 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22545 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22546 @file{@var{dir}}.
22547
22548 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22549 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22550 @file{@var{dir}}.
22551
22552 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22553 @need 2000
22554 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22555 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22556 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22557 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22558 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22559 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22560 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
22561 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22562 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
22563 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22564 @var{dirname}.
22565
22566 @item --norecursion
22567 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
22568 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22569
22570 @item --target=@var{target}
22571 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22572 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22573 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22574
22575 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22576
22577 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22578 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22579
22580 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22581 @end table
22582
22583 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22584 needed for special purposes only.
22585
22586 @node Maintenance Commands
22587 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22588 @cindex maintenance commands
22589 @cindex internal commands
22590
22591 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22592 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22593 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22594 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22595 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22596
22597 @table @code
22598 @kindex maint agent
22599 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22600 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22601 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22602 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22603
22604 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22605 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22606 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22607 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22608 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22609 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22610 is shown:
22611
22612 @table @code
22613 @item breakpoint
22614 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22615
22616 @item watchpoint
22617 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22618
22619 @item longjmp
22620 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22621 @code{longjmp} calls.
22622
22623 @item longjmp resume
22624 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22625
22626 @item until
22627 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22628
22629 @item finish
22630 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22631
22632 @item shlib events
22633 Shared library events.
22634
22635 @end table
22636
22637 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22638 @item maint check-symtabs
22639 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22640
22641 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22642 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22643 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22644
22645 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22646 @item maint cplus namespace
22647 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22648
22649 @kindex maint demangle
22650 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22651 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
22652
22653 @kindex maint deprecate
22654 @kindex maint undeprecate
22655 @cindex deprecated commands
22656 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22657 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22658 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22659 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22660 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22661 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22662 the replacement as part of the warning.
22663
22664 @kindex maint dump-me
22665 @item maint dump-me
22666 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22667 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22668 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22669 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22670
22671 @kindex maint internal-error
22672 @kindex maint internal-warning
22673 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22674 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22675 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22676 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22677 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22678 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22679 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22680 @value{GDBN} session.
22681
22682 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22683 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22684
22685 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
22686
22687 @smallexample
22688 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22689 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22690 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22691 debugging may prove unreliable.
22692 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22693 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22694 (@value{GDBP})
22695 @end smallexample
22696
22697 @kindex maint packet
22698 @item maint packet @var{text}
22699 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22700 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22701 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22702 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22703 checksum.
22704
22705 @kindex maint print architecture
22706 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22707 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22708 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22709
22710 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
22711 @item maint print c-tdesc
22712 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
22713 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
22714 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
22715
22716 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22717 @item maint print dummy-frames
22718 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22719
22720 @smallexample
22721 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22722 @dots{}
22723 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22724 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22725 58 return (a + b);
22726 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22727 @dots{}
22728 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22729 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22730 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22731 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22732 (@value{GDBP})
22733 @end smallexample
22734
22735 Takes an optional file parameter.
22736
22737 @kindex maint print registers
22738 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22739 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22740 @kindex maint print register-groups
22741 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22742 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22743 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22744 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22745 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22746
22747 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22748 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22749 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22750 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22751 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22752 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22753
22754 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22755 write the information.
22756
22757 @kindex maint print reggroups
22758 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22759 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22760 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22761 information.
22762
22763 The register groups info looks like this:
22764
22765 @smallexample
22766 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22767 Group Type
22768 general user
22769 float user
22770 all user
22771 vector user
22772 system user
22773 save internal
22774 restore internal
22775 @end smallexample
22776
22777 @kindex flushregs
22778 @item flushregs
22779 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22780
22781 @kindex maint print objfiles
22782 @cindex info for known object files
22783 @item maint print objfiles
22784 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22785 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22786 and symtabs.
22787
22788 @kindex maint print statistics
22789 @cindex bcache statistics
22790 @item maint print statistics
22791 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22792 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22793 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22794 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22795 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22796 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22797 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22798 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22799 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22800 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22801 lengths.
22802
22803 @kindex maint print target-stack
22804 @cindex target stack description
22805 @item maint print target-stack
22806 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
22807 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
22808 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
22809 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
22810 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
22811 address.
22812
22813 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
22814 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
22815
22816 @kindex maint print type
22817 @cindex type chain of a data type
22818 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22819 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22820 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22821 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22822 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22823 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22824
22825 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22826 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22827 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22828 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22829 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22830
22831 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22832 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22833 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22834 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22835 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22836 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22837 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22838 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22839 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22840
22841 @kindex maint set profile
22842 @kindex maint show profile
22843 @cindex profiling GDB
22844 @item maint set profile
22845 @itemx maint show profile
22846 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22847
22848 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22849 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22850 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22851 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22852 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22853 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22854 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22855
22856 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22857 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22858
22859 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22860 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22861 @item maint show-debug-regs
22862 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22863 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22864 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
22865 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22866 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22867
22868 @kindex maint space
22869 @cindex memory used by commands
22870 @item maint space
22871 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22872 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22873 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22874 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22875 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22876
22877 @kindex maint time
22878 @cindex time of command execution
22879 @item maint time
22880 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22881 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22882 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22883 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22884 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22885
22886 @kindex maint translate-address
22887 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22888 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22889 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22890 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22891 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22892 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22893 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22894
22895 @end table
22896
22897 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22898 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22899
22900 @table @code
22901 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22902 @kindex set watchdog
22903 @cindex watchdog timer
22904 @cindex timeout for commands
22905 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22906 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22907 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22908
22909 @item show watchdog
22910 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22911 @end table
22912
22913 @node Remote Protocol
22914 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22915
22916 @menu
22917 * Overview::
22918 * Packets::
22919 * Stop Reply Packets::
22920 * General Query Packets::
22921 * Register Packet Format::
22922 * Tracepoint Packets::
22923 * Interrupts::
22924 * Examples::
22925 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
22926 * Library List Format::
22927 * Memory Map Format::
22928 @end menu
22929
22930 @node Overview
22931 @section Overview
22932
22933 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22934 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22935 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22936 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22937
22938 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22939 transmitted and received data, respectively.
22940
22941 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22942 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22943 @cindex remote serial protocol
22944 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22945 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22946 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22947 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22948
22949 @smallexample
22950 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22951 @end smallexample
22952 @noindent
22953
22954 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22955 @noindent
22956 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22957 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22958 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22959
22960 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22961 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22962
22963 @smallexample
22964 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22965 @end smallexample
22966
22967 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22968 @noindent
22969 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22970 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22971 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22972
22973 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22974 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22975 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22976 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22977 retransmission):
22978
22979 @smallexample
22980 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22981 <- @code{+}
22982 @end smallexample
22983 @noindent
22984
22985 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22986 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22987 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22988 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22989
22990 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22991 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22992 exceptions).
22993
22994 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22995 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22996 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22997 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22998
22999 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
23000 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
23001 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
23002
23003 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
23004 @anchor{Binary Data}
23005 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
23006 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
23007 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
23008 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
23009 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
23010 binary data.
23011
23012 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
23013 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
23014 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
23015 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
23016 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
23017 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
23018 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
23019 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
23020 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
23021 (described next).
23022
23023 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
23024 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
23025 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
23026 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
23027 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
23028 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
23029 value greater than 126 should not be used.
23030
23031 So:
23032 @smallexample
23033 "@code{0* }"
23034 @end smallexample
23035 @noindent
23036 means the same as "0000".
23037
23038 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23039 error number. That number is not well defined.
23040
23041 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23042 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23043 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23044 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23045 on that response.
23046
23047 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23048 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23049 optional.
23050
23051 @node Packets
23052 @section Packets
23053
23054 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23055 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23056 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
23057 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23058
23059 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23060 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23061 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23062 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23063 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23064 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23065 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23066 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
23067 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23068 @var{baz}.
23069
23070 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23071 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23072
23073 Here are the packet descriptions.
23074
23075 @table @samp
23076
23077 @item !
23078 @cindex @samp{!} packet
23079 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23080 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23081 debugged.
23082
23083 Reply:
23084 @table @samp
23085 @item OK
23086 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23087 @end table
23088
23089 @item ?
23090 @cindex @samp{?} packet
23091 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23092 step and continue.
23093
23094 Reply:
23095 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23096
23097 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23098 @cindex @samp{A} packet
23099 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23100 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23101 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23102
23103 Reply:
23104 @table @samp
23105 @item OK
23106 The arguments were set.
23107 @item E @var{NN}
23108 An error occurred.
23109 @end table
23110
23111 @item b @var{baud}
23112 @cindex @samp{b} packet
23113 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23114 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23115
23116 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23117 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23118 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23119
23120 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23121 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23122 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23123 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23124 of view, nothing actually happened.}
23125
23126 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23127 @cindex @samp{B} packet
23128 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23129 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23130
23131 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23132 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23133
23134 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23135 @cindex @samp{c} packet
23136 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23137 resume at current address.
23138
23139 Reply:
23140 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23141
23142 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23143 @cindex @samp{C} packet
23144 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23145 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23146
23147 Reply:
23148 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23149
23150 @item d
23151 @cindex @samp{d} packet
23152 Toggle debug flag.
23153
23154 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23155 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23156
23157 @item D
23158 @cindex @samp{D} packet
23159 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23160 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23161
23162 Reply:
23163 @table @samp
23164 @item OK
23165 for success
23166 @item E @var{NN}
23167 for an error
23168 @end table
23169
23170 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23171 @cindex @samp{F} packet
23172 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23173 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23174 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
23175
23176 @item g
23177 @anchor{read registers packet}
23178 @cindex @samp{g} packet
23179 Read general registers.
23180
23181 Reply:
23182 @table @samp
23183 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23184 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23185 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23186 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23187 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
23188 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
23189 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23190 @item E @var{NN}
23191 for an error.
23192 @end table
23193
23194 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23195 @cindex @samp{G} packet
23196 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23197 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23198
23199 Reply:
23200 @table @samp
23201 @item OK
23202 for success
23203 @item E @var{NN}
23204 for an error
23205 @end table
23206
23207 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23208 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23209 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23210 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23211 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23212 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23213 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23214
23215 Reply:
23216 @table @samp
23217 @item OK
23218 for success
23219 @item E @var{NN}
23220 for an error
23221 @end table
23222
23223 @c FIXME: JTC:
23224 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23225 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23226 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23227 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23228 @c described. For example:
23229 @c
23230 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23231 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23232 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23233 @c
23234 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23235 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23236 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23237
23238 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23239 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23240 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23241 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23242 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23243 step starting at that address.
23244
23245 @item I
23246 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23247 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23248 step packet}.
23249
23250 @item k
23251 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23252 Kill request.
23253
23254 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23255 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23256 thread?)}.
23257
23258 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23259 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23260 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23261 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23262
23263 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23264 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23265 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23266 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23267 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23268 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23269 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23270 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23271
23272 Reply:
23273 @table @samp
23274 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23275 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23276 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23277 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23278 @item E @var{NN}
23279 @var{NN} is errno
23280 @end table
23281
23282 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23283 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23284 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23285 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23286 hexadecimal number.
23287
23288 Reply:
23289 @table @samp
23290 @item OK
23291 for success
23292 @item E @var{NN}
23293 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23294 written).
23295 @end table
23296
23297 @item p @var{n}
23298 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23299 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23300 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23301 register value is encoded.
23302
23303 Reply:
23304 @table @samp
23305 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23306 the register's value
23307 @item E @var{NN}
23308 for an error
23309 @item
23310 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23311 @end table
23312
23313 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23314 @anchor{write register packet}
23315 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23316 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23317 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23318 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23319
23320 Reply:
23321 @table @samp
23322 @item OK
23323 for success
23324 @item E @var{NN}
23325 for an error
23326 @end table
23327
23328 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23329 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23330 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23331 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23332 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23333 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23334
23335 @item r
23336 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23337 Reset the entire system.
23338
23339 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23340
23341 @item R @var{XX}
23342 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23343 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23344 This packet is only available in extended mode.
23345
23346 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23347
23348 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23349 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23350 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23351 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23352
23353 Reply:
23354 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23355
23356 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23357 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23358 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23359 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23360 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23361
23362 Reply:
23363 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23364
23365 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23366 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23367 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23368 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23369 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23370
23371 @item T @var{XX}
23372 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23373 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23374
23375 Reply:
23376 @table @samp
23377 @item OK
23378 thread is still alive
23379 @item E @var{NN}
23380 thread is dead
23381 @end table
23382
23383 @item v
23384 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23385 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23386
23387 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23388 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23389 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23390 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23391 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23392 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23393 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23394 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23395
23396 @table @samp
23397 @item c
23398 Continue.
23399 @item C @var{sig}
23400 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23401 @item s
23402 Step.
23403 @item S @var{sig}
23404 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23405 @end table
23406
23407 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23408 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23409
23410 Reply:
23411 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23412
23413 @item vCont?
23414 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23415 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23416
23417 Reply:
23418 @table @samp
23419 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23420 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23421 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23422 @item
23423 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23424 @end table
23425
23426 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23427 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23428 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23429 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23430 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23431 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
23432 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23433 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23434 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23435 packet is received.
23436
23437 Reply:
23438 @table @samp
23439 @item OK
23440 for success
23441 @item E @var{NN}
23442 for an error
23443 @end table
23444
23445 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23446 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23447 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23448 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23449 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23450 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23451 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23452 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23453 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23454 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23455 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23456 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23457
23458
23459 Reply:
23460 @table @samp
23461 @item OK
23462 for success
23463 @item E.memtype
23464 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23465 @item E @var{NN}
23466 for an error
23467 @end table
23468
23469 @item vFlashDone
23470 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23471 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23472 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23473 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23474 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23475 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23476 request is completed.
23477
23478 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23479 @anchor{X packet}
23480 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23481 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23482 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23483 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23484
23485 Reply:
23486 @table @samp
23487 @item OK
23488 for success
23489 @item E @var{NN}
23490 for an error
23491 @end table
23492
23493 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23494 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23495 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23496 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23497 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23498 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23499 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23500 @var{length} bytes.
23501
23502 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23503 separately.
23504
23505 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23506 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23507 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23508 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23509 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23510 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23511
23512 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23513 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23514 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23515 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23516 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23517 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23518
23519 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23520 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23521 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23522 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23523 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23524
23525 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23526 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23527 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23528 target, is not defined.}
23529
23530 Reply:
23531 @table @samp
23532 @item OK
23533 success
23534 @item
23535 not supported
23536 @item E @var{NN}
23537 for an error
23538 @end table
23539
23540 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23541 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23542 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23543 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23544 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23545 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23546
23547 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23548 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23549
23550 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23551 movement.}
23552
23553 Reply:
23554 @table @samp
23555 @item OK
23556 success
23557 @item
23558 not supported
23559 @item E @var{NN}
23560 for an error
23561 @end table
23562
23563 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23564 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23565 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23566 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23567 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23568
23569 Reply:
23570 @table @samp
23571 @item OK
23572 success
23573 @item
23574 not supported
23575 @item E @var{NN}
23576 for an error
23577 @end table
23578
23579 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23580 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23581 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23582 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23583 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23584
23585 Reply:
23586 @table @samp
23587 @item OK
23588 success
23589 @item
23590 not supported
23591 @item E @var{NN}
23592 for an error
23593 @end table
23594
23595 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23596 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23597 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23598 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23599 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23600
23601 Reply:
23602 @table @samp
23603 @item OK
23604 success
23605 @item
23606 not supported
23607 @item E @var{NN}
23608 for an error
23609 @end table
23610
23611 @end table
23612
23613 @node Stop Reply Packets
23614 @section Stop Reply Packets
23615 @cindex stop reply packets
23616
23617 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23618 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23619 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23620 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23621 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23622 @value{GDBN} source code.
23623
23624 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23625 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23626 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23627 components.
23628
23629 @table @samp
23630
23631 @item S @var{AA}
23632 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23633 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23634 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23635
23636 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23637 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23638 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23639 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23640 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23641 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23642 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23643 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23644
23645 @itemize @bullet
23646 @item
23647 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23648 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23649 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23650 two-digit hex number.
23651
23652 @item
23653 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23654 hex.
23655
23656 @item
23657 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
23658 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
23659 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
23660 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
23661
23662 @item
23663 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23664 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23665 future.
23666 @end itemize
23667
23668 The currently defined stop reasons are:
23669
23670 @table @samp
23671 @item watch
23672 @itemx rwatch
23673 @itemx awatch
23674 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23675 hex.
23676
23677 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
23678 @item library
23679 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
23680 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
23681 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
23682 @end table
23683
23684 @item W @var{AA}
23685 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23686 applicable to certain targets.
23687
23688 @item X @var{AA}
23689 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23690
23691 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23692 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23693 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23694 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23695 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23696
23697 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23698 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23699 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23700 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23701 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
23702 system calls.
23703
23704 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23705 this very system call.
23706
23707 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23708 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23709 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23710 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23711 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
23712 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
23713
23714 @end table
23715
23716 @node General Query Packets
23717 @section General Query Packets
23718 @cindex remote query requests
23719
23720 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23721 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23722 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23723 sending information to and from the stub.
23724
23725 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23726 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23727 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23728 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23729 conventions:
23730
23731 @itemize @bullet
23732 @item
23733 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23734 @item
23735 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23736 letter.
23737 @item
23738 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23739 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23740 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23741 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23742 @end itemize
23743
23744 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23745 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23746 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23747 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23748 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23749 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23750 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23751 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23752 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23753 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23754 packet.}.
23755
23756 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23757 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23758 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23759 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23760 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23761
23762 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23763
23764 @table @samp
23765
23766 @item qC
23767 @cindex current thread, remote request
23768 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23769 Return the current thread id.
23770
23771 Reply:
23772 @table @samp
23773 @item QC @var{pid}
23774 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23775 @item @r{(anything else)}
23776 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23777 @end table
23778
23779 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23780 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23781 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23782 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23783 Reply:
23784 @table @samp
23785 @item E @var{NN}
23786 An error (such as memory fault)
23787 @item C @var{crc32}
23788 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23789 @end table
23790
23791 @item qfThreadInfo
23792 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23793 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23794 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23795 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23796 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23797 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23798 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23799 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23800 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23801 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23802
23803 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23804
23805 Reply:
23806 @table @samp
23807 @item m @var{id}
23808 A single thread id
23809 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23810 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23811 @item l
23812 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23813 @end table
23814
23815 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23816 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23817 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23818 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23819 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23820
23821 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23822 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23823 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23824 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23825 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23826
23827 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23828 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23829
23830 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23831 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23832 information associated with the variable.)
23833
23834 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
23835 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23836 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23837 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23838 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23839 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23840
23841 Reply:
23842 @table @samp
23843 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23844 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23845 local storage requested.
23846
23847 @item E @var{nn}
23848 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23849
23850 @item
23851 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23852 @end table
23853
23854 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23855 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23856 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23857 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23858 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23859 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23860 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23861
23862 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23863
23864 Reply:
23865 @table @samp
23866 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23867 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23868 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23869 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23870 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23871 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23872 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23873 @end table
23874
23875 @item qOffsets
23876 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23877 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23878 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
23879 image.
23880
23881 Reply:
23882 @table @samp
23883 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
23884 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
23885 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
23886 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
23887 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
23888 segments by the supplied offsets.
23889
23890 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
23891 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
23892 to the @code{Bss} section.}
23893
23894 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
23895 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
23896 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
23897 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
23898 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
23899 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
23900 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
23901 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
23902 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
23903 @end table
23904
23905 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23906 @cindex thread information, remote request
23907 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23908 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23909 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23910
23911 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23912 (see below).
23913
23914 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23915
23916 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
23917 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
23918 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23919 @anchor{QPassSignals}
23920 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
23921 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
23922 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
23923 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
23924 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
23925 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
23926 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
23927 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
23928 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
23929
23930 Reply:
23931 @table @samp
23932 @item OK
23933 The request succeeded.
23934
23935 @item E @var{nn}
23936 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23937
23938 @item
23939 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
23940 the stub.
23941 @end table
23942
23943 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
23944 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
23945 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23946 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23947
23948 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23949 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23950 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23951 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23952 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23953 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23954 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23955 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23956 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23957
23958 Reply:
23959 @table @samp
23960 @item OK
23961 A command response with no output.
23962 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23963 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23964 @item E @var{NN}
23965 Indicate a badly formed request.
23966 @item
23967 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23968 @end table
23969
23970 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23971 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23972 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23973 packets.)
23974
23975 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23976 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23977 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23978 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23979 @anchor{qSupported}
23980 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23981 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23982 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23983 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23984 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23985 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23986 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23987 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23988 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23989 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23990 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23991 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23992 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23993 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23994
23995 Reply:
23996 @table @samp
23997 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23998 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23999 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
24000 possible forms).
24001 @item
24002 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
24003 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
24004 @end table
24005
24006 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
24007 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
24008 are:
24009
24010 @table @samp
24011 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
24012 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
24013 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
24014 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
24015 @item @var{name}+
24016 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
24017 need an associated value.
24018 @item @var{name}-
24019 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
24020 @item @var{name}?
24021 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
24022 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
24023 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
24024 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
24025 @end table
24026
24027 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
24028 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
24029 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
24030 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
24031 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
24032
24033 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
24034 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
24035 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
24036 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
24037 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
24038 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
24039 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
24040 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
24041 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
24042 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
24043 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
24044 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
24045 all the features it supports.
24046
24047 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
24048 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
24049
24050 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
24051 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
24052 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
24053 form response.
24054
24055 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
24056 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
24057 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
24058 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
24059
24060 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
24061 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
24062 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
24063 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
24064 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
24065
24066 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24067
24068 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
24069 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24070 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24071 @item Feature Name
24072 @tab Value Required
24073 @tab Default
24074 @tab Probe Allowed
24075
24076 @item @samp{PacketSize}
24077 @tab Yes
24078 @tab @samp{-}
24079 @tab No
24080
24081 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24082 @tab No
24083 @tab @samp{-}
24084 @tab Yes
24085
24086 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
24087 @tab No
24088 @tab @samp{-}
24089 @tab Yes
24090
24091 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
24092 @tab No
24093 @tab @samp{-}
24094 @tab Yes
24095
24096 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
24097 @tab No
24098 @tab @samp{-}
24099 @tab Yes
24100
24101 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
24102 @tab No
24103 @tab @samp{-}
24104 @tab Yes
24105
24106 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
24107 @tab No
24108 @tab @samp{-}
24109 @tab Yes
24110
24111 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
24112 @tab No
24113 @tab @samp{-}
24114 @tab Yes
24115
24116 @end multitable
24117
24118 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24119
24120 @table @samp
24121 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
24122 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24123 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24124 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24125 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24126 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24127 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24128 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24129 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24130 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24131
24132 @item qXfer:auxv:read
24133 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24134 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24135
24136 @item qXfer:features:read
24137 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24138 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24139
24140 @item qXfer:libraries:read
24141 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
24142 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
24143
24144 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
24145 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24146 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24147
24148 @item qXfer:spu:read
24149 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
24150 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
24151
24152 @item qXfer:spu:write
24153 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
24154 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
24155
24156 @item QPassSignals
24157 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24158 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24159
24160 @end table
24161
24162 @item qSymbol::
24163 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24164 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24165 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24166 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24167
24168 Reply:
24169 @table @samp
24170 @item OK
24171 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24172 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24173 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24174 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24175 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24176 below.
24177 @end table
24178
24179 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24180 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24181
24182 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24183 target has previously requested.
24184
24185 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24186 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24187 will be empty.
24188
24189 Reply:
24190 @table @samp
24191 @item OK
24192 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24193 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24194 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24195 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24196 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24197 @end table
24198
24199 @item QTDP
24200 @itemx QTFrame
24201 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24202
24203 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24204 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24205 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24206 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24207 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24208 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24209 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24210 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24211 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24212 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24213
24214 Reply:
24215 @table @samp
24216 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24217 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24218 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24219 the thread's attributes.
24220 @end table
24221
24222 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24223 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24224 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24225 packets.)
24226
24227 @item QTStart
24228 @itemx QTStop
24229 @itemx QTinit
24230 @itemx QTro
24231 @itemx qTStatus
24232 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24233
24234 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24235 @cindex read special object, remote request
24236 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24237 @anchor{qXfer read}
24238 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24239 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24240 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
24241 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
24242 additional details about what data to access.
24243
24244 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24245 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24246 formats, listed below.
24247
24248 @table @samp
24249 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24250 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
24251 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
24252 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
24253
24254 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24255 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24256
24257 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24258 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
24259 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
24260 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
24261 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
24262
24263 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24264 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24265
24266 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24267 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
24268 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
24269 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24270 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24271
24272 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
24273 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
24274 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
24275
24276 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24277 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24278
24279 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24280 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
24281 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
24282 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24283 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24284
24285 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24286 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24287
24288 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24289 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
24290 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24291 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
24292 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24293 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24294 in that context to be accessed.
24295
24296 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24297 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24298 @end table
24299
24300 Reply:
24301 @table @samp
24302 @item m @var{data}
24303 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
24304 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
24305 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
24306 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
24307 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
24308 request.
24309
24310 @item l @var{data}
24311 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24312 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24313 than the @var{length} in the request.
24314
24315 @item l
24316 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24317 There is no more data to be read.
24318
24319 @item E00
24320 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24321
24322 @item E @var{nn}
24323 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24324 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24325
24326 @item
24327 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24328 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24329 @end table
24330
24331 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24332 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24333 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24334 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24335 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
24336 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24337 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
24338 to access.
24339
24340 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24341 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24342 formats, listed below.
24343
24344 @table @samp
24345 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24346 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
24347 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24348 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
24349 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24350 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24351 in that context to be accessed.
24352
24353 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24354 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24355 @end table
24356
24357 Reply:
24358 @table @samp
24359 @item @var{nn}
24360 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24361 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24362
24363 @item E00
24364 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24365
24366 @item E @var{nn}
24367 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24368 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24369
24370 @item
24371 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24372 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24373 @end table
24374
24375 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24376 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24377 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24378 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24379 must respond with an empty packet.
24380
24381 @end table
24382
24383 @node Register Packet Format
24384 @section Register Packet Format
24385
24386 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24387 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24388 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24389 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24390 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24391 most-significant - least-significant.
24392
24393 @table @r
24394
24395 @item MIPS32
24396
24397 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24398 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24399 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24400
24401 @item MIPS64
24402
24403 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24404 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24405 as @code{MIPS32}.
24406
24407 @end table
24408
24409 @node Tracepoint Packets
24410 @section Tracepoint Packets
24411 @cindex tracepoint packets
24412 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24413
24414 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24415 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24416
24417 @table @samp
24418
24419 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24420 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24421 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24422 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24423 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24424 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24425 tracepoint's actions.
24426
24427 Replies:
24428 @table @samp
24429 @item OK
24430 The packet was understood and carried out.
24431 @item
24432 The packet was not recognized.
24433 @end table
24434
24435 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24436 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24437 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24438 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24439 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24440 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24441 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24442
24443 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24444 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24445 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24446 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24447 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24448 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24449 tracepoint actions.
24450
24451 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24452 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24453 following forms:
24454
24455 @table @samp
24456
24457 @item R @var{mask}
24458 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24459 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24460 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24461 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24462 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24463
24464 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24465 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24466 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24467 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24468 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24469 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24470 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24471
24472 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24473 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24474 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24475 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24476 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24477 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24478 packet).
24479
24480 @end table
24481
24482 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24483 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24484 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24485 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24486 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24487 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24488 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24489 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24490
24491 Replies:
24492 @table @samp
24493 @item OK
24494 The packet was understood and carried out.
24495 @item
24496 The packet was not recognized.
24497 @end table
24498
24499 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24500 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24501 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24502 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24503
24504 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24505 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24506 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24507 one of the following forms:
24508
24509 @table @samp
24510 @item F @var{f}
24511 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24512 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24513 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24514
24515 @item T @var{t}
24516 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24517 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24518
24519 @end table
24520
24521 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24522 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24523 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24524 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24525
24526 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24527 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24528 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24529 is a hexadecimal number.
24530
24531 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24532 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24533 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24534 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24535 numbers.
24536
24537 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24538 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24539 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24540
24541 @item QTStart
24542 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24543 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24544
24545 @item QTStop
24546 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24547
24548 @item QTinit
24549 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24550
24551 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24552 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24553 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24554 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24555
24556 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24557 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24558 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24559 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24560
24561 @item qTStatus
24562 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24563
24564 Replies:
24565 @table @samp
24566 @item T0
24567 There is no trace experiment running.
24568 @item T1
24569 There is a trace experiment running.
24570 @end table
24571
24572 @end table
24573
24574
24575 @node Interrupts
24576 @section Interrupts
24577 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24578
24579 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24580 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24581 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24582 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24583
24584 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24585 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24586 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24587 interfaces.
24588
24589 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24590 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24591 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24592 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24593 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24594 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24595 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24596 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24597
24598 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24599 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24600 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24601 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24602 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24603 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24604 program is stopped will be discarded.
24605
24606 @node Examples
24607 @section Examples
24608
24609 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24610 does not get any direct output:
24611
24612 @smallexample
24613 -> @code{R00}
24614 <- @code{+}
24615 @emph{target restarts}
24616 -> @code{?}
24617 <- @code{+}
24618 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24619 -> @code{+}
24620 @end smallexample
24621
24622 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24623
24624 @smallexample
24625 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24626 <- @code{+}
24627 -> @code{s}
24628 <- @code{+}
24629 @emph{time passes}
24630 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24631 -> @code{+}
24632 -> @code{g}
24633 <- @code{+}
24634 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24635 -> @code{+}
24636 @end smallexample
24637
24638 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24639 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24640 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24641
24642 @menu
24643 * File-I/O Overview::
24644 * Protocol Basics::
24645 * The F Request Packet::
24646 * The F Reply Packet::
24647 * The Ctrl-C Message::
24648 * Console I/O::
24649 * List of Supported Calls::
24650 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
24651 * Constants::
24652 * File-I/O Examples::
24653 @end menu
24654
24655 @node File-I/O Overview
24656 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24657 @cindex file-i/o overview
24658
24659 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24660 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24661 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24662 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24663 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24664 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24665
24666 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24667 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24668 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24669 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24670 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24671
24672 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24673 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24674 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24675 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24676 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24677 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24678 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24679
24680 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24681 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24682 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24683 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24684 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24685
24686 @smallexample
24687 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24688 <- target requests 'system call X'
24689 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24690 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
24691 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
24692 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24693 @end smallexample
24694
24695 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24696 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24697 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24698 system are not supported by this protocol.
24699
24700 @node Protocol Basics
24701 @subsection Protocol Basics
24702 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24703
24704 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24705 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24706 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24707 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24708 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24709 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24710 to call the appropriate host system call:
24711
24712 @itemize @bullet
24713 @item
24714 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24715
24716 @item
24717 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24718 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24719 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24720 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
24721
24722 @end itemize
24723
24724 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24725
24726 @itemize @bullet
24727 @item
24728 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24729 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24730 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24731 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24732 packet.
24733
24734 @item
24735 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24736 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24737
24738 @item
24739 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24740
24741 @item
24742 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24743
24744 @item
24745 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24746 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24747 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24748 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24749 packet.
24750
24751 @end itemize
24752
24753 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24754 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24755
24756 @itemize @bullet
24757 @item
24758 Return value.
24759
24760 @item
24761 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24762
24763 @item
24764 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24765
24766 @end itemize
24767
24768 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24769 the latest continue or step action.
24770
24771 @node The F Request Packet
24772 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
24773 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24774 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24775
24776 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24777
24778 @table @samp
24779 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24780
24781 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24782 This is just the name of the function.
24783
24784 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24785 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24786 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24787 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24788 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24789 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24790 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24791
24792 @end table
24793
24794
24795
24796 @node The F Reply Packet
24797 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
24798 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24799 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24800
24801 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24802
24803 @table @samp
24804
24805 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
24806
24807 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24808
24809 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
24810 representation.
24811 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24812
24813 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24814 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24815 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24816
24817 @smallexample
24818 F0,0,C
24819 @end smallexample
24820
24821 @noindent
24822 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24823
24824 @smallexample
24825 F-1,4,C
24826 @end smallexample
24827
24828 @noindent
24829 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24830
24831 @end table
24832
24833
24834 @node The Ctrl-C Message
24835 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
24836 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24837
24838 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24839 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
24840 the target should behave as if it had
24841 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24842 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24843 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24844 packet.
24845
24846 It's important for the target to know in which
24847 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24848
24849 @itemize @bullet
24850 @item
24851 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24852
24853 @item
24854 The system call on the host has been finished.
24855
24856 @end itemize
24857
24858 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24859 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24860 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24861 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24862 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24863 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24864
24865 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24866 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24867 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24868 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24869 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24870 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24871 or the full action has been completed.
24872
24873 @node Console I/O
24874 @subsection Console I/O
24875 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24876
24877 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
24878 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24879 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24880 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24881 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24882 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24883 conditions is met:
24884
24885 @itemize @bullet
24886 @item
24887 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24888 @code{read}
24889 system call is treated as finished.
24890
24891 @item
24892 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24893 newline.
24894
24895 @item
24896 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24897 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
24898
24899 @end itemize
24900
24901 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24902 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24903 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24904 is stopped at the user's request.
24905
24906
24907 @node List of Supported Calls
24908 @subsection List of Supported Calls
24909 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24910
24911 @menu
24912 * open::
24913 * close::
24914 * read::
24915 * write::
24916 * lseek::
24917 * rename::
24918 * unlink::
24919 * stat/fstat::
24920 * gettimeofday::
24921 * isatty::
24922 * system::
24923 @end menu
24924
24925 @node open
24926 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24927 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24928
24929 @table @asis
24930 @item Synopsis:
24931 @smallexample
24932 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24933 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24934 @end smallexample
24935
24936 @item Request:
24937 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24938
24939 @noindent
24940 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24941
24942 @table @code
24943 @item O_CREAT
24944 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24945 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24946 are concerned.
24947
24948 @item O_EXCL
24949 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24950 an error and open() fails.
24951
24952 @item O_TRUNC
24953 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24954 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24955 truncated to zero length.
24956
24957 @item O_APPEND
24958 The file is opened in append mode.
24959
24960 @item O_RDONLY
24961 The file is opened for reading only.
24962
24963 @item O_WRONLY
24964 The file is opened for writing only.
24965
24966 @item O_RDWR
24967 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24968 @end table
24969
24970 @noindent
24971 Other bits are silently ignored.
24972
24973
24974 @noindent
24975 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24976
24977 @table @code
24978 @item S_IRUSR
24979 User has read permission.
24980
24981 @item S_IWUSR
24982 User has write permission.
24983
24984 @item S_IRGRP
24985 Group has read permission.
24986
24987 @item S_IWGRP
24988 Group has write permission.
24989
24990 @item S_IROTH
24991 Others have read permission.
24992
24993 @item S_IWOTH
24994 Others have write permission.
24995 @end table
24996
24997 @noindent
24998 Other bits are silently ignored.
24999
25000
25001 @item Return value:
25002 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
25003 occurred.
25004
25005 @item Errors:
25006
25007 @table @code
25008 @item EEXIST
25009 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
25010
25011 @item EISDIR
25012 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
25013
25014 @item EACCES
25015 The requested access is not allowed.
25016
25017 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25018 @var{pathname} was too long.
25019
25020 @item ENOENT
25021 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25022
25023 @item ENODEV
25024 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
25025
25026 @item EROFS
25027 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
25028 write access was requested.
25029
25030 @item EFAULT
25031 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
25032
25033 @item ENOSPC
25034 No space on device to create the file.
25035
25036 @item EMFILE
25037 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
25038
25039 @item ENFILE
25040 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
25041 has been reached.
25042
25043 @item EINTR
25044 The call was interrupted by the user.
25045 @end table
25046
25047 @end table
25048
25049 @node close
25050 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
25051 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
25052
25053 @table @asis
25054 @item Synopsis:
25055 @smallexample
25056 int close(int fd);
25057 @end smallexample
25058
25059 @item Request:
25060 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
25061
25062 @item Return value:
25063 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
25064
25065 @item Errors:
25066
25067 @table @code
25068 @item EBADF
25069 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
25070
25071 @item EINTR
25072 The call was interrupted by the user.
25073 @end table
25074
25075 @end table
25076
25077 @node read
25078 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
25079 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
25080
25081 @table @asis
25082 @item Synopsis:
25083 @smallexample
25084 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
25085 @end smallexample
25086
25087 @item Request:
25088 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25089
25090 @item Return value:
25091 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
25092 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
25093 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
25094
25095 @item Errors:
25096
25097 @table @code
25098 @item EBADF
25099 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25100 reading.
25101
25102 @item EFAULT
25103 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25104
25105 @item EINTR
25106 The call was interrupted by the user.
25107 @end table
25108
25109 @end table
25110
25111 @node write
25112 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
25113 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
25114
25115 @table @asis
25116 @item Synopsis:
25117 @smallexample
25118 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
25119 @end smallexample
25120
25121 @item Request:
25122 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25123
25124 @item Return value:
25125 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
25126 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
25127 is returned.
25128
25129 @item Errors:
25130
25131 @table @code
25132 @item EBADF
25133 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25134 writing.
25135
25136 @item EFAULT
25137 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25138
25139 @item EFBIG
25140 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25141 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
25142
25143 @item ENOSPC
25144 No space on device to write the data.
25145
25146 @item EINTR
25147 The call was interrupted by the user.
25148 @end table
25149
25150 @end table
25151
25152 @node lseek
25153 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
25154 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
25155
25156 @table @asis
25157 @item Synopsis:
25158 @smallexample
25159 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
25160 @end smallexample
25161
25162 @item Request:
25163 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
25164
25165 @var{flag} is one of:
25166
25167 @table @code
25168 @item SEEK_SET
25169 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
25170
25171 @item SEEK_CUR
25172 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
25173 bytes.
25174
25175 @item SEEK_END
25176 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
25177 bytes.
25178 @end table
25179
25180 @item Return value:
25181 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
25182 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
25183 value of -1 is returned.
25184
25185 @item Errors:
25186
25187 @table @code
25188 @item EBADF
25189 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
25190
25191 @item ESPIPE
25192 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
25193
25194 @item EINVAL
25195 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
25196
25197 @item EINTR
25198 The call was interrupted by the user.
25199 @end table
25200
25201 @end table
25202
25203 @node rename
25204 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
25205 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
25206
25207 @table @asis
25208 @item Synopsis:
25209 @smallexample
25210 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
25211 @end smallexample
25212
25213 @item Request:
25214 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
25215
25216 @item Return value:
25217 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25218
25219 @item Errors:
25220
25221 @table @code
25222 @item EISDIR
25223 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
25224 directory.
25225
25226 @item EEXIST
25227 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
25228
25229 @item EBUSY
25230 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
25231 process.
25232
25233 @item EINVAL
25234 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
25235 of itself.
25236
25237 @item ENOTDIR
25238 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
25239 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
25240 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
25241
25242 @item EFAULT
25243 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
25244
25245 @item EACCES
25246 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25247
25248 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25249
25250 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
25251
25252 @item ENOENT
25253 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
25254
25255 @item EROFS
25256 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25257
25258 @item ENOSPC
25259 The device containing the file has no room for the new
25260 directory entry.
25261
25262 @item EINTR
25263 The call was interrupted by the user.
25264 @end table
25265
25266 @end table
25267
25268 @node unlink
25269 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
25270 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
25271
25272 @table @asis
25273 @item Synopsis:
25274 @smallexample
25275 int unlink(const char *pathname);
25276 @end smallexample
25277
25278 @item Request:
25279 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
25280
25281 @item Return value:
25282 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25283
25284 @item Errors:
25285
25286 @table @code
25287 @item EACCES
25288 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25289
25290 @item EPERM
25291 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
25292
25293 @item EBUSY
25294 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
25295 being used by another process.
25296
25297 @item EFAULT
25298 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25299
25300 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25301 @var{pathname} was too long.
25302
25303 @item ENOENT
25304 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25305
25306 @item ENOTDIR
25307 A component of the path is not a directory.
25308
25309 @item EROFS
25310 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25311
25312 @item EINTR
25313 The call was interrupted by the user.
25314 @end table
25315
25316 @end table
25317
25318 @node stat/fstat
25319 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
25320 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
25321 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
25322
25323 @table @asis
25324 @item Synopsis:
25325 @smallexample
25326 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
25327 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
25328 @end smallexample
25329
25330 @item Request:
25331 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
25332 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25333
25334 @item Return value:
25335 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25336
25337 @item Errors:
25338
25339 @table @code
25340 @item EBADF
25341 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25342
25343 @item ENOENT
25344 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25345 path is an empty string.
25346
25347 @item ENOTDIR
25348 A component of the path is not a directory.
25349
25350 @item EFAULT
25351 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25352
25353 @item EACCES
25354 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25355
25356 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25357 @var{pathname} was too long.
25358
25359 @item EINTR
25360 The call was interrupted by the user.
25361 @end table
25362
25363 @end table
25364
25365 @node gettimeofday
25366 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25367 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25368
25369 @table @asis
25370 @item Synopsis:
25371 @smallexample
25372 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25373 @end smallexample
25374
25375 @item Request:
25376 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25377
25378 @item Return value:
25379 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25380
25381 @item Errors:
25382
25383 @table @code
25384 @item EINVAL
25385 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25386
25387 @item EFAULT
25388 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25389 @end table
25390
25391 @end table
25392
25393 @node isatty
25394 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25395 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25396
25397 @table @asis
25398 @item Synopsis:
25399 @smallexample
25400 int isatty(int fd);
25401 @end smallexample
25402
25403 @item Request:
25404 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25405
25406 @item Return value:
25407 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25408
25409 @item Errors:
25410
25411 @table @code
25412 @item EINTR
25413 The call was interrupted by the user.
25414 @end table
25415
25416 @end table
25417
25418 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25419 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25420 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25421 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25422 needed.
25423
25424
25425 @node system
25426 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25427 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25428
25429 @table @asis
25430 @item Synopsis:
25431 @smallexample
25432 int system(const char *command);
25433 @end smallexample
25434
25435 @item Request:
25436 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25437
25438 @item Return value:
25439 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25440 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25441 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25442 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25443 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25444 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25445 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25446
25447 @item Errors:
25448
25449 @table @code
25450 @item EINTR
25451 The call was interrupted by the user.
25452 @end table
25453
25454 @end table
25455
25456 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25457 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25458 the host is simplified before it's returned
25459 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25460 is discarded, and the return value consists
25461 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25462
25463 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25464 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25465 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25466
25467 @table @code
25468 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25469 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25470 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25471 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25472
25473 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25474 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25475 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25476 protocol.
25477 @end table
25478
25479 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25480 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25481 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25482
25483 @menu
25484 * Integral Datatypes::
25485 * Pointer Values::
25486 * Memory Transfer::
25487 * struct stat::
25488 * struct timeval::
25489 @end menu
25490
25491 @node Integral Datatypes
25492 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
25493 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25494
25495 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25496 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25497 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25498
25499 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25500 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25501
25502 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25503
25504 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25505 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25506
25507 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25508
25509 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25510 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25511 byte order.
25512
25513 @node Pointer Values
25514 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
25515 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25516
25517 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25518 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25519 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25520 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25521
25522 @smallexample
25523 @code{1aaf/12}
25524 @end smallexample
25525
25526 @noindent
25527 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25528 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25529 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25530 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25531
25532 @smallexample
25533 @code{123456/d}
25534 @end smallexample
25535
25536 @node Memory Transfer
25537 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
25538 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25539
25540 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25541 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
25542 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25543 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25544 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25545 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25546 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25547
25548
25549 @node struct stat
25550 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25551 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25552
25553 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25554 is defined as follows:
25555
25556 @smallexample
25557 struct stat @{
25558 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25559 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25560 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25561 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25562 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25563 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25564 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25565 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25566 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25567 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25568 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25569 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25570 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25571 @};
25572 @end smallexample
25573
25574 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25575 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25576 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25577
25578 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25579 range of values.
25580
25581 @table @code
25582
25583 @item st_dev
25584 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25585
25586 @item st_ino
25587 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25588
25589 @item st_mode
25590 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25591 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25592
25593 @item st_uid
25594 @itemx st_gid
25595 @itemx st_rdev
25596 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25597
25598 @item st_atime
25599 @itemx st_mtime
25600 @itemx st_ctime
25601 These values have a host and file system dependent
25602 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25603 support exact timing values.
25604 @end table
25605
25606 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25607 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25608 continuing.
25609
25610 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25611 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25612 get truncated on the target.
25613
25614 @node struct timeval
25615 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25616 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25617
25618 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25619 is defined as follows:
25620
25621 @smallexample
25622 struct timeval @{
25623 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25624 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25625 @};
25626 @end smallexample
25627
25628 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25629 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25630 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25631
25632 @node Constants
25633 @subsection Constants
25634 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25635
25636 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25637 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25638 values before and after the call as needed.
25639
25640 @menu
25641 * Open Flags::
25642 * mode_t Values::
25643 * Errno Values::
25644 * Lseek Flags::
25645 * Limits::
25646 @end menu
25647
25648 @node Open Flags
25649 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
25650 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25651
25652 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25653
25654 @smallexample
25655 O_RDONLY 0x0
25656 O_WRONLY 0x1
25657 O_RDWR 0x2
25658 O_APPEND 0x8
25659 O_CREAT 0x200
25660 O_TRUNC 0x400
25661 O_EXCL 0x800
25662 @end smallexample
25663
25664 @node mode_t Values
25665 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
25666 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25667
25668 All values are given in octal representation.
25669
25670 @smallexample
25671 S_IFREG 0100000
25672 S_IFDIR 040000
25673 S_IRUSR 0400
25674 S_IWUSR 0200
25675 S_IXUSR 0100
25676 S_IRGRP 040
25677 S_IWGRP 020
25678 S_IXGRP 010
25679 S_IROTH 04
25680 S_IWOTH 02
25681 S_IXOTH 01
25682 @end smallexample
25683
25684 @node Errno Values
25685 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
25686 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25687
25688 All values are given in decimal representation.
25689
25690 @smallexample
25691 EPERM 1
25692 ENOENT 2
25693 EINTR 4
25694 EBADF 9
25695 EACCES 13
25696 EFAULT 14
25697 EBUSY 16
25698 EEXIST 17
25699 ENODEV 19
25700 ENOTDIR 20
25701 EISDIR 21
25702 EINVAL 22
25703 ENFILE 23
25704 EMFILE 24
25705 EFBIG 27
25706 ENOSPC 28
25707 ESPIPE 29
25708 EROFS 30
25709 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25710 EUNKNOWN 9999
25711 @end smallexample
25712
25713 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25714 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25715
25716 @node Lseek Flags
25717 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
25718 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25719
25720 @smallexample
25721 SEEK_SET 0
25722 SEEK_CUR 1
25723 SEEK_END 2
25724 @end smallexample
25725
25726 @node Limits
25727 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25728 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25729
25730 All values are given in decimal representation.
25731
25732 @smallexample
25733 INT_MIN -2147483648
25734 INT_MAX 2147483647
25735 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25736 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25737 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25738 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25739 @end smallexample
25740
25741 @node File-I/O Examples
25742 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25743 @cindex file-i/o examples
25744
25745 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25746 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25747
25748 @smallexample
25749 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25750 @emph{request memory read from target}
25751 -> @code{m1234,6}
25752 <- XXXXXX
25753 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25754 -> @code{F6}
25755 @end smallexample
25756
25757 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25758 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25759
25760 @smallexample
25761 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25762 @emph{request memory write to target}
25763 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25764 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25765 -> @code{F6}
25766 @end smallexample
25767
25768 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25769 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25770
25771 @smallexample
25772 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25773 -> @code{F-1,9}
25774 @end smallexample
25775
25776 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
25777 host is called:
25778
25779 @smallexample
25780 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25781 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25782 <- @code{T02}
25783 @end smallexample
25784
25785 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
25786 host is called:
25787
25788 @smallexample
25789 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25790 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25791 <- @code{T02}
25792 @end smallexample
25793
25794 @node Library List Format
25795 @section Library List Format
25796 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
25797
25798 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
25799 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
25800 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
25801 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
25802 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
25803 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
25804 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
25805 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
25806 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
25807 are loaded.
25808
25809 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
25810 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
25811 associated name and one or more segment base addresses, which report
25812 where the library was loaded in memory. The segment bases are start
25813 addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not depend on the library's
25814 link-time base addresses.
25815
25816 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
25817 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
25818
25819 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
25820 offset, looks like this:
25821
25822 @smallexample
25823 <library-list>
25824 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
25825 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
25826 </library>
25827 </library-list>
25828 @end smallexample
25829
25830 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
25831
25832 @smallexample
25833 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
25834 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
25835 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
25836 <!ELEMENT library (segment)*>
25837 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25838 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
25839 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
25840 @end smallexample
25841
25842 @node Memory Map Format
25843 @section Memory Map Format
25844 @cindex memory map format
25845
25846 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25847 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25848 memory map.
25849
25850 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25851 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25852 lists memory regions.
25853
25854 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
25855 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
25856
25857 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25858
25859 @smallexample
25860 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25861 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
25862 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25863 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25864 <memory-map>
25865 region...
25866 </memory-map>
25867 @end smallexample
25868
25869 Each region can be either:
25870
25871 @itemize
25872
25873 @item
25874 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25875 bytes from there:
25876
25877 @smallexample
25878 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25879 @end smallexample
25880
25881
25882 @item
25883 A region of read-only memory:
25884
25885 @smallexample
25886 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25887 @end smallexample
25888
25889
25890 @item
25891 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25892 bytes in length:
25893
25894 @smallexample
25895 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25896 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25897 </memory>
25898 @end smallexample
25899
25900 @end itemize
25901
25902 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25903 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25904 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25905
25906 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25907
25908 @smallexample
25909 <!-- ................................................... -->
25910 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25911 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25912 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
25913 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25914 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25915 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25916 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25917 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25918 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25919 and its type, or device. -->
25920 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25921 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25922 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25923 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25924 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25925 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25926 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25927 @end smallexample
25928
25929 @include agentexpr.texi
25930
25931 @node Target Descriptions
25932 @appendix Target Descriptions
25933 @cindex target descriptions
25934
25935 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
25936 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
25937 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
25938
25939 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
25940 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
25941 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
25942 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
25943 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
25944 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
25945 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
25946
25947 @itemize @bullet
25948 @item
25949 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
25950 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
25951 @item
25952 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
25953 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
25954 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
25955 @item
25956 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
25957 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
25958 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
25959 @end itemize
25960
25961 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
25962 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
25963 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
25964 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
25965 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
25966
25967 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
25968 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
25969
25970 @menu
25971 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
25972 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
25973 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
25974 descriptions.
25975 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
25976 @end menu
25977
25978 @node Retrieving Descriptions
25979 @section Retrieving Descriptions
25980
25981 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
25982 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
25983 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
25984 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
25985 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
25986 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
25987 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
25988 Format}.
25989
25990 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
25991 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
25992 specify a file are:
25993
25994 @table @code
25995 @cindex set tdesc filename
25996 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
25997 Read the target description from @var{path}.
25998
25999 @cindex unset tdesc filename
26000 @item unset tdesc filename
26001 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
26002 will use the description supplied by the current target.
26003
26004 @cindex show tdesc filename
26005 @item show tdesc filename
26006 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
26007 @end table
26008
26009
26010 @node Target Description Format
26011 @section Target Description Format
26012 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
26013
26014 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
26015 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
26016 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
26017 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
26018 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
26019 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
26020 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
26021
26022 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
26023 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
26024 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
26025 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
26026
26027 Here is a simple target description:
26028
26029 @smallexample
26030 <target version="1.0">
26031 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
26032 </target>
26033 @end smallexample
26034
26035 @noindent
26036 This minimal description only says that the target uses
26037 the x86-64 architecture.
26038
26039 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
26040 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
26041 are explained further below.
26042
26043 @smallexample
26044 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26045 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
26046 <target version="1.0">
26047 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
26048 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
26049 </target>
26050 @end smallexample
26051
26052 @noindent
26053 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
26054 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
26055 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
26056 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
26057 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
26058 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
26059 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
26060 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
26061 the version mismatch.
26062
26063 @subsection Inclusion
26064 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
26065 @cindex XInclude
26066 @ifnotinfo
26067 @cindex <xi:include>
26068 @end ifnotinfo
26069
26070 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
26071 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
26072 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
26073 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
26074 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
26075
26076 @smallexample
26077 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
26078 @end smallexample
26079
26080 @noindent
26081 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
26082 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
26083 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
26084 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
26085 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
26086 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
26087 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
26088 original description.
26089
26090 @subsection Architecture
26091 @cindex <architecture>
26092
26093 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
26094
26095 @smallexample
26096 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
26097 @end smallexample
26098
26099 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
26100 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
26101 Debugging Target}).
26102
26103 @subsection Features
26104 @cindex <feature>
26105
26106 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
26107 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
26108 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
26109 has this form:
26110
26111 @smallexample
26112 <feature name="@var{name}">
26113 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
26114 @var{reg}@dots{}
26115 </feature>
26116 @end smallexample
26117
26118 @noindent
26119 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
26120 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
26121 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
26122 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
26123
26124 @subsection Types
26125
26126 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
26127 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
26128 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
26129 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
26130 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
26131
26132 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
26133 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
26134 Types must be defined before they are used.
26135
26136 @cindex <vector>
26137 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
26138 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
26139 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
26140 @var{count}:
26141
26142 @smallexample
26143 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
26144 @end smallexample
26145
26146 @cindex <union>
26147 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
26148 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
26149 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
26150 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
26151
26152 @smallexample
26153 <union id="@var{id}">
26154 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
26155 @dots{}
26156 </union>
26157 @end smallexample
26158
26159 @subsection Registers
26160 @cindex <reg>
26161
26162 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
26163
26164 @smallexample
26165 <reg name="@var{name}"
26166 bitsize="@var{size}"
26167 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
26168 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
26169 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
26170 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
26171 @end smallexample
26172
26173 @noindent
26174 The components are as follows:
26175
26176 @table @var
26177
26178 @item name
26179 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
26180
26181 @item bitsize
26182 The register's size, in bits.
26183
26184 @item regnum
26185 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
26186 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
26187 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
26188 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
26189 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
26190 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
26191 in order of increasing register number.
26192
26193 @item save-restore
26194 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
26195 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
26196 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
26197 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
26198 ABI.
26199
26200 @item type
26201 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
26202 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
26203 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
26204 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
26205 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
26206 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
26207
26208 @item group
26209 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
26210 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
26211 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
26212 in @code{info registers}.
26213
26214 @end table
26215
26216 @node Predefined Target Types
26217 @section Predefined Target Types
26218 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
26219
26220 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
26221 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
26222 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
26223 types. The currently supported types are:
26224
26225 @table @code
26226
26227 @item int8
26228 @itemx int16
26229 @itemx int32
26230 @itemx int64
26231 @itemx int128
26232 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26233
26234 @item uint8
26235 @itemx uint16
26236 @itemx uint32
26237 @itemx uint64
26238 @itemx uint128
26239 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26240
26241 @item code_ptr
26242 @itemx data_ptr
26243 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
26244 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
26245 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
26246 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
26247 may be marked as data pointers.
26248
26249 @item ieee_single
26250 Single precision IEEE floating point.
26251
26252 @item ieee_double
26253 Double precision IEEE floating point.
26254
26255 @item arm_fpa_ext
26256 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
26257
26258 @end table
26259
26260 @node Standard Target Features
26261 @section Standard Target Features
26262 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
26263
26264 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
26265 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
26266 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
26267 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
26268 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
26269 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
26270 can recognize them.
26271
26272 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
26273 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
26274 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
26275 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
26276 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
26277 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
26278 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
26279 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
26280
26281 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
26282 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
26283 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
26284
26285 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
26286 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
26287 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
26288 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
26289
26290 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
26291 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
26292 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
26293
26294 @menu
26295 * ARM Features::
26296 * M68K Features::
26297 @end menu
26298
26299
26300 @node ARM Features
26301 @subsection ARM Features
26302 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
26303
26304 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
26305 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
26306 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
26307
26308 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
26309 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
26310
26311 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
26312 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
26313 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
26314 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
26315
26316 @subsection MIPS Features
26317 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
26318
26319 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
26320 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
26321 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
26322 on the target.
26323
26324 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
26325 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
26326 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26327
26328 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
26329 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
26330 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
26331 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26332
26333 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
26334 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
26335 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
26336
26337 @node M68K Features
26338 @subsection M68K Features
26339 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
26340
26341 @table @code
26342 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
26343 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
26344 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
26345 One of those features must be always present.
26346 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
26347 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
26348 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
26349 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
26350
26351 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
26352 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
26353 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
26354 @samp{fpiaddr}.
26355 @end table
26356
26357 @subsection PowerPC Features
26358 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
26359
26360 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
26361 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
26362 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
26363 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26364
26365 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
26366 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
26367
26368 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
26369 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
26370 and @samp{vrsave}.
26371
26372 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
26373 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
26374 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
26375 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
26376 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
26377 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
26378 user.
26379
26380 @include gpl.texi
26381
26382 @raisesections
26383 @include fdl.texi
26384 @lowersections
26385
26386 @node Index
26387 @unnumbered Index
26388
26389 @printindex cp
26390
26391 @tex
26392 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
26393 % meantime:
26394 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
26395 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
26396 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
26397 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
26398 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
26399 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
26400 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
26401 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
26402 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
26403 \page\colophon
26404 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
26405 @end tex
26406
26407 @bye
This page took 0.538888 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.